VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
USER’S GUIDE
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
26dB
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
PAIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
FADER MODE
/-1
+1/
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
ADAT IN
EFF RTN
MASTER
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CAUTION:
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE BLADE OF
PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.
ATTENTION:
POUR EVITER LES CHOCS ELECTRIQUES, INTRODUIRE
LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE
CORRESPONDANTE DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU'
AU FOND.
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK,
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK).
NO USER - SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral
triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated
"dangerous voltage" within the product's enclosure that may be
of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to
persons.
"WARNING"
"TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK,
DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR
MOISTURE."
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to
alert the user to the presence of important operating and
maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature
accompanying the appliance.
9. Heat - The appliance should be situated away from heat sources
such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other appliances
(including amplifiers) that produce heat.
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1. Read Instructions - All the safety and operating instructions
should be read before the appliance is operated.
2. Retain Instructions - The safety and operating instructions
should be retained for future reference.
10. Power Sources - The appliance should be connected to a power
supply only of the type described in the operating instructions
or as marked on the appliance.
3. Heed Warnings - All warnings on the appliance and in the
operating instructions should be adhered to.
11. Grounding or Polarization - The precautions that should be taken
so that the grounding or polarization means of an appliance is
not defeated.
4. Follow Instructions - All operating and use instructions should
be followed.
12. Power Cord Protection - Power supply cords should be routed
so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items
placed upon or against them, paying particular attention to cords
at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they
exit from the appliance.
5. Water and Moisture - The appliance should not be used near
water - for example, near a bathtub, washbowl, kitchen sink,
laundry tub, in a wet basement, or near a swimming pool, and
the like.
6. Carts and Stands - The appliance should be used only with a
cart or stand that is recommended by the manufacturer.
13. Cleaning - The appliance should be cleaned only as
recommended by the manufacturer.
14. Nonuse Periods - The power cord of the appliance should be
unplugged from the outlet when left unused for a long period of
time.
15. Object and Liquid Entry - Care should be taken so that objects
do not fall and liquids are not spilled into the enclosure through
openings.
An appliance and cart combination should be moved with care.
Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may cause
the appliance and cart combination to overturn.
16. Damage Requiring Service - The appliance should be serviced
by qualified service personnel when:
A. The power supply cord or the plug has been damaged; or
B. Objects have fallen, or liquid has been spilled into the
appliance; or
7. Wall or Ceiling Mounting - The appliance should be mounted to
a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer.
8. Ventilation - The appliance should be situated so that its location
or position dose not interfere with its proper ventilation.
For example, the appliance should not be situated on a bed,
sofa, rug, or similar surface that may block the ventilation
openings; or, placed in a built-in installation, such as a bookcase
or cabinet that may impede the flow of air through the ventilation
openings.
C. The appliance has been exposed to rain; or
D. The appliance does not appear to operate normally or
exhibits a marked change in performance; or
E. The appliance has been dropped, or the enclosure damaged.
17. Servicing - The user should not attempt to service the appliance
beyond that described in the operating instructions.
All other servicing should be referred to qualified service
personnel.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[ON] key fu n ction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
EQ Section Rotary Con trols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Rear Pan el . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
CHAPTER 3
Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
VM200 System Exam ple . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Con n ectin g th e Power Cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Tu rn in g th e VM200 On an d Off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
A Few Tips on Usin g th e VM200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Ch an n el Layers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
An Im portan t Note Abou t Word Clock In form ation . . . 48
Stopless Rotary Con trols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
Readin g th e Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Th e Ch an n el Edit Fu n ction Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Fu n ction Page Param eter Matrix. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Lit & Flash in g LED Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Fin ally...Let’s Get Started! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Makin g Con n ection s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Powerin g On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Adju stin g th e Ch an n el In pu t . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Recordin g. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Storin g a Mix Scen e . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
CHAPTER 4
Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .59
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
In pu t Ch an n els 1–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
In pu t Ch an n els 5–8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
In pu t Ch an n els 9–16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
In pu t Ch an n els 17–20 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
In sert Ch an n els 1–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
Pad Switch es (In pu t ch an n els 1–4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
TRIM Con trols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
In vertin g th e In pu t Ph ase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
In pu t Ch an n el EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Mu tin g Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Settin g Ch an n el Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Pan n in g In pu t Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Rou tin g In pu t Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Mon itorin g an d Soloin g In pu t Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Feedin g Ou tpu ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
REC Bu ss Ou t . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
ST Bu ss Ou t. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Pairin g Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Grou pin g Mu te Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
Grou pin g Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
Viewin g In pu t Ch an n el Settin gs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Copyin g Ch an n el Settin gs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
CHAPTER 5
EQ. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Equ alizers (EQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
4
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Adju stin g th e EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
EQ En ablin g Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Bypassin g th e EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Resettin g th e EQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
EQ Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
EQ Preset Library List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Recallin g EQ Program s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Storin g EQ Program s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Editin g EQ Program Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Copyin g EQ Settin gs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
EQ Preset Library Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
CHAPTER 6
Monitoring Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Mon itorin g an d Soloin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
MON SEL Param eter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
SOLO MODE Param eter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Mon itor Ou ts an d Ph on es . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Two Track In pu t (2TRK IN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Mon itorin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Soloin g . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Meterin g Sign al Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Viewin g In pu t/ Ou tpu t Level Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Viewin g Ch an n el, Au x Sen d & Effect Sen d Meters . . . 106
CHAPTER 7
Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .107
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
ST BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
REC BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
ADAT OUT & S/ P DIF OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
AUX SEND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Usin g th e ST BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Mon itorin g th e ST BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Viewin g th e ST BUSS OUT Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Settin g th e ST BUSS OUT Level. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Mu tin g th e ST BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Usin g th e REC BUSS OUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Mon itorin g th e REC BUSS OUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Viewin g th e REC BUSS OUT Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Settin g th e REC BUSS OUT Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
Usin g th e AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
En ablin g AUX Sen ds 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX Param eter) . . 115
Mon itorin g AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Viewin g th e AUX Sen d an d Master Settin g . . . . . . . . 116
Pre-fader/ Post-fader AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Mu tin g AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Sm ooth in g Fu n ction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Viewin g Bu ss Rou tin g for Each Ch an n el . . . . . . . . . . 121
CHAPTER 8
Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
VM200 Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Effects Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
VM200 User’s Guide
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effect Preset Library List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Applyin g Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Selectin g an Effects Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Settin g Effects Retu rn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
Sen din g Sign al to Effects Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Rou tin g Effects Retu rn s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Con trollin g th e Sen ds Sign als . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Pre-fader/ Post-fader Effect Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Viewin g an d Adju stin g th e Effect Sen d Level. . . . . . . 130
Viewin g an d Adju stin g th e Effect Sen d Master Level . 131
Mon itorin g Effects Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Con trollin g th e Retu rn Sign als . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Settin g th e Effect Retu rn Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Pan n in g Effects Retu rn s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Effects Library . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Editin g Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Recallin g Effects Program s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Storin g Effects Program s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Editin g Effect Program Titles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Effects Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
CHAPTER 9
Scene Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Wh at is Scen e Mem ory? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Scen e Edit In dicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Wh at Can You Store in a Scen e? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Recallin g Mix Scen es . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Recallin g a Scen e Man u ally . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Recallin g a Scen e Au tom atically at Start-u p . . . . . . . 151
Recallin g Scen es Usin g MIDI Program Ch an ge . . . . . 152
Motorized Faders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Storin g Mix Scen es . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Editin g Scen e Mem ory Titles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Recall Safe Fu n ction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Specifyin g Recall Safe Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Specifyin g Recall Safe Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
CHAPTER 10
Digital Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .159
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Digital Con n ection s, Word Clocks, an d Sam ple Rates 160
Word Clock Setu p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
WORD IN/ OUT Con n ectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Settin g th e Master Word Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Settin g th e VM200 as Master or Slave . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Mu ltitrack Recordin g an d Masterin g to a DAT . . . . . 164
Digital I/ Os . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
ADAT IN/ OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Usin g ADAT IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Assign in g Ch an n els to ADAT DIRECT SENDs . . . . . . 166
Usin g S/ P DIF OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
Usin g S/ P DIF IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Assign in g S/ P DIF Sign als to Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . 169
Cascadin g th e VM200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
6
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
CHAPTER 11
VM200 & MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .173
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Usin g th e VM200 with MIDI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
MIDI Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Cascadin g Two VM200s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
MIDI Tran sm it an d Receive Ch an n els . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
System Exclu sive Messages (Fostex Exclu sive) . . . . . 179
Bu lk Du m p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Usin g Program Ch an ge Messages to Recall Scen es . . 180
Usin g Con trol Ch an ge Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Editin g th e Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table. . . . . . . . . . 185
Exam ples: Usin g Con trol Ch an ge Messages . . . . . . . . 187
Con trollin g Param eters Usin g Fostex Exclu sive . . . . 188
Bu lk Du m p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
Tran sm ittin g MIDI Bu lk Du m p Messages . . . . . . . . . 189
Receivin g Bu lk Du m p Requ ests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
MMC (MIDI Mach in e Con trol) Sen d . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Settin g th e Device ID Nu m ber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
En terin g MMC Sen d Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Fram e Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Ch eckin g th e Locate Poin ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Tran sm ittin g th e Locate Com m an ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
CHAPTER 12
Initializing the VM200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .197
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
In itializin g th e VM200 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 198
Defau lt Setu p Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
APPENDIX
Specifications and Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
Abou t Th is Ch apter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Ch apter Con ten ts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Display Warn in g Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Specification s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Main ten an ce . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
Tables & Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Ch an n el Fader Gain Table. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Q . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Program Ch an ge Assign Table 1 (User) . . . . . . . . . . . 210
Program Ch an ge Assign Table 2 (Preset) . . . . . . . . . . 210
Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table 1 (User) . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table 2 (Preset) . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Preset Scen e Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
MIDI In / Ou t Data Form at . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
MIDI Im plem en tation Ch art . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Declaration of EC Directive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Th e Affect of Im m u n ity on Th is Equ ipm en t . . . . . . . . 226
Fostex Distribu tors List In Eu rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
VM200 User’s Guide
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
8
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 1
Introducing the VM200
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter in trodu ces th e VM200 Digital Recordin g Mixer,
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
explain s h ow to u se th is gu ide, an d h ow to in stall th e m ixer. It also
ON
AN
P
provides a su m m ary of th e m ain featu res of th e VM200.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Chapter Contents
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SO
LO
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
14
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introducing the VM200
Welcom e to the VM200
Th an k you for pu rch asin g th e Fostex VM200 Digital Recordin g
Mixer.
Th e VM200 is an affordable program m able digital au dio m ixer th at
can be extrem ely u sefu l in n u m erou s au dio application s, in clu din g
sm aller -scale live sou n d rein forcem en t, as well as au dio an d video
post-produ ction . However, it is design ed prim arily for digital au dio
recordin g in a MIDI or project stu dio, especially if you are u sin g dig-
ital h ard disk or tape-based m u ltitrack recordin g tech n ologies su ch
as th e Fostex FD-8, VR-800, or oth er ADAT-com patible digital
recorders.
Using this Guide
Th is u ser’s gu ide in clu des th e followin g m ain section s:
Cha pter 1: Introducing the VM200 describes th e m ajor featu res an d
explain s h ow to in stall th e VM200.
Cha pter 2: Touring the VM200 takes you on a gu ided tou r of th e
m ixer’s in pu ts an d ou tpu ts, faders, con trols, bu tton s, an d LCD dis-
play elem en ts.
Cha pter 3: Getting Sta rted offers illu strated system exam ples an d
explain s h ow to con n ect an d tu rn on th e power to th e VM200, an d try
ou t a few featu res, su ch as th e EQ an d Effects processors.
Cha pter 4: Inputs describes th e available in pu t ch an n els an d dis-
cu sses pad switch es, trim con trols, ph ase in version , as well as m u t-
in g, pan n in g, grou pin g, an d rou tin g in pu t ch an n els.
Cha pter 5: EQ describes th e param etric equ alizer, th e EQ Library,
an d h ow to store, recall, an d edit EQ program s.
Cha pter 6: Monitoring describes th e m on itorin g an d soloin g capabili-
ties of th e VM200 an d explain s h ow to view variou s level m eters.
Cha pter 7: Outputs describes th e stereo bu ss ou tpu t, th e record bu ss
ou tpu t, th e AUX sen ds, an d h ow to m on itor, rou te, solo, an d m u te th e
bu ss ou ts.
Cha pter 8: Effects describes th e Effect Library, presets an d u ser pro-
gram s, an d h ow to apply an d rou te to an d from th e effect processors.
Cha pter 9: Scene Memories in trodu ces scen e m em ories an d explain s
h ow to store an d recall scen es, an d h ow to preven t specific param e-
ters from bein g u pdated by a recalled scen e m em ory.
Cha pter 10: Digita l I/ O discu sses th e VM200’s digital in pu ts an d ou t-
pu ts, in clu din g th e ADAT an d S/ P DIF digital con n ectors, word clock
m asters an d slaves, an d cascadin g m u ltiple VM200s.
Cha pter 11: MIDI describes th e Mu sical In stru m en t Digital In terface
(MIDI) fu n ction s of th e VM200.
Cha pter 12: Initia lizing explain s h ow to re-in itialize th e VM200.
10
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Installing the VM200
Appendix A. Specifica tions a nd Da ta provides tech n ical specification s
an d oth er data, in clu din g a MIDI Program Ch an ge Assign table, a
Con trol Ch an ge Assign table, System Exclu sive m essages, etc.
Th e Index can h elp you locate specific in form ation qu ickly.
Installing the VM200
Locate th e VM200 on a level, stable su rface.
You can also m ou n t th e VM200 vertically in a rack u sin g th e Fostex
9910 option al rack m ou n t adapter. Rem ove th e six screws from th e
bottom of th e VM200, attach th e rack m ou n t adapter, th en rein stall
th e screws as sh own in th e illu stration below.
rack-mount adapter
3 screws per side
attach adapters
to sides of mixer
side view of
installed adapter
Refer to th e Preca utions for in form ation on appropriate location s an d
en viron m en ts for th e VM200.
Refer to “Gettin g Started” on page 43 an d “Ou tpu ts” on page 107 for
in form ation on con n ectin g th e VM200 to oth er com pon en ts.
VM200 User’s Guide
11
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introducing the VM200
Feature Sum m ary
Th is section su m m arizes th e m ain featu res of th e VM200.
Audio Specifications
❑ 20-bit 64-tim es oversam plin g, delta sigm a m odu lation A/ D con -
verters
❑ 20-bit 128-tim es oversam plin g, delta sigm a m odu lation D/ A con -
verters
❑ 90dB or h igh er dyn am ic ran ge
❑ 20Hz to 20kHz, +1dB/ -3dB frequ en cy respon se
❑ in du stry stan dard 44.1K or 48K sam plin g rates
Inputs and Outputs
❑ 20 Ch an n el In pu ts
• Ch an n els 1 - 8: An alog In
• Ch an n els 9-16: ADAT In (20-bit)
• Ch an n els 17-20: Effect Retu rn (for in tern al effects on ly)
• Switch able balan ced XLR an d balan ced/ u n balan ced ph on e
jacks
• +48V ph an tom power su pport for XLR An alog In jacks 1-4
• Rou te S/ P DIF in pu t sign als to an y of 20 ch an n els
❑ 18 Ou tpu ts
• Stereo bu ss ou tpu t (ST BUSS OUT)
• Recordin g bu ss ou tpu t (REC BUSS OUT)
• 20-bit digital two-ch an n el ou tpu t (S/ P DIF OUT)
• 20-bit digital ADAT eigh t-ch an n el ou tpu t (ADAT OUT)
• Two au xiliary ou tpu ts (AUX SEND 1-2)
• ADD AUX fu n ction adds two au xiliary ou ts (AUX SENDS 3-4)
• Solo bu ss ou tpu ts post-fader listen (PFL) sign als from an y ch an -
n el or bu ss to th e Mon itor or Ph on es ou tpu ts.
❑ MIDI IN, MIDI OUT, an d MIDI THRU (bu ilt in to th e m ixer)
❑ Word Clock In an d Ou t
❑ An alog two-track in pu t jacks (2TRK IN) en able you to m on itor two
tracks with ou t affectin g th e m ix.
❑ 4 In sert jacks for extern al effects retu rn s
12
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Mixer Functions
Mixer Functions
❑ Scen e Mem ory (u p to 100 scen es)
❑ 3 Preset Scen es (INIT, RECORDING, MIXDOWN)
❑ 60m m con tin u ou s m otorized faders
❑ Stopless rotary con trols
❑ 4-ban d param etric EQ for ch an n els 1-16
❑ Du al in tern al effects processors
❑ EQ Library with 50 Presets plu s 50 m em ory location s for cu stom -
ized EQ program s
❑ Effect Library featu rin g 50 Preset effect program s, an d m em ory
location s for 50 u ser -cu stom ized effect program s
❑ Th e ADAT DIRECT sen d fu n ction en ables you to assign in pu t ch an -
n el 1-8 sign als to ADAT 1-8 (an d tu rn an y ch an n el on or off).
❑ You can pair adjacen t (odd-even ) in pu t ch an n els.
❑ You can pair AUX SEND 1 an d 2, an d AUX SEND 3 an d 4.
❑ Th ree Fader grou ps (A, B, C)
❑ Th ree Mu te grou ps (A, B, C)
❑ Ch an n el Copy fu n ction copies param eter settin gs, in clu din g m u te
grou p an d fader grou p in form ation , from on e ch an n el to an oth er
❑ EQ Copy fu n ction copies EQ settin gs from on e ch an n el to an oth er.
❑ LED-segm en t m eter displays ST BUSS OUT level
❑ LCD m eter displays levels for 20 in pu t ch an n els or 18 ou tpu t ch an -
n els
❑ Two Solo m odes, PFL an d MIX-SOLO, en able you to m on itor sign als
pre-fader or post-fader
❑ Large 256x64 dot resolu tion LCD Display
MIDI functions
❑ You can u se Program Ch an ge m essages to recall scen es (Presets
an d User tables)
❑ You can u se Con trol Ch an ge m essages to con trol m ixer param eters
(Presets an d User tables)
❑ You can u se System Exclu sive m essages to con trol m ixer param e-
ters
❑ You can ou tpu t MIDI Mach in e Code (MMC) by pressin g keys on th e
con trol pan el
❑ MIDI Bu lk Du m p capability for data backu p an d tran sfer
VM200 User’s Guide
13
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introducing the VM200
Mixer Configuration
Th e VM200 is equ ipped with a total of 20 an alog an d digital in pu ts:
eigh t an alog m on o in pu t ch an n els (1-8), fou r in tern al effects
retu rn s, an d an eigh t-ch an n el ADAT digital in pu t. A two-ch an n el
S/ P DIF digital in pu t sign al can be rou ted to an y of 20 ch an n els,
an d a two-track an alog in pu t (2TRK IN) is also provided.
Extern al effects sign als can be retu rn ed to th e VM200 via fou r
INSERT ph on e jacks.
In pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 8 featu re trim con trol atten u ators an d TRS
ph on e jack con n ectors. In pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 4 can also be
switch ed to +48V ph an tom -powered balan ced XLR-type con n ectors.
Two effects bu sses sen d sign als to th e two on -board effects proces-
sors. An Effects Library con tain s 50 h igh -qu ality preset effects pro-
gram s. Th e effects can be m odified an d stored in th e Effects Library
for fu tu re recall. Th e VM200 retu rn s th e effects sign als via ch an n els
17-20.
Th e VM200 featu res 18 ou tpu ts.
A stereo bu ss ou tpu ts th e stereo bu ss sign al; a record bu ss ou tpu ts
th e record bu ss sign al.
Th ere are two fixed AUX Sen ds, an d two m ore can be added th rou gh
th e u se of an ADD AUX fu n ction (alth ou gh th e record bu ss is u n avail-
able wh en th e ADD AUX param eter is on ).
Digital ou tpu ts in clu de a 20-bit digital two-ch an n el ou tpu t (S/ P DIF
OUT), a 20-bit digital ADAT eigh t-ch an n el ou tpu t (ADAT OUT).
Mon itor an d h eadph on e ou tpu ts facilitate stereo m on itorin g via
speakers or h eadph on es.
A fou r -ban d param etric equ alizer is available for each in pu t ch an n el.
EQ program s can be stored in an d recalled from an on -board EQ
Library.
You can cascade m u ltiple VM200s togeth er to in crease th e n u m ber of
in pu t ch an n els.
Why a Digital Mixer?
On e of th e best th in gs abou t a digita l au dio m ixer is th at it is able to
com bin e au dio sign als from variou s sou rces with ou t in trodu cin g vir -
tu ally an y sign al degradation , distortion , crosstalk, or n oise.
Digital recordin g to tape or h ard disk-based system s is in creasin gly
popu lar. However, m an y of th ese sm all stu dios u se 4-, 8-, or 16-ch an -
n el a na log m ixers.
Th e VM200 Digital Recordin g Mixer en ables you to keep you r au dio
sign als in th e digital dom ain for both m ixin g a nd recordin g, resu ltin g
in n ew levels clarity an d qu ality in you r recordin gs.
14
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Four-band Parametric EQ & EQ Library
Four-band Param etric EQ & EQ Library
Ch an n els 1 th rou gh 16 featu re a fou r -ban d param etric equ alizer
(EQ), with variable Gain , Frequ en cy, an d Q con trols.
Th e LO-MID an d HI-MID ban ds u se param etric EQ. Th e LO ban d can
fu n ction as an HPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ; th e HI ban d can fu n c-
tion as an LPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ.
An EQ Library can store u p to 100 EQ program s for fu tu re recall.
Dual On-board Effects Processors
Th e VM200 featu res two on -board stereo effects processors, EFF1
an d EFF2.
Th ese effects processors u tilize Fostex Advan ced Sign al Processin g
Tech n ology (ASP) to create h igh -qu ality am bien t reverbs, as well as
ch oru ses, delays, flan gers, an d oth er effects an d com bin ation s.
ASP is an exclu sive n ew digital effect processin g tech n ology design ed
by Fostex th at excels at m axim izin g th e efficien cy of digital sign al pro-
cessin g power. It ach ieves an overwh elm in gly h igh -den sity Early
Reflection sou n d an d sm ooth High Du m p respon se rate via a Har -
m on ic Feedback Algorith m , an d con du cts elaborate reverb sim u lation
u sin g High Den sity Logarith m ic Processin g tech n ology, wh ich elim i-
n ates m u tu al in terferen ce between in tegrated delay m odu les, redu c-
in g au dio im pu rities.
Digital I/ O
Th e VM200 featu res two types of digital in pu ts an d ou tpu ts: S/ P DIF
an d ADAT.
Th e S/ P DIF is a two-ch an n el digital I/ O com m on ly fou n d on con -
su m er CD players, com pu ter au dio cards, etc.
Th e ADAT IN an d ADAT OUT con n ectors allow a direct eigh t-ch an n el
con n ection to an y ADAT-com patible digital au dio recorder, su ch as
th e Fostex VR800 or th e Alesis ADAT series.
About the Display and Graphic User Interface
Th e LCD display featu res a resolu tion of 256-by-64 dots an d u tilizes
graph ic icon s to represen t faders, sen d levels, an d rotary con trol
kn obs.
Th e display also provides a graph ic EQ respon se cu rve an d n u m erical
readou ts of m ixer param eter settin gs.
Depen din g on th e ligh tin g in you r stu dio, you m ay wish to su pple-
m en t th e LCD Display with a goosen eck-type stu dio lam p or oth er
ligh t sou rce.
VM200 User’s Guide
15
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Introducing the VM200
Scene Mem ory
Th e VM200 en ables you to store virtu ally every m ixer param eter set-
tin g as part of a grou p sn apsh ot, or “scen e,” in th e Scen e Mem ory.
Th e Scen e Mem ory can store u p to 100 scen es, wh ich you can later
recall by sim ply pressin g a key on th e VM200, or by issu in g a rem ote
MIDI Program Ch an ge com m an d from a con n ected MIDI device.
Th e Scen e Mem ory store an d recall fu n ction s let you work on a m ix
u n til you are satisfied, th en store virtu ally all m ixer fader an d param -
eter settin gs for in stan tan eou s fu tu re recall.
In addition to th e scen e m em ory “slots” or “location s” for u ser pro-
gram s, th e VM200 featu res th ree preset scen es: In itMix, Recordin g,
an d Mix Down , wh ich are design ed for optim al perform an ce in com -
m on m ixin g situ ation s.
MIDI
MIDI con n ection s en able you to take advan tage of th e VM200’s ver -
satility. MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages can recall scen es from th e
VM200’s Scen e Mem ory. MIDI Con trol Ch an ge m essages an d Fostex
System Exclu sive m essages en able real-tim e param eter con trol.
To backu p an d tran sfer data between VM200s, you can u se System
Exclu sive Bu lk Du m p com m an ds.
If a MIDI-com patible recorder is con n ected to th e VM200, you can
con trol it rem otely via MMC (MIDI Mach in e Con trol). You can also
cascade VM200s via MIDI con n ection s.
Faders
Th e VM200 featu res eigh t 60m m con tin u ou s-th row faders an d on e
Master fader.
A ch an n el layerin g system en ables you to con trol u p to 20 ch an n els
u sin g on ly th e eigh t faders an d th e Master. Page Select keys specify
th e “active” ch an n el layer. You can select Ch an n els 1 - 8 An alog In ,
Ch an n els 9 - 16 ADAT In , or Ch an n els 17 - 20 Eff Rtn . Th e LCD Dis-
play will sh ow param eters specific to th e selected layer.
Th e VM200 featu res seven Fader m odes. In each m ode, th e Faders
fu n ction sligh tly differen tly, con trollin g variou s sen d an d retu rn lev-
els. Th e Fader m odes in clu de: Ch an n el, Eff1, Eff2, Au x1, Au x2, Au x3,
an d Au x4.
Th e m otorized faders m ove au tom atically wh en you recall a scen e
from Scen e Mem ory, if th e Motor param eter is tu rn ed on .
Th e faders can be grou ped in to on e of th ree grou ps, en ablin g you to
con trol th e grou p with a sin gle fader. Faders for paired ch an n els
m ove as on e.
Th e faders can fu n ction as MIDI con trollers if a MIDI device is con -
n ected to th e VM200 via th e MIDI ports.
16
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 2
Touring the VM200
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter takes you on a gu ided tou r of th e VM200, in trodu cin g
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
variou s com pon en ts of th e con trol su rface, in clu din g th e faders,
ON
AN
P
rotary con trols, th e Data Wh eel, an d oth er featu res.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
It also explain s th e operation s associated with each fu n ction key.
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
Th is ch apter th en discu sses th e in pu t an d ou tpu t con n ectors an d
ON
EQ EDIT
switch es on th e rear pan el an d con clu des with a block diagram of
Q
0
th e VM200.
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
Chapter Contents
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
Top Pan el Con trol Su rface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
-30
-40
0
-
ON
4
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
EQ Section Rotary Con trols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
17
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Top Panel Control Surface
Th e followin g illu stration sh ows th e top pan el con trol su rface of th e
VM200.
Each section of th e m ixer is discu ssed in th e followin g pages.
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
26dB
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
PAIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
FADER MODE
/-1
+1/
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-10
-20
-10
-10
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
ADAT IN
EFF RTN
MASTER
An alog Con trol Section (page 19)
LCD Display (page 20)
Fu n ction Keys (page 22)
In pu t Ch an n el Con trol Section (page 32)
Rear Pan el (page 38)
Data Wh eel an d Neigh borin g Keys (page 21)
18
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Analog Control Section
Analog Control Section
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
26dB
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
A/ B Input selectors
Th e VM200 featu res fou r A/ B In pu t selectors th at en able you to
select th e A or B in pu ts for in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 4.
The A In pu ts are balanced XLR-type connectors for u se with m icro-
phones that featu re XLR-type plu gs, su ch as condenser m icrophones,
or oth er in pu t devices that requ ire XLR con nectors.
Th e B In pu ts are balan ced/ u n balan ced TRS (tip-rin g-sleeve) ph on e
con n ectors, for u se with dyn am ic m icroph on es an d oth er sou n d
sou rces th at requ ire ph on e jacks. (Th ese con n ectors will accept bal-
an ced or u n balan ced in pu ts.)
For m ore in form ation , see “In pu t Ch an n els 1–4” on page 60.
Th e A In pu ts are selected by defau lt (th e selector is n ot depressed).
Press th e A/ B In pu t Selector to select th e B in pu t.
PAD (26dB) sw itches
Th e fou r Pad switch es tu rn th e 26 dB in pu t pads on an d off for in pu t
ch an n els 1–4.
Wh en tu rn ed on , th e in pu t pads atten u ate th e sign al by 26 dB. Th is
h elps th e pream p h an dle “h ot” sign als.
For m ore in form ation , see “Pad Switch es (In pu t ch an n els 1–4)” on
page 63.
TRIM controls
Th e fou r Trim con trols (1–4) atten u ate th e gain of th e in pu t pream ps
in th e ran ge of +10 to -34 or -16 to -60 dB, depen din g on wh eth er or
n ot th e sign al is atten u ated by th e Pad 26dB switch . Th e oth er fou r
Trim con trols (5–8) atten u ate th e gain of th e in pu t pream ps in th e
ran ge of -10 to -50.
2TRK IN sw itch
Th e 2TRK IN switch en ables you to m on itor th e sign al in pu t to th e
2TRK IN con n ector on th e rear pan el. You can m on itor th is sign al
th rou gh MONITOR OUT or PHONES OUT. Th e sign al is u n affected by
m ixer settin gs.
VM200 User’s Guide
19
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Monitor Gain knob
Use th e Mon itor Gain kn ob to adju st th e Mon itor Ou t level.
Th e Mon itor Ou t jacks ou tpu t th e bu ss sign al you specify on th e
SETUP SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page. (Th e defau lt is ST BUSS
OUT.)
Phones Gain knob
Use th e Ph on es Gain kn ob to adju st th e h eadph on e ou tpu t level.
LCD Display
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
Contrast dial
Rotate th is dial left or righ t to adju st th e con trast of th e LCD Display
for m axim u m clarity.
LCD Display
Th e LCD Display h as a resolu tion of 256 x 64 dots. It displays variou s
param eters an d n u m erical valu es, an d u ses graph ic icon s to repre-
sen t faders, rotary con trols, pan position s, an d switch es.
For m ore in form ation , see “Readin g th e Display” on page 49.
Meters
Th e LCD Display featu res m eters for 20 in pu t ch an n els or 18 ou tpu t
ch an n els.
To th e righ t of th e LCD Display is a pair of n in e-segm en t LED m eters
for th e Left an d Righ t ch an n els of th e stereo bu ss sign als.
20
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Data Wheel and Neighboring Keys
Data Wheel and Neighboring Keys
Th e Data Wh eel is located in th e lower -righ t corn er of th e VM200.
It en ables you to scroll th rou gh lists of program s in th e Effect an d EQ
Libraries. You can also u se th e Data Wh eel to m ove th e cu rsor left an d
righ t wh en n am in g a n ew effect or EQ program .
/-1
+1/
EXIT
DATA
Use your thumb or finger
to rotate the Data Wheel
ENTER
[</ -1] and [+1/ >] Keys
Th ese keys can step th rou gh scrollable lists, su ch as th e Effect
Library or EQ Library.
[ENTER] and [EXIT] Keys
You can u se th e [ENTER] key to execu te certain fu n ction s, su ch as
con firm in g n ew param eter valu es, writin g to m em ory, or in itializin g
th e VM200. You can also u se it to con firm n ew param eter settin gs.
In m an y cases, if you h old down th e [ENTER] key wh ile pressin g
an oth er key, th e VM200 displays th e key’s first fu n ction page (as
opposed to th e m ost recen tly-displayed fu n ction page for th at key).
Pressin g th e [EXIT] key u su ally exits th e cu rren t operatin g m ode an d
displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
Th e followin g table sh ows addition al [ENTER] key fu n ction s.
Press ENTER and...
ON
Operation
Sets channel fader parameter in selected fader mode to Unity Gain.
Increases adjustment increment in EFF Edit or EQ Edit mode.
Rotary Controls
VM200 enters EQ Edit mode. (If already in EQ Edit mode, the
parameter being edited will be initialized after confirmation.
EQ EDIT
SYSTEM
Displays the first SYSTEM function page.
Displays the first MIDI function page.
MIDI
CH VIEW
Displays the first CH VIEW function page.
Displays the first PAIR/GROUP function page.
Displays the first ROUTING/PHASE function page.
Displays the first CHANNEL/METER function page.
PAIR/GROUP
ROUTING/PHASE
CHANNEL/METER
VM200 User’s Guide
21
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Function Keys
Th is section provides a brief tou r of th e VM200’s n u m erou s fu n ction
keys.
Wh en you press certain fu n ction keys, su ch as [SYSTEM] or [CURRENT
SCENE STATUS], th e VM200 displays a “fu n ction page” of in form ation
on th e LCD Display Pan el. Each fu n ction page con tain s param eters
th at you can set to con figu re an d con trol th e VM200.
Each time you press the [SYSTEM] key,
a subsequent function page is displayed.
SETUP
SYSTEM
MIDI
In m an y cases, repeatedly pressin g a fu n ction key displays addition al
pages of param eters. Th e sequ en ce of pages cycles arou n d to begin
again (i.e., page 1, 2, 3, 1, 2, 3...)
Oth er fu n ction keys, su ch as EFF1 in th e Fader Mode section , do n ot
directly display in form ation on th e LCD Display Pan el, bu t n everth e-
less con figu re or con trol th e VM200 in oth er ways.
Som e fu n ction keys are opaqu e grey. Oth ers are tran slu cen t an d
fixed above an LED ligh t th at can ligh t u p or flash to in dicate statu s
in form ation .
In gen eral, th e tran slu cen t fu n ction keys flash to in dicate th at th ey
are available for selection . On ce selected, th ey rem ain lit.
Not e: Th e procedu res in th is m an u al offer specific steps th at you
can follow to accom plish certain tasks. Ph rases su ch as “press
th e fu n ction key twice” assu m e th e fu n ction page cycle always
begin s with th e first fu n ction page. Th is m ay n ot always be th e
case. If n ot, sim ply press th e key repeatedly u n til th e desired page
appears.
22
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setup Section
Setup Section
Th e Setu p section featu res two fu n ction keys: [SYSTEM] an d [MIDI].
Th e SYSTEM key displays fu n ction pages th at en able you to con figu re
th e VM200.
Th e [MIDI] key displays fu n ction pages th at en able you to in terface
th e VM200 to MIDI devices.
SETUP
SYSTEM
MIDI
[SYSTEM] Key
Th e [SYSTEM] key en ables you to con figu re th e VM200.
It displays a sequ en ce of six fu n ction pages on th e LCD Display if you
repeatedly press th e key.
SYSTEM Key
Function Pages
Includes parameters that enable you to...
1:CLOCK/ MON
Se le c t a syste m c lo c k, sp e c ify the b uss to m o nito r, se le c t a
so lo m o d e a nd ke y o p e ra tio n, turn the fa d e r m o to rs o n o r
o ff, a nd se t the Fra m e m o d e .
2:RCL SAFE
Sp e c ify p a ra m e te rs tha t yo u wa nt to re ma in unm o d ifie d
(no t up d a te d ) whe n yo u re c a ll a sc e ne fro m m e m o ry.
3:CH RCL SAFE
4:SOLO SAFE
5:POWER ON RCL
6:INITIALIZE
Sp e c ify c ha nne ls tha t yo u wa nt to re ma in unm o d ifie d (no t
up d a te d ) whe n yo u re c a ll a sc e ne fro m m e m o ry.
Sp e c ify c ha nne ls tha t yo u wa nt to se nd to the ST Buss in
M-So lo m o d e .
Sp e c ify whic h sc e ne the m ixe r sho uld re c a ll fro m m e m o ry
whe n yo u p owe r o n the VM200.
Re -initia lize the VM200, re se tting a ll p a ra m e te rs to fa c to ry
d e fa ult se tting s.
[MIDI] Key
Th e [MIDI] key en ables you to in terface th e VM200 with MIDI (Mu sical
In stru m en t Digital In terface) in stru m en ts an d devices.
Th e [MIDI] key also featu res six fu n ction pages, as su m m arized below:
MIDI Key
Function Pages
Includes parameters that enable you to...
1:MIDI TX&RX
Se t MIDI tra nsm it/ re c e ive c ha nne ls, se t MIDI m e ssa g e tra ns-
m issio n a nd re c e p tio n o n o r o ff.
2:PGM TABLE1
3:PGM TABLE2
4:CTL TABLE1
5:CTL TABLE2
6:BULK DUMP
Ed it Use r Pro g ra m Cha ng e Assig n ta b le 1.
Vie w Pro g ra m Cha ng e Assig n ta b le 2.
Ed it Use r Co ntro l Cha ng e Assig n ta b le 1.
Vie w Co ntro l Cha ng e Assig n ta b le 2.
Se t up Bulk Dum p tra nsm issio n.
VM200 User’s Guide
23
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Current Scene Status
Th e Cu rren t Scen e Statu s section featu res on ly on e key, wh ich
sh ares its n am e.
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
Wh en you press th e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] key, th e VM200 en ters
Cu rren t Scen e Statu s m ode an d displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS
fu n ction page. Th e n u m ber an d n am e of th e scen e (e.g.,
01:MY_SCENE) appear in th e top righ t of th e display.
Th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page en ables you to:
• En able th e EQ for ch an n els 1-8, 9-16, or 1-16
• Tu rn on th e ADD. AUX param eter (to en able AUX Sen ds 3&4)
• Set th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction to Level 1 or 2
• Set th e record bu ss gain (REC-B.GAIN) from [∞ to -90 to 0dB]
(available wh en ADD. AUX is off)
• Set th e sen ds for AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, an d AUX4, EFF1, an d EFF2
to Pre-fader or Post-fader
• Pair AUX Sen ds (Au x1&2 or Au x3&4).
Key Mode Section
Th e Key Mode section featu res fou r fu n ction keys: [ROUT-
ING/ PHASE], [PAIR/ GROUP], [CH VIEW], an d [CHANNEL/ METER], as
described below.
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
PAIR/
GROUP
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
[ROUTING/ PHASE] Key
Th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key displays a sequ en ce of th ree fu n ction
pages th at let you con trol m ixer rou tin g, assign S/ P DIF in pu ts to
ch an n els, an d in vert th e ph ase for each ch an n el.
Th e ROUTING fu n ction page lets you rou te in pu t ch an n els 1–20 to th e
Stereo Bu ss (ST BUS), th e Record Bu ss (REC BUS), or th e ADAT ou t-
pu t (DIRECT).
Press a Page Select key to specify Ch an n els 1-8, 9-16, or 17-20. Th en
press th e [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d/ or [ON] key for each ch an n el to rou te
th e sign al to a poten tial destin ation . Th e in dicator in th e ch an -
n el/ bu ss m atrix h igh ligh ts (dark squ are).
24
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[PAIR/GROUP] Key
Th e S/ P DIF fu n ction page lets you assign th e S/ P DIF digital two-track
in pu t to an y odd-even pair of ch an n els (e.g., 1&2, 13&14, etc.).
Th e Ø PHASE fu n ction page lets you in vert th e ph ase for each of in pu t
ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20.
Press a Page Select key to specify Ch an n els 1-8, 9-16, or 17-20.
You can also u se th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key in con ju n ction with th e
[PAIR/ GROUP] key to en ter MMC m ode. (For m ore in form ation , see
“MMC (MIDI Mach in e Con trol) Sen d” on page 192.)
ROUTING/PHASE Key
Function Pages
1:ROUTING
Includes parameters that enable you to...
Ro ute inp ut c ha nne ls 1-20 to ST BUSS, REC BUSS, o r ADAT
DIRECT.
2:S/ P DIF
Assig n S/ P DIF d ig ita l inp ut to a ny o d d -e ve n c ha nne l p a ir.
Inve rt p ha se fo r e a c h inp ut c ha nne l.
3:Ø PHASE
[PAIR/ GROUP] Key
Th e [PAIR/ GROUP] key displays a sequ en ce of three fu nction pages
that enable you to pair ch annels, m u te grou ps of channels, or grou p
faders u n der th e control of a single fader.
Th e CHANNEL PAIR (CH PAIR) fu n ction page en ables you to pair an y two
odd-even ch an n els u sin g th e [EQ EDIT] keys.
Th e MUTE GROUP fu n ction page en ables you to create th ree grou ps of
ch an n els (Mu te Grou ps A, B, an d C) th at you can silen ce in stan tly.
Th e FADER GROUP fu n ction page also en ables you to create th ree grou ps
of ch an n els (Fader Grou ps A, B, an d C). Faders in a grou p can be con -
trolled by a sin gle fader.
Use th e Page Select keys to specify Ch an n els 1-8, 9-16, or 17-20; u se
th e [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d [ON] keys to apply th ese fu n ction s to spe-
cific ch an n els.
You can also press th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key sim u ltan eou sly with th e
[PAIR/ GROUP] key to en ter MMC m ode. (For m ore in form ation , see
“MMC (MIDI Mach in e Con trol) Sen d” on page 192.)
PAIR/GROUP Key
Function Pages
1:CH PAIR
Includes parameters that enable you to...
Pa ir o d d -e ve n inp ut c ha nne ls.
Cre a te Mute Gro up s A, B, C
Cre a te Fa d e r Gro up s A, B, C
2:MUTE GROUP
3:FADER GROUP
[CH VIEW] Key
Th e Ch an n el View [CH VIEW] key displays a sequ en ce of th ree fu n c-
tion pages th at display settin gs for specific ch an n els, an d allow you
to copy ch an n el an d EQ settin gs from a sou rce ch an n el to destin a-
tion ch an n els.
Th e CH VIEW fu n ction page lets you view (bu t n ot m odify) settin gs for
specific ch an n els.
VM200 User’s Guide
25
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Th e CH COPY fu n ction page lets you copy ch an n el settin gs from a
sou rce ch an n el to on e or m ore destin ation ch an n els.
Th e EQ COPY fu n ction page lets you copy EQ settin gs from a sou rce
ch an n el to on e or m ore destin ation ch an n els.
CH VIEW Key
Function Pages
1:CH VIEW
Includes parameters that enable you to...
Vie w c ha nne l p a ra m e te r se tting s.
Co p y c ha nne l se tting s to o the r c ha nne ls.
Co p y EQ se tting s to o the r c ha nne ls.
2:CH COPY
3:EQ COPY
[CHANNEL/ METER] Key
Pressin g th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key displays two CHANNEL EDIT fu n c-
tion pages: Ch an n el Edit/ In pu t an d Ch an n el Edit/ Ou tpu t.
Th ese are essen tially th e “m ain ” pages of th e VM200, th e pages you
will likely display m ost often . However, u n like oth er fu n ction pages,
th e n am e of th e page does n ot appear on a CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction
page.
Th e n am e an d n u m ber of th e Cu rren t Scen e appear in th e top-left
corn er of th e display.
Th ese fu n ction pages en able you to view an d set th e pan position for
each ch an n el.
You can also view th e input levels for in pu t ch an n els 1-20.
Pressin g th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key a secon d tim e displays th e output
levels for th e ADAT, AUX, Effects, Record Bu ss, an d Stereo Bu ss ou t-
pu ts.
CHANNEL/METER Key
Function Pages
Includes parameters that enable you to...
1:CH EDIT (Inp ut)
Vie w inp ut le ve ls a nd se t p a n p o sitio ns.
Vie w o utp ut le ve ls a nd se t p a n p o sitio ns.
2:CH EDIT (Outp ut)
26
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fader Mode Section
Fader Mode Section
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
ADD.AUX
CHANNEL
Th e VM200 featu res 20 in pu t ch an n els an d 18 ou tpu t ch an n els.
However, with on ly eigh t faders plu s th e Master fader, th e VM200
m u st u se its faders for m u ltiple tasks to accom m odate all th ose
ch an n els.
Depen din g on th e Fader Mode, th e faders (as well as th e [ON], [SOLO],
an d [EQ EDIT] keys) con trol differen t fu n ction s. You determ in e wh ich
fu n ction s th e faders an d keys will con trol by selectin g a Fader Mode.
[AUX1], [AUX2], [AUX3], and [AUX4] Keys
If you press on e of th ese fu n ction keys, th e faders, th e Master fader,
[ON] an d [SOLO] keys con trol th e AUX sen d sign als. (To en able AUX3
an d AUX4 keys, tu rn on th e ADD. AUX param eter on th e CURRENT
SCENE STATUS fu n ction page. For m ore in form ation , see “En ablin g AUX
Sen ds 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX Param eter)” on page 115.)
[EFF1] and [EFF2] Keys
If you press on e of th ese fu n ction keys, th e faders, th e Master fader,
[ON] an d [SOLO] keys con trol th e EFF1 an d EFF2 sen d sign als.
[CHANNEL] Key
Th e [CHANNEL] key is som eth in g like a “Hom e” key. With th is key
selected, ch an n el con trols h an dle in pu t ch an n el sign als an d th e Mas-
ter con trols h an dle stereo ou t sign als.
VM200 User’s Guide
27
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Selected EQ Section
An equ alizer (EQ) en ables you to boost or cu t specific frequ en cy
ran ges to “sh ape” a sou n d.
Th e VM200 featu res a fou r -ban d param etric equ alizer for each in pu t
ch an n el. Each ban d featu res rotary con trols for Gain , Frequ en cy,
an d Q.
Th e LO-MID an d HI-MID ban ds u se param etric EQ. Th e LO ban d can
fu n ction as an HPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ; th e HI ban d can
fu n ction as an LPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ.
Th e Selected EQ section featu res th ree keys: an [EQ ON] key, an d
[STORE] an d [RECALL] keys for th e EQ Library.
For m ore in form ation on u sin g th e EQ, see EQ on page 75.
SELECTED EQ
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
RECALL
STORE
[EQ ON] Key
Th e [EQ ON] key en ables you to tu rn on or bypass th e equ alization
param eters selected via th e [EQ EDIT] keys.
EQ Library
Th e EQ Library stores sets of equ alization param eters as EQ pro-
gram s th at you can later recall.
Th e EQ Library featu res 50 preset EQ program s. You can store u p to
50 n ew EQ program s (in EQ Library location s 50 - 99).
[RECALL] Key
Pressin g th e [RECALL] key displays th e EQ LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction
page, wh ich en ables you to select from u p to 100 equ alization pro-
gram s (00 - 99).
Use th e Data Wh eel or [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to scroll th rou gh th e list,
an d press th e [ENTER] key to recall th e selected EQ program .
Th e lower h alf of th e fu n ction page displays th e pan an d fader set-
tin gs for each ch an n el.
[STORE] Key
Th e [STORE] key en ables you to create an d store n ew EQ program s.
On ce you ’ve worked on a m ix, adju stin g th e Gain , Frequ en cy, an d Q
param eters to you r satisfaction for all fou r ban ds of each ch an n el,
28
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Eff Edit Section
you m ay wish to store th e EQ settin gs for fu tu re recall.
Pressin g th e [STORE] key displays th e EQ LIBRARY STORE fu n ction page.
Use th e Data Wh eel to scroll th rou gh th e list to select th e location
(program n u m ber) wh ere you wan t to store th e n ew EQ program .
Press th e [ENTER] key to display th e EQ LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction
page, th en n am e th e EQ program .
Pressin g th e [ENTER] key again stores th e program in th e EQ Library
for fu tu re recall.
On e way to create a n ew EQ program is to select th e EQ program m ost
sim ilar to you r “target” EQ, th en m odify variou s param eters to scu lpt
th e respon se cu rve in to sh ape.
For m ore in form ation , see “Storin g EQ Program s” on page 86.
Eff Edit Section
Th e Eff Edit section featu res fou r keys: [EFF1], [EFF2], an d [STORE]
an d [RECALL] keys for th e Effect Library.
EFF EDIT
EFF1
EFF2
EFF LIBRARY
RECALL
STORE
[EFF1] and [EFF2] Keys
Th e [EFF1] an d [EFF2] keys in th e Eff Edit Section en able you to select
for editing th e effect th at is cu rren tly loaded in effect processor 1 or 2.
Not e: Do n ot con fu se th ese keys with th e keys in th e Fader Mode
section of th e sam e n am e.
Pressin g [EFF1] or [EFF2] displays an EFF EDIT fu n ction page th at
in clu des param eters related to th e cu rren t effect.
For exam ple, a Large Hall Reverb effect in clu des param eters for
Reverb Tim e, E/ R Balan ce, HPF, LPF, In itial Delay, PreDelay, Room
Size, etc. Th e 3D Ch oru s effect in clu des param eters for Depth , HPF,
an d LPF.
Effect Library
Th e Effect Library stores effects th at you can recall.
It featu res 50 preset effects an d effect com bin ation s. You can m odify
th e param eters for th ese existin g effects to create an d store an addi-
tion al 50 cu stom effect program s.
VM200 User’s Guide
29
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
[RECALL] Key
Pressin g th e [RECALL] key displays th e EFFECT LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction
page, wh ich en ables you to select from 50 preset effects program s
(00 - 49).
Use the Data Wheel or [</ -1] and [+1/ >] keys to scroll throu gh the list
or to select a program. Press the [ENTER] key to recall the Effect pro-
gram.
[STORE] Key
Th e [STORE] key en ables you to store you r own Effect program s in
on e of 50 u ser program location s (program n u m bers 50 -99).
On ce you ’ve edited effect param eters to you r satisfaction , you m ay
wish to store th em for fu tu re recall.
Press th e [STORE] key to display th e EFFECT LIBRARY STORE fu n ction
page.
Use th e Data Wh eel or [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to scroll th rou gh th e list
to select th e location (50–99) wh ere you wan t to store th e n ew effect
program .
Press th e [ENTER] key to display th e EFFECT LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction
page, th en n am e th e effect program .
Pressin g th e [ENTER] key again stores th e program in th e Effect
Library for fu tu re recall.
On e way to create a n ew Effect program is to select th e Effect program
m ost sim ilar to you r “target” effect, th en m odify variou s param eters
to scu lpt th e effect in to sh ape.
For m ore in form ation , see “Effects” on page 123.
Rec Buss Section
Th e Rec Bu ss section featu res on ly th e [SOLO] fu n ction key.
Th e VM200 also featu res [SOLO] keys for each ch an n el an d th e Mas-
ter fader. For m ore in form ation on th e Rec Bu ss [SOLO] keys, see
“Soloin g th e REC BUSS OUT” on page 113.
Th e REC BUSS is en abled on ly wh en th e ADD. AUX param eter is
tu rn ed off. For m ore in form ation , see “En ablin g AUX Sen ds 3 & 4
(ADD. AUX Param eter)” on page 115.
30
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[SOLO] Key
[SOLO] Key
REC BUSS
SOLO
Th e [SOLO] key in th e Rec Bu ss section en ables you to solo th e
Record Bu ss.
Scene Mem ory Section
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL
STORE
Th e Scen e Mem ory section in clu des [RECALL] an d [STORE] keys th at
en able you to recall scen es from m em ory an d store n ew scen es to
m em ory.
A “scen e” is a collection or “sn apsh ot” of virtu ally all th e param eter
settin gs of th e VM200 at a given poin t in tim e.
[RECALL] Key
Pressin g th e [RECALL] key displays th e SCENE MEMORY RECALL fu n ction
page.
You can u se th e Data Wh eel or [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to scroll
th rou gh th e list of stored an d preset scen es.
Press th e [RECALL] key again to recall th e scen e from m em ory an d
rem ain in Scen e Mem ory m ode, or press th e [ENTER] key to recall th e
scen e an d exit Scen e Mem ory m ode.
[STORE] Key
Th e [STORE] key en ables you to store scen es in Scen e Mem ory.
Pressin g th e [STORE] key displays th e SCENE MEMORY STORE fu n ction
page.
Press th e [ENTER] key to display th e SCENE MEMORY NAME EDIT fu n ction
page, th en n am e th e n ew Scen e Mem ory. Press th e [ENTER] key again
to store th e scen e in m em ory.
VM200 User’s Guide
31
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Channel Control Section
Th e VM200 featu res n in e 60m m m otorized
faders.
EQ/LO
GAIN
Faders 1 th rou gh 8 are associated with
separate [ON], [SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT] keys.
(Th e Master fader featu res on ly [ON] an d
[SOLO] keys.)
FREQ
Q
PAN
PAN
Faders 1 - 8 an d [ON], [SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT]
keys 1-8 typically con trol ch an n els 1
th rou gh 8. However, th ey can also con trol
ch an n els 9 th rou gh 16, an d 17 th rou gh 20,
depen din g on th e ch an n el layer you select
u sin g th e Page Select keys. (See th e “Fader
fu n ction ” table below.)
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
SOLO
ON
ON
Th e n in th fader is th e Master Fader.
Faders 1 - 8 an d [ON], [SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT]
keys also assign valu es to variou s fu n ction
page param eters.
You can also u se th e faders an d [ON],
[SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT] keys as MIDI con trol-
lers by settin g param eters on th e Con trol
Table fu n ction pages, wh ich are displayed
by th e Setu p [MIDI] fu n ction key.
+10
0
+10
0
-10
-20
-10
-20
Faders
Faders
-30
-40
-30
-40
Th e faders con trol differen t fu n ction s
depen din g on th e Fader Mode you select.
-
-
You select a Fader Mode by pressin g on e of
th e keys in th e Fader Mode section of th e
con trol su rface. Th e VM200 featu res seven
fader m odes: Ch an n el, Au x 1, Au x2, Au x3,
Au x4, Eff1, an d Eff2. (For m ore in form a-
on page 34.)
1
9
17
2
10
18
Faders 1 - 8 typically con trol th e ch an n el
gain ; th e Master Fader typically con trols
th e Stereo Bu ss Master gain .
However, in Fader Mode Au x1 for exam ple,
Fader 1 con trols th e ch an n el-to-Au x1 Sen d
gain . In Fader Mode Eff2, Fader 1 con trols
th e ch an n el-to-Eff2 Sen d gain , an d so on .
32
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Faders
Th e followin g table describes th e fu n ction of th e ch an n el faders an d
Master fader in each Fader Mode:
Fader function
CH
Input Channel
1–8 (ANALOG IN) | 9–16 (ADAT IN) | 17–20 (EFF RTN)
Channel Gain
Master
Mode
CHANNEL
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
ST BUSS Master Gain
AUX1 Send Master Gain
AUX2 Send Master Gain
AUX3 Send Master Gain
AUX4 Send Master Gain
EFF1 Send Master Gain
EFF2 Send Master Gain
Channel to AUX1 Send Gain
Channel to AUX2 Send Gain
Channel to AUX3 Send Gain
Channel to AUX4 Send Gain
Channel to EFF1 Send Gain
Channel to EFF2 Send Gain
EFF2
VM200 User’s Guide
33
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
EQ/LO
GAIN
[ON], [SOLO], & [EQ EDIT] Keys
Th e VM200 featu res eigh t sets of [ON],
[SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT] keys, on e set for each
ch an n el fader.
FREQ
Q
Th e Master fader also featu res a [SOLO] key
an d an [ON] key.
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
Th e followin g paragraph s su m m arize th e
fu n ction s of th ese keys.
EQ Edit keys
SOLO
SOLO
Solo keys
On keys
[ON] Keys
ON
ON
Th e [ON] keys basically tu rn ch an n els on an d
off.
In Ch an n el Fader Mode, th e ch an n el [ON]
keys tu rn ch an n els 1-8, 9-16, or 17-20 on or
off, depen din g on th e ch an n el layer you select
(u sin g th e Page Select keys).
+10
0
+10
0
Th e Master [ON] key con trols variou s fu n c-
tion s depen din g on th e cu rren t Fader Mode.
In Fader Mode Au x1 for exam ple, [ON] key 1
tu rn s ch an n el 1 on an d off, an d th e Master
[ON] key tu rn s th e Au x1 Ou t on an d off. In
Fader Mode Eff2, On key 1 tu rn s ch an n el 1
on an d off, an d th e Master [ON] key tu rn s th e
Eff2 Master on an d off.
-10
-20
-10
-20
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
Th e [ON] keys can also tran sm it MMC com -
m an ds in MMC Sen d m ode. (For m ore in for -
m ation , see “MMC (MIDI Mach in e Con trol)
Sen d” on page 192.)
Th e followin g table describes th e fu n ction of
th e ch an n el an d Master [ON] keys in each
Fader Mode:
1
9
17
2
10
18
[ON] key function
CH
Input Channel
Master
Mode
CHANNEL
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
1–8 (ANALOG IN) 9–16 (ADAT IN) 17–20 (EFF RTN)
ST BUSS OUT ON/OFF
AUX1 OUT ON/OFF
AUX2 OUT ON/OFF
AUX3 OUT ON/OFF
AUX4 OUT ON/OFF
EFF1 Master ON/OFF
EFF2 Master ON/OFF
Channel ON/OFF
EFF2
34
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
[SOLO] Keys
[SOLO] Keys
Th e [SOLO] keys en able you to solo ch an n els for m on itorin g.
Th e Solo Mode param eter on th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction
page determ in es h ow sign als from each ch an n el will solo. Th ey can
solo in dividu ally (PFL, or pre-fader listen ) or after bein g m ixed
togeth er post-fader (M-SOLO, or m ix solo).
In Ch an n el Fader Mode, th e [SOLO] keys solo ch an n els 1-20, depen d-
in g on th e ch an n el layer you select u sin g th e Page Select keys.
Th e [SOLO] keys con trol variou s fu n ction s depen din g on th e cu rren t
Fader Mode. In Fader Mode Au x1 for exam ple, [SOLO] key 1 solos
ch an n el 1, an d th e Master [SOLO] key solos th e AUX1 Bu ss. In Fader
Mode Eff2, [SOLO] key 1 solos ch an n el 1, an d th e Master [SOLO] key
solos th e Eff2 Sen d Master.
Th e followin g table describes th e fu n ction of th e Ch an n el an d Master
[SOLO] keys in each Fader Mode:
[SOLO] key function
CH
Input Channel
Master
Mode
CHANNEL
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
1–8 (ANALOG IN) 9–16 (ADAT IN) 17–20 (EFF RTN)
ST BUSS Solo
AUX1 Solo
AUX2 Solo
Channel Solo
AUX3 Solo
AUX4 Solo
EFF1 Send Solo
EFF2 Send Solo
EFF2
VM200 User’s Guide
35
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
[EQ EDIT] Keys
Th e [EQ EDIT] keys en able you to select ch an n els for param eter edit-
in g.
Wh en you press an [EQ EDIT] key, th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT
fu n ction page for th e selected ch an n el (for exam ple, EQ EDIT CH2).
Th is fu n ction page in clu des param eters th at con trol a fou r -ban d
param etric equ alizer. Th e ban ds are LO, LO-MID, HI-MID, an d HI.
You can adju st th e equ alization by rotatin g th e [GAIN], [FREQ], an d
[Q] con trols for each ban d.
For m ore in form ation , refer to th e table below, wh ich describes th e
fu n ction of th e [EQ EDIT] key in differen t Fader Modes.
[EQ EDIT] key function
CH
Input Channel
Master
Mode
CHANNEL
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
1–8 (ANALOG IN) 9–16 (ADAT IN)
17–20 (EFF RTN)
Edits EQ for
Channels 1–8
(Disabled if
EQ Enable for
Channels 1–8 is
turned OFF.)
Edits EQ for
Channels 9–16
(Disabled if
EQ Enable for
Channels 9–16 is
turned OFF.)
Disabled
N/A
EFF2
EQ Section Rotary Controls
Th e VM200 EQ section is h orizon tally su bdivided in to fou r section s:
EQ-LO, EQ/ LO-MID, EQ/ HI-MID, an d EQ HI.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
Each ban d featu res th ree kn obs labelled Gain , Freq, an d Q th at con -
trol th e param etric equ alizer in EQ Edit m ode.
Th e Gain rotary con trol sets th e gain of th e in pu t pream ps.
Th e Freq rotary con trol specifies th e frequ en cy.
Th e Q rotary con trols adju st th e selectivity of a filter. A n arrow fre-
qu en cy ban d in dicates a h igh Q valu e; a wide frequ en cy ban d in di-
cates a low Q valu es. (In th e respon se cu rve, n otice h ow a bell-sh aped
cu rve grows wider as Q decreases.)
However, like m an y VM200 con trols, in oth er operation al m odes th e
EQ section kn obs serve m u ltiple pu rposes. For exam ple, in Ch an n el
Edit m ode, th e [FREQ] an d [Q] kn obs con trol th e ch an n els pan posi-
tion .
36
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Page Select Keys
Page Select Keys
Th e VM200 u ses a ch an n el-layer form at, in wh ich its n in e faders per -
form m u ltiple tasks to accom m odate 20 in pu t ch an n els.
You can im agin e th e VM200 as bein g divided in to th ree layers. Layer
1 provides access to Ch an n els 1 th rou gh 8, wh ich prim arily h an dle
th e an alog in pu ts. Layer 2 provides access to Ch an n els 9 th rou gh 16,
wh ich are u sed with ADAT-com patible system s. Layer 3 provides
access to Ch an n els 17-20, wh ich are u sed prim arily for effects
retu rn s.
You can u se th e Page Select keys to select an appropriate ch an n el
layer. Th e VM200 will display param eters appropriate for th e ch an n el
layer you specify.
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
Wh en you press a Page Select key, it ligh ts u p, an d th e oth er two Page
Select keys rem ain dark or flash in g.
Page Select Key
Channels Displayed
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
Channels 1 - 8 ANALOG IN
Channels 9 - 16 ADAT IN
Channels 17 - 20 EFFECT RETURN
VM200 User’s Guide
37
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Rear Panel
All in pu ts an d ou tpu ts on th e VM200 are con ven ien tly located on
th e rear pan el. Th e followin g paragraph s briefly describe each in pu t
an d ou tpu t.
PHONES
MONITOR OUT
2TRK IN
ST BUSS OUT
REC BUSS OUT
AUX SEND
INPUT
A
A
A
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
4
L
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
ADD.AUX SEND
4
3
2
1
CAUTION
WARNING:
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC
TO
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
SHOCK,DO NOT EXPOSE THIS EQUIPMENT
TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
+48V
+48V
+48V
+48V
RISQUE
DE CHOC ELECTRIQUE
NE PAS OUVRIR.
AVIS:
AC IN
S/P DIF
ADAT
MIDI
OUT
WORD
B
B
B
75
OPTICAL
POWER
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
THRU
IN
ON OFF
IN
OUT
INSERT
INSERT
INSERT
4
3
2
1
PHONES
Con n ect a pair of stereo h eadph on es to th is stereo (TRS) ph on e jack.
Set th e ou tpu t level u sin g th e PHONES Gain kn ob on th e top pan el.
MONITOR OUT
Con n ect th is pair of RCA ph on o jacks to th e in pu ts on you r m on itor -
in g am plifier.
Select th e m on itor sign al you wish to ou tpu t th rou gh th ese jacks
u sin g th e MON SEL param eter on th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n c-
Set th e ou tpu t level u sin g th e MONITOR Gain kn ob on th e top pan el.
2TRK In
You can in pu t a two-track sign al, su ch as th e stereo ou tpu ts from a
m aster recorder, to th is pair of RCA ph on o jacks for con fiden ce m on -
itorin g.
Press th e 2TRK IN switch on th e top pan el to m on itor th e sign al.
ST BUSS OUT
Th e Stereo Bu ss Ou t (ST BUSS OUT) is a pair of u n balan ced
1/ 4-in ch ph on e jacks th at ou tpu ts th e left an d righ t ch an n els of th e
m ain stereo m ix.
REC BUSS OUT
Th e Rec Bu ss Ou t (REC BUSS OUT) is a pair of u n balan ced
1/ 4-in ch ph on e jacks th at ou tpu ts th e record bu ss.
Wh en th e ADD. AUX param eter is tu rn ed on , th e REC BUSS OUT
ou tpu ts Au x Sen ds 3 an d 4.
38
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Rear Panel
AUX SEND
AUX SEND 1 an d 2 are a pair of u n balan ced 1/ 4-in ch ph on e jacks
th at can ou tpu t an au xiliary sign al to drive extern al effects, for
exam ple.
Inputs 1 - 4: XLR or Phone Connectors (A or B)
In pu t ch an n els 1 - 4 accept eith er balan ced XLR in pu ts (XLR-3-32
type), or balan ced/ u n balan ced (1/ 4-in ch ) ph on e plu gs. (In pu t 1-4
Ph on es con n ectors accept eith er balan ced or u n balan ced an alog
in pu t.)
If you are in sertin g a ph on e plu g, press th e A/ B switch for ch an n els
1 th rou gh 4 to select th e B in pu ts.
If you are in sertin g an XLR-type plu g, leave th e A/ B switch
“u n pressed” to select th e A in pu ts. You can switch ph an tom power to
th e XLR con n ectors on or off u sin g switch es located ben eath each
con n ector. (Man y con den ser m icroph on es, for exam ple, requ ire ph an -
tom power.)
Th ese in pu ts h ave a n om in al in pu t ran ge of -60 dB to +10 dB.
+48 Phantom Power
Tu rn on th is switch for XLR m icroph on es or devices con n ected to
XLR in pu ts th at requ ire ph an tom power.
Inputs 5 - 8: Phone Connectors
In pu t ch an n els 5 th rou gh 8 accept u n balan ced ph on e plu gs.
Th ese in pu ts are design ed for u se with lin e-level sou rces (e.g., a syn -
th esizer keyboards, effects processors, or oth er devices).
Th ese in pu ts h ave a n om in al in pu t ran ge of -60 dB to +10 dB.
Inserts 1-4: Phone Connectors
Th e In sert con n ectors are stereo-type ph on e jacks.
You can con n ect an extern al effects u n it to th ese con n ectors u sin g an
in sert cable to sen d th e sign al to th e effects u n it an d retu rn it to th e
VM200. (For m ore in form ation , see “In sert Ch an n els 1–4” on page 62.)
Th e In sert con n ectors allow you to in sert a sign al in to th e sign al ch ain
after th e PAD switch es an d TRIM kn obs.
AC In
In sert th e fem ale en d of th e AC power cable in to th is con n ector. Con -
n ect th e m ale en d to an AC electrical ou tlet of th e appropriate voltage
for you r area.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
39
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
Power Sw itch
Use th e power switch to tu rn th e VM200 on an d off.
S/ P DIF IN/ OUT
Th ese are S/ P DIF form at optical digital con n ectors. You can con -
n ect an y S/ P DIF equ ipped device (su ch as certain CD players, DAT
recorders, or com pu ter sou n dcards) to th ese con n ectors.
For m ore in form ation , see “S/ P DIF IN/ OUT” on page 168.
ADAT IN/ OUT
Th ese are Alesis ADAT Mu ltich an n el Optical Digital In terface con -
n ectors. You can con n ect an 8-track digital m u ltitrack recorder,
su ch as a Fostex VR-800 or oth er ADAT-com patible recorder, to
th ese con n ectors.
For m ore in form ation , see “ADAT IN/ OUT” on page 165.
MIDI IN, OUT,THRU
Th ese stan dard MIDI ports en able you to con n ect th e VM200 to
oth er MIDI devices. Th e MIDI IN port receives MIDI m essages. Th e
MIDI OUT port ou tpu ts MIDI m essages. Th e MIDI THRU port ou t-
pu ts all MIDI m essages received by th e MIDI IN port.
75Ω On, Off Sw itch
Th is switch tu rn s WORD IN term in ation on an d off. If th e VM200 is
th e last device to receive word clock via th e WORD IN con n ection ,
tu rn th is term in ation switch on .
WORD IN/ OUT
Th e Word In an d Ou t con n ectors are con n ected to th e WORD OUT
an d IN con n ectors of digital devices to receive an d sen d word clock
in form ation for digital syn c operation .
40
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Block Diagram
Block Diagram
VM200 User’s Guide
41
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Touring the VM200
42
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 3
Getting Started
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter is design ed to h elp get you started qu ickly u sin g you r
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
VM200.
ON
AN
P
It explain s h ow to plu g in th e power cord, con n ect to an am plifier,
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
plu g in a m icroph on e or oth er sou rce, tu rn on th e VM200, adju st a
FREQ
SOLO
few con trols, try ou t som e EQ settin gs an d Effect presets, an d record
AN
P
ON
a stereo sign al to an extern al recorder.
EQ EDIT
Q
0
However, please read th e Preca utions , “In trodu cin g th e VM200” on
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
page 9 an d “Tou rin g th e VM200” on page 17 before you “get started.”
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
Chapter Contents
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
5
13
SOLO
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
43
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
VM200 System Exam ple
Th e followin g illu stration sh ows on e exam ple of a recordin g stu dio
based on th e VM200.
Monitor speakers
DAT
ADAT compatible
Monitor amplifier
Master recorder
Headphones
Guitar processor
Lead guitar
ANALOG IN
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
26dB
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
Guitar processor
Second guitar
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
PAIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
ON
ON
ON
Bass processor
Bass guitar
FADER MODE
/-1
+1/
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-10
-20
-10
-10
-20
-10
-20
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
ADAT IN
EFF RTN
MASTER
MIDI keyboard
Vocal
Chorus
MIDI
Interface
Drums
44
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting the Power Cord
Connecting the Power Cord
Warn in g: Tu rn off th e power to all connected electron ic equ ipm en t
before m akin g any connections to the VM200.
Use th e in clu ded power cord to con n ect th e VM200 to an appropriate
AC electrical ou tlet. In sert th e fem ale en d in to th e AC in pu t on th e
rear pan el of th e VM200. In sert th e m ale en d in to a wall ou tlet of an
appropriate voltage for you r area.
Turning the VM200 On and Off
Th e power bu tton is located on th e rear pan el of th e VM200 n ext to
th e AC power cable in pu t jack. Wh en you power on you r au dio com -
pon en ts, be certain to follow th is sequ en ce to preven t dam age to you r
equ ipm en t:
1. Con n ect all in st ru m en t s an d sou n d sou rces, in clu din g k ey-
boards, dru m m ach in es, et c.
2. Tu rn on t h e power t o all sou n d sou rces.
3. Tu rn on t h e power t o t h e VM2 0 0 by depressin g t h e power bu t -
t on on t h e rear pan el.
Th e VM200 displays th e Fostex an d VM200 logos, th en th e CHAN-
NEL EDIT fu n ction page. (For m ore in form ation on th e CHANNEL EDIT
4. Mak e su re t h e volu m e on you r m on it or am plifi er is n ot set t oo
lou d, t h en t u rn on t h e power t o t h e m on it or am plifi er.
Wh en you tu rn off th e power to th e VM200, be su re to follow th is
sequ en ce in reverse. (Th at is, first tu rn off th e m on itor am plifier, th en
th e VM200, th en th e sou n d sou rces.)
VM200 User’s Guide
45
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
A Few Tips on Using the VM200
If you h ave experien ce u sin g an alog au dio m ixers, a few th in gs abou t
th e VM200 Digital Recordin g Mixer m ay be n ew to you . Th is section
in trodu ces som e of th e advan tages of workin g with a digital m ixer.
Channel Layers
If a con ven tion al an alog m ixin g con sole h as 16 or 24 in pu t ch an n els,
it also likely h as16 or 24 faders, th e sam e n u m ber of [ON] keys an d
[SOLO] keys, etc. Each in pu t ch an n el is a com plete m odu le, with its
own dedicated set of in pu t con n ector, pream p, etc. Th is type of
design can work well, bu t is redu n dan t an d su bject to an alog n oise.
Th e VM200 is a digita l recordin g m ixer, an d does n ot con form to an a-
log recordin g con ven tion s.
Th e VM200 u ses an in n ovative “ch an n el layerin g” system th at
en ables you to con trol u p to 20 ch an n els u sin g on ly eigh t faders an d
on e Master Fader.
You press on e of th ree Page Select keys to specify th e active ch an n el
layer. Th e faders, rotary con trols, an d variou s keys th en con trol a
ch an n el on th e selected layer, an d th e LCD Display sh ows param eters
specific to th e selected layer.
For exam ple, Fader 1 can con trol in pu t ch an n els 1, 9, or 17 depen d-
in g on th e selected ch an n el layer. (It can also con trol variou s sen d lev-
els, depen din g on th e cu rren t m ixer rou tin g.)
You can select on e of th e followin g layers by pressin g th e appropriate
Page Select key:
• Ch an n els 1 - 8 An alog In
• Ch an n els 9 - 16 ADAT In
• Ch an n els 17 - 20 Eff Rtn
46
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Channel Layers
Th e followin g diagram illu strates th e th ree ch an n el layers of th e
VM200:
The [1–8 ANALOG IN] key is lit.
You can control channels 1–8.
17-20 EFF RTN
EQ/HI
GAIN
AGE SELECT IN
P
T
9-16 ADA
Q
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
FREQ
IN
N
PA
1-8 ANALOG
Q
N
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
PA
FREQ
N
PA
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
Q
EQ/LO
GAIN
SOLO
N
PA
EQ EDIT
FREQ
N
PA
EQ EDIT
Q
ON
N
PA
EQ EDIT
FREQ
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
SOLO
EQ EDIT
ON
ON
SOLO
+10
ON
0
+10
0
+10
-10
0
+10
-10
-20
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
The [9–16 ADAT IN] key is lit.
You can control channels 9–16.
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-30
-20
-
-40
17-20 EFF RTN
-30
EQ/HI
-
-40
GAIN
AGE SELECT
P
T
IN
-
ADA
9-16
Q
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
FREQ
N
PA
ANALOG IN
1-8
Q
N
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ EDIT
PA
FREQ
N
PA
EQ EDIT
Q
EQ/LO
GAIN
SOLO
N
PA
EQ EDIT
FREQ
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
Q
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
ANALOG IN
-10
ON
N
PA
SOLO
EQ EDIT
FREQ
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
ON
SOLO
EQ EDIT
ON
ON
SOLO
+10
ON
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
-10
-20
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
The [17–20 EFF RTN] key is lit.
You can control channels 17–20.
-20
-
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-30
-20
-
-40
-30
-
-40
-
17-20 EFF RTN
EQ/HI
GAIN
AGE SELECT
IN
ADA
P
T
9-16
Q
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
FREQ
N
PA
ANALOG IN
1-8
Q
N
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
PA
FREQ
N
PA
EQ EDIT
Q
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
T IN
EQ/LO
GAIN
SOLO
N
PA
EQ EDIT
FREQ
N
PA
EQ EDIT
Q
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
ADA
FREQ
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
N
SOLO
PA
EQ EDIT
ON
SOLO
EQ EDIT
ON
ON
SOLO
+10
ON
0
+10
0
+10
-10
0
+10
-10
-20
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
+10
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
0
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-10
-30
-20
-
-40
-30
-20
-
-40
-30
-
-40
-
17 18 19 20
EFF RTN
VM200 User’s Guide
47
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Keeping It Digital
Man y h om e stu dios or project stu dios th ese days record to digital
au dio tape or h ard disk recordin g system s, bu t lackin g a digital
m ixer, th ey are forced to m ix tracks u sin g a con ven tion al an alog
m ixer. Th is can actu ally add color an d warm th to som e tracks, bu t
is likely to in trodu ce n oise in to th e sign al ch ain .
On ce an in stru m en t or sin ger’s voice h as been con verted to digital
au dio by an an alog-to-digital (A/ D) con verter, it is gen erally best to
leave th e recordin g in th e digital dom ain . Ru n n in g th e sign al back
an d forth th rou gh A/ D an d D/ A con verters, regardless of th e qu ality
of th e con verters, u n n ecessarily redu ces th e overall qu ality of th e sig-
n al, an d h en ce th e fin al recordin g.
With th e VM200, you can record an d m ixdown en tirely in th e digital
dom ain . Th is m ay m ake a dram atic im provem en t in th e qu ality of
you r fin al recordin gs.
An Im portant Note About Word Clock Inform ation
Before you can tran sfer digital au dio from on e device to an oth er, th e
digital au dio equ ipm en t m u st be word clock syn ch ron ized, or tim in g
problem s m ay resu lt.
For exam ple, if you are recordin g to an oth er digital device, su ch as an
ADAT, DAT, or digital m u ltitracker, you m u st syn ch ron ize all digital
com pon en ts in you r recordin g system to a com m on word clock
sou rce.
If th e VM200 is th e on ly digital com pon en t in you r recordin g system ,
you do n ot n eed to adju st an y word clock settin gs.
However, if you are u sin g oth er digital au dio com pon en ts, please refer
to “Digital Con n ection s, Word Clocks, an d Sam ple Rates” on
page 160 for m ore in form ation on syn ch ron izin g to a com m on word
clock sou rce.
Stopless Rotary Controls
Th e VM200 u ses th e 12 rotary con trols (also kn own as th e Gain ,
Freq, an d Q con trols) to adju st valu es for several differen t param e-
ters, depen din g on th e cu rren tly-selected fu n ction page.
Un like con ven tion al an alog con trol kn obs, th e rotary con trols on th e
VM200 are stopless; you can rotate th em righ t or left en dlessly.
In th is way, th e kn obs can m ore easily accom m odate a broad ran ge
of param eter valu es.
48
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Lower and Raise Faders to Initiate Sends
Lower and Raise Faders to Initiate Sends
If on occasion you th in k you h ave con figu red th e VM200 to sen d a
particu lar sign al to a bu ss, bu t you u n expectedly can n ot h ear th e
ou tpu t, try brin gin g th e fader down an d raisin g it back u p to th e
desired level to in itiate th e sen d.
Th is m ay seem u n u su al if you are u sed to an alog m ixers, bu t it is part
of th e ch an n el layer stru ctu re of th e VM200. Becau se th e faders can
con trol m u ltiple fu n ction s depen din g on th e displayed fu n ction page,
you m ay n eed to lower an d raise th e faders to set n ew levels wh en you
ch an ge Fader Modes.
For exam ple, after you set th e level of ch an n els 19 an d 20 for an effect
retu rn , if you wish to set th e effect sen d level on ch an n el 3, you m ay
n eed to lower th e Ch an n el 3 an d Master faders on ce, th en raise th em
to set th e desired level.
Reading the Display
Th e LCD Display featu res a resolu tion of 256 x 64 dots. It can dis-
play n u m erical param eter valu es, an d u ses graph ic icon s to repre-
sen t fader position s an d rotary con trol settin gs.
Th is section sh ows a few sam ple fu n ction pages an d explain s com m on
icon s an d in dicators.
The Channel Edit Function Page
Wh en ever you tu rn on th e power to th e VM200 or press th e
[CHANNEL/ METER] key or th e [EXIT] key, th e VM200 displays th e
CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
Th ere are actu ally two version s of th e Ch an n el Edit page. On e version
sh ows th e in pu ts; th e oth er version sh ows th e ou tpu ts. (Th e Ch an n el
Edit/ In pu t version is sh own below.)
Wh en you see th is fu n ction page, th e VM200 is in Ch an n el Edit m ode.
You can th in k of th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction pages as a type of “h om e”
page.
scene program number
scene title
selected EQ
input channel meters
ADD.AUX or Rec Buss
channel number
master fader level
channel pan settings
channel fader levels
VM200 User’s Guide
49
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Exam ples of Other Function Pages
Th e n am e of th e fu n ction page appears in th e u pper -left corn er.
Note h ow th e fader icon s look like little faders on th e followin g CHANNEL
VIEW (CH VIEW) fu n ction page.
Function Page Name
Level indicator
Fader icons show
fader position.
You u se th e [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d [ON] keys to toggle two-state in di-
cators. Th ese in dicators are represen ted on th e display by sm all rect-
an gles.
An em pty rectan gle in dicates th at th e param eter or option is tu rn ed
“off.” A “filled” or solid dark rectan gle in dicates an “on ” settin g. (Th is
m an u al also refers to darken ed in dicators as “h igh ligh ted,” ju st to
con fu se th e tou rists.)
Empty rectangle means “off”
Filled or dark rectangle means “on”
Function Page Param eter Matrix
Th e display frequ en tly arran ges th e param eters on a fu n ction page
in a m atrix.
On e su ch m atrix displays fou r rectan gles in a h orizon tal row, with
each rectan gle con tain in g a param eter. Ben eath th is appears an oth er
row, wh ich con tain s eigh t rectan gles, as illu strated below.
On su ch a fu n ction page, th e fou r Gain rotary con trols adju st param -
eters in th e top row, an d th e Freq an d Q rotary con trols adju st th e
param eters in th e bottom row.
50
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Lit & Flashing LED Keys
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
For example, use the EQ/LO Gain rotary control
to turn the CH FADER parameter on and off.
Use the EQ/HI-MID Freq rotary control
to turn the EFF1 parameter on and off.
Lit & Flashing LED Keys
Man y of th e keys on th e con trol su rface of th e VM200 are tran slu -
cen t an d fixed in position over an LED ligh t th at can provide statu s
in form ation .
In gen eral, th ese keys flash wh en th ey are available for selection , an d
ligh t u p con tin u ou sly wh en th ey are selected. (Don ’t be alarm ed th e
first tim e you press th e Rou tin g fu n ction key an d a cou ple dozen
ligh ts start flash in g! Th is is n orm al.)
LED Condition Meaning
dark
flashing
lit
off, deselected
available for selection
on, selected
VM200 User’s Guide
51
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Finally...Let’s Get Started!
Th e followin g procedu re lets you try ou t som e of th e capabilities of
you r VM200. To sim plify th e explan ation , in th is procedu re we will
con n ect a m icroph on e to ch an n el 1, adju st th e EQ, apply effects, an d
record th e sign al.
Making Connections
Th is procedu re assu m es th at you h ave in stalled an d powered on th e
VM200. (See page 45 for m ore in form ation .)
1. Con n ect a m icroph on e, in st ru m en t , or ot h er sou n d sou rce t o
in pu t ch an n el 1 .
You can con n ect eith er:
• a balan ced XLR-type con den ser m icroph on e to in pu t ch an n el 1,
con n ector A, an d leave th e In pu t A/ B selector bu tton on th e top
pan el u n pressed; or
• a balan ced/ u n balan ced TRS-type m icroph on e to in pu t ch an n el
1, con n ector B, an d depress th e In pu t A/ B selector bu tton .
However, you can u se an oth er sou n d sou rce, su ch as a syn th e-
sizer keyboard or CD player, if you desire. Make su re it is powered
off before you con n ect it to th e VM200.
INPUT
XLR-type connector (A)
A
A
A
4
3
2
1
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
+48V
+48V
+48V
+48V
B
B
B
1/4” phone connector (B)
INSERT
INSERT
INSERT
4
3
2
1
2. Con n ect t h e VM2 0 0 MONITOR OUT t o an am plifi er an d
speak ers, or con n ect a pair of st ereo h eadph on es t o t h e
PHONES jack .
You can u se th e Mon itor Gain or Ph on es Gain kn obs to adju st th e
ou tpu t volu m e level. Lower th e Gain to m in im u m to preven t lou d
n oise.
MONITOR OUT
PHONES
PHONES
MONITOR OUT
2TRK IN
ST BUSS OUT
REC BUSS OUT
AUX SEND
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
4
L
3
2
1
ADD.AUX SEND
3. Con n ect t h e ST BUSS OUT t o t h e an alog in pu t s of a recorder.
Even th ou gh th e VM200 is a digital m ixer design ed prim arily for
u se with digital m u ltitrack recorders, to sim plify th is brief proce-
du re, we will con n ect to an an alog recorder.
52
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Powering On
If you prefer, you can con n ect a DAT to th e S/ P DIF OUT or an
ADAT-com patible recorder to th e ADAT OUT con n ectors. (For
m ore in form ation , see “Digital Con n ection s” on page 159.).
If you ju st wan t to try ou t th e EQ an d som e effects, you can skip
th is step (step 3) altogeth er.
4. Lower all faders an d Gain an d Trim k n obs on t h e VM2 0 0 .
Powering On
5. Press t h e Power bu t t on on t h e rear pan el t o t u rn on t h e power
t o t h e VM2 0 0 .
Th e VM200 ban n er scrolls, all keys flash , th en th e VM200 dis-
plays th e CHANNEL EDIT/ INPUT fu n ction page.
Th e [1–8 ANALOG IN] Page Select key ligh ts u p red. All [ON] keys,
th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key, an d th e [CHANNEL] key ligh t u p green .
6. Tu rn on t h e m icroph on e (or ot h er con n ect ed sou n d sou rce),
t h en t u rn on t h e power t o t h e am plifi er.
If you are u sin g an XLR-type con den ser m icroph on e con n ected to
th e XLR in pu t, tu rn on th e +48 ph an tom power to th e m icroph on e
u sin g th e ph an tom power switch on th e rear pan el.
Adjusting the Channel Input
Make su re th at th e [ON] keys for ch an n el 1 an d Master are lit. If n ot,
press th e [ON] keys to tu rn th em on .
Also, m ake su re th at th e 2TRK IN bu tton is NOT depressed.
7. Wh ile t alk in g or sin gin g in t o t h e m icroph on e (or playin g an
alt ern at e sou n d sou rce), adju st t h e ch an n el 1 Trim con t rol,
an d raise t h e ch an n el 1 fader an d t h e Mast er fader.
Notice th e m ovem en t in th e level m eter for in pu t ch an n el 1 on th e
LCD Display, an d in th e ST BUSS LED m eter to th e righ t of th e
display.
Adju st th e in pu t ch an n el level so th at th e m eter will n ot reach th e
“OL” (overload) level.
8. Raise t h e m on it orin g level u sin g t h e Mon it or Gain con t rol for
con n ect ed m on it orin g speak ers, or t h e Ph on es Gain con t rol
for con n ect ed h eadph on es.
Set th is to th e desired listen in g level.
VM200 User’s Guide
53
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Adjusting the EQ
9. Press t h e ch an n el 1 [EQ EDIT] k ey.
Th e [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p oran ge, an d th e [EQ ON] key in th e
Selected EQ section ligh ts u p green .
If th e [EQ ON] key is n ot lit, press th e key to tu rn it on .
Th e followin g EQ EDIT fu n ction page appears.
10. Use t h e EQ Gain , Freq, an d Q rot ary con t rols t o adju st t h e
ch an n el 1 EQ.
Each trio of rotary con trols adju sts th e EQ in a separate fre-
qu en cy ban d. Use all 12 rotary con trols to adju st th e ch an n el 1
EQ in each of th e fou r ban ds.
For exam ple, watch th e respon se cu rve swell as you raise th e
EQ/ HI-MID Gain , as illu strated in figu res A an d B below.
A
B
the response curve swells when Gain is raised
54
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Adjusting the EQ
If you lower th e Freq, th e soft bell-sh aped cu rve in Figu re B wou ld
m ove to th e left, as illu strated in Figu re C:
C
In Figu res D an d E below, n otice h ow th e frequ en cy ran ge ch an ges
an d th e respon se cu rve sh arpen s an d n arrows as th e EQ/ HI-MID
Q valu e is raised.
D
E
You can store EQ settin gs in a program , or you can recall a preset
EQ program . Refer to “EQ” on page 75 for m ore in form ation .
VM200 User’s Guide
55
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
Audition Som e Effects
Let’s apply som e effects from th e Eff2 effect processor to th e sign al.
11. Press t h e [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit sect ion .
Th e [EFF2] key ligh ts u p oran ge an d th e VM200 displays th e EFF
EDIT fu n ction page.
12. Press t h e [RECALL] k ey in t h e Eff Library sect ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e followin g EFFECT LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction
page, an d th e [EFF2] key flash es.
13. Use t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [>/ -1 ] an d [+1 / <] k eys t o scroll or
st ep t h rou gh t h e effect s list an d select an effect program .
Try som eth in g like th e Mon o Delay or a Large Hall Reverb.
14. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e select ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF EDIT fu n ction page.
15. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
56
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recording
16. Press t h e [1 7 –2 0 EFF RTN] Page Select k ey.
Th e [1–8 ANALOG IN] key LED tu rn s off an d th e [17–20 EFF RTN] key
ligh ts u p red.
17. Mak e su re t h at t h e [ON] k eys for ch an n els 1 9 an d 2 0 are lit ,
an d lower t h en raise t h e faders for ch an n els 1 9 an d 2 0 t o set
t h e effect s ret u rn ch an n el level.
You m u st lower th en raise th e faders to set th e retu rn level.
EFF1 is rou ted to EFF RTN 17 an d 18, an d EFF2 is rou ted to EFF
RTN 19 an d 20.
18. Mak e su re t h at t h e Mast er [ON] k ey is lit , t h en raise t h e Mas-
t er fader t o set t h e effect s ret u rn m ast er level.
19. Press t h e [1 –8 ANALOG IN] Page Select k ey.
Th e [17–20 EFF RTN] key LED tu rn s off an d th e [1–8 ANALOG IN]
Page Select key ligh ts u p.
20. Press t h e [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion .
Th e [EFF2] key flash es oran ge an d th e [AUX2] key flash es red in th e
Fader Mode section . (Don ’t worry abou t th e flash in g [AUX2] key for
th e m om en t.)
21. Lower t h en raise t h e ch an n el 1 fader an d t h e Mast er fader t o
set t h e desired effect s sen d sign al level.
As you raise th e faders, you sh ou ld h ear th e effect.
You can also edit an d store effects settin gs. Refer to “Effects” on
page 123 for m ore in form ation .
Of cou rse, you can con n ect oth er in stru m en ts to oth er an alog ch an -
n els, or con n ect a DAT or CD player to th e S/ P DIF In con n ector for
m ixdown an d recordin g.
Recording
22. Set u p you r con n ect ed recorder accordin gly an d press t h e
REC an d PLAY bu t t on on t h e recorder t o begin recordin g.
You can n ow record you r perform an ce to th e recorder.
To ch eck th e in pu t an d ou tpu t levels of th e VM200, press th e
[CHANNEL/ METER] key to toggle between th e in pu t an d ou tpu t
m eters.
Storing a Mix Scene
On ce you are satisfied with th e m ix settin gs, you can save th em as a
scen e “sn apsh ot” in th e VM200’s Scen e Mem ory. You can also recall
an d edit th ese scen es later. Please refer to “Scen e Mem ory” on
page 147 for m ore in form ation .
VM200 User’s Guide
57
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Getting Started
58
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 4
Input Channels
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter provides an overview of th e VM200’s in pu t ch an n els,
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
in clu din g ph an tom power, rou tin g, pairin g, grou pin g, copyin g
ON
AN
P
ch an n el settin gs, an d m ore.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Chapter Contents
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
In sert Ch an n els 1–4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
Pad Switch es (In pu t ch an n els 1–4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
TRIM Con trols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
-30
-40
0
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
59
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Input Channels 1–4
Th ere are two sets of an alog con n ectors for In pu t Ch an n els 1 - 4.
Th e “A” set accepts XLR-type in pu ts (balan ced); th e “B” set accepts
ph on e jacks (balan ced or u n balan ced).
Th e XLR con n ectors are XLR-3-32-type in pu ts. Th e ph on e jacks are
1/ 4-in ch TRS-type.
Both XLR an d ph on e jack in pu ts accept a n om in al in pu t ran ge of
–60 dB to +10 dB.
INPUT
XLR inputs
A
A
A
4
3
2
1
phantom power switch
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
+48V
+48V
+48V
+48V
phone jack inputs
inserts
B
B
B
INSERT
INSERT
INSERT
4
3
2
1
Not e: Before you set th e INPUT A/ B switch for in pu t ch an n els 1-4, lower
th e correspon din g TRIM control to th e m in im u m , or you will h ear a clickin g
n oise.
Not e: Before you tu rn on ph an tom power, lower th e TRIM control for th e
correspon din g in pu t ch an n el to th e m inim u m , or tu rn off th e power to th e
VM200.
Not e: Tu rn off th e correspon din g ph an tom power switch before you con n ect
a dynam ic m icroph on e; oth erwise, you m ay dam age th e m icroph on e. If you
tu rn on th e power to the VM200 wh ile th e in pu t ch an n el’s ph an tom power
switch is tu rn ed on , th e VM200 displays a warn in g m essage: “Warn in g! +48V
SW ON!”
60
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Phantom Power for Input Channels 1–4
Phantom Power for Input Channels 1–4
Th e VM200 su pplies option al ph an tom power (+48 V) to th e XLR con -
n ectors. You can tu rn th e ph an tom power on or off u sin g th e switch es
on th e rear pan el as sh own in th e figu re above.
Caut ion : Tu rn on the phantom power only after you connect a balanced XLR
com ponent (su ch as a condenser m icrophone) to the XLR inpu t connector.
Specify th e con n ector you wish to u se by pressin g (or n ot pressin g) th e
A/ B in pu t selectors on th e top pan el (sh own in th e figu re below). Th e
A settin g (u n pressed) selects th e XLR in pu t con n ector; th e B settin g
(depressed) selects th e ph on e jack in pu t con n ector.
INPUT 1
INPUT 2
INPUT 3
INPUT 4
A/B Input selector
A
A
A
A
B
B
PAD
26dB
B
PAD
26dB
B
PAD
26dB
PAD
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
+10
+10
+10
+10
Input Channels 5–8
In pu t ch an n els 5–8 accept on ly u n balan ced ph on e jacks. (Th ese con -
n ectors do n ot accept XLR in pu ts or balan ced an alog in pu ts.)
For m ore in form ation , see “Rear Pan el” on page 38.
Input Channels 9–16
In addition to th e an alog sign als you can in pu t to ch an n els 1
th rou gh 8, you can assign digital ADAT in pu ts to ch an n els 9-16.
Refer to “Digital Con n ection s” on page 159 for m ore in form ation .
Input Channels 17–20
In pu t ch an n els 17–20 are u sed for in tern al effect retu rn s from th e
EFF1 or EFF2 effects processor.
VM200 User’s Guide
61
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Insert Channels 1–4
You can use a Y-shaped insert cable to connect the VM200 to an
external effects processor. The signal flows out of the VM200 Insert
connector, into and out of the effects processor, and back into the
VM200 via the insert cable.
Tip (Send)
from VM200 to Effects processor
Ring (Return)
from Effects processor to VM200
The Insert connectors allow you to insert a signal into the signal
chain after the PAD switches and TRIM knobs.
INPUT
A
A
A
4
3
2
1
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
ON
OFF
+48V
+48V
+48V
+48V
B
B
B
to FX
INSERT
INSERT
INSERT
from FX
4
3
2
1
INSERT connectors 1-4
62
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Pad Switches (Input channels 1–4)
Pad Sw itches (Input channels 1–4)
In pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 4 featu re 26 dB Pad switch es th at atten u -
ate th e in pu t sign al by 26 dB.
Th is allows th e in pu t pream p to work with h ot, h igh -level sign als,
su ch as th ose from a sn are dru m m icroph on e.
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
PAD
26dB
26dB
26dB
Not e: Pad switch settin gs are n ot stored in Scen e Mem ory.
TRIM Controls
You can adju st th e gain of th e in pu t ch an n el pream ps on in pu t ch an -
n els 1 th rou gh 4 by u sin g th e Trim con trols. You r goal is to optim ize
the in pu t sign al level to ach ieve the best signal-to-noise ratio.
Keep a close eye on th e level m eters wh ile adju stin g th e Trim con trols.
In gen eral, set th e levels as h igh as possible with ou t peakin g (actu ally,
it’s okay if th e level occa s iona lly peaks a little). If you set th e level too
h igh , th e sign al m ay distort an d or clip. If it’s set too low, th e ou tpu t
sign al m ay sou n d th in or n oisy.
INPUT 1
INPUT 2
INPUT 3
INPUT 4
INPUT 5
INPUT 6
INPUT 7
INPUT 8
A
A
A
A
B
B
PAD
26dB
B
PAD
26dB
B
PAD
PAD
26dB
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
-60
-34
-16
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-60
-34
-16
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
+10
+10
+10
+10
VM200 uses “boxed” values
when Pad switch is depressed.
Th e Trim con trols h ave an in pu t sen sitivity of –16 dB to –60 dB,
wh ich is appropriate for m an y m icroph on es. However, you can press
on e of th e Pad switch es for ch an n els 1–4 to redu ce th e in pu t sen sitiv-
ity for th at ch an n el to th e ran ge of +10 to –34 dB. Th is works well for
“h ot” m icroph on e sign als.
Th e Trim con trols on in pu t ch an n els 5–8 h ave a gain ran ge of –10 dB
to –50 dB. Th is works well with lin e-level sign als.
Not e: Trim con trol settin gs are n ot stored in Scen e Mem ory.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
63
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Inverting the Input Phase
“Ph ase” con cern s th e tim in g of two differen t sign als. A pair of stereo
speakers can operate “in ph ase” or “ou t of ph ase.” If th e drivers in
th e left an d righ t speakers m ove in an d ou t at th e sam e tim e, in per -
fect con cert with on e an oth er, th e speakers are “in ph ase.” If th ey
are ou t of syn c, th ey are “ou t of ph ase.” Ou t-of-ph ase speakers ten d
to produ ce a weak stereo im age an d low bass ou tpu t.
Ph ase is often represen ted by th is sym bol: ∅.
On th e VM200, you can in vert th e ph ase for ch an n els 1–20. First you
access th e PHASE fu n ction page, th en press an [EQ EDIT] key to tu rn
ph ase in version on or off. A ligh t in dicator on th e display m ean s
ph ase is n orm al (off) for th at ch an n el; a dark (h igh ligh ted) in dicator
m ean s ph ase is in verted (on ).
You can u se th e ph ase in version software switch es to com pen sate for
balan ced cables or m icroph on es th at m ay h ave been wired in cor -
rectly, or at an y tim e you wish to in vert th e ph ase of a ch an n el to pre-
ven t sign al can cellation .
1. Press t h e [ROUTING/ PHASE] k ey repeat edly t o display t h e
3:∅ PHASE fu n ct ion page.
Th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key an d th e [EQ EDIT] keys for all selectable
ch an nels start to flash (indicating their availability).
Th e 3:∅ PHASE fu n ction page in clu des a 1-by-20 m atrix th at in di-
cates wh eth er th e ph ase is n orm al or reversed for each ch an n el.
Indicates phase is normal.
Indicates Phase is reversed.
2. Press a Page Select k ey t o select t h e t arget ch an n el layer,
t h en press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for an y ch an n el t o reverse it s
ph ase.
Th e [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p if you tu rn ph ase in version on .
Even wh en ch an n els are con figu red as stereo pairs, th eir ph ase
switch es can be set in depen den tly.
3. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
64
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channel EQ
Input Channel EQ
You can apply EQ to ch an n els 1—16 u sin g th e fou r -ban d param etric
equ alizer. For m ore in form ation on u sin g th e equ alizer, see “EQ” on
page 75.
Muting Channels
To m u te a ch an n el, u se th e Page Select keys to select th e desired
ch an n el layer, th en m ake su re th e ch an n el’s [ON] key is tu rn ed off.
If ch an n els are lin ked as a stereo pair (see “Pairin g Ch an n els” on
on ).
You can also grou p in pu t ch an n els in to Mu te grou ps an d con trol th em
page 68.)
Setting Channel Levels
You con trol in pu t ch an n el levels u sin g th e faders.
If it is n ot already selected, select th e desired ch an n el layer u sin g a
Page Select key, th en press th e ch an n el’s [ON] key.
Th e VM200 featu res seven Fader Modes. Th e faders con trol differen t
fu n ction s an d param eters depen din g on th e cu rren t Fader Mode.
You can select a Fader Mode by pressin g on e of th e keys in th e Fader
Mode section , su ch as [AUX1], [EFF2], [CHANNEL], etc. (See “Faders” on
page 32 for m ore in form ation abou t Fader Modes.)
If ch an n els are lin ked as a stereo pair or grou p, you can set th e ch an -
n el level for th e pair or grou p u sin g an y fader in th e pair or grou p. For
Panning Input Channels
Use th e eigh t pan pot rotary con trols to pan th e sign al between th e
left an d righ t ch an n els of th e stereo ou tpu t.
1. Mak e su re t h at t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey is lit . If n ot , press it
t o t u rn it on .
VM200 User’s Guide
65
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
panpot icon
numeric pan value
hard left hard right
2. Use t h e Page Select k eys t o select t h e t arget ch an n el layer.
3. Use t h e pan pot rot ary con t rols t o m ak e t h e pan set t in gs.
Th e display sh ows a dial icon for each ch an n el th at visu ally in di-
cates th e pan position . Th e display also in clu des n u m erical val-
u es—su ch as L2.0 or R3.7—th at provide precise pan position
data.
If you pan h ard righ t or h ard left (th at is, fu lly righ t or left), th e
n u m erical valu e ch an ges to a left or righ t arrow to in dicate th at
th e m axim u m h as been reach ed.
Th e pan settin gs ran ge from L10.0 to R10.0 in in crem en ts of 0.5
(alth ou gh you ’ll n ever see R10.0 or L10.0 in dication s, becau se
th ese settin gs are th e m axim u m valu e an d are replaced by th e
arrow).
Routing Input Channels
You can con trol in pu t ch an n el rou tin g by u sin g th e on / off software
switch es on th e ROUTING fu n ction page.
Th e ROUTING fu n ction page in clu des switch es th at can rou te ch an n els
1–20 to th e Rec Bu ss an d Stereo Bu ss, an d ch an n els 1–8 to th e
ADAT Direct ou tpu ts. (You can n ot rou te ch an n els 9–20 to th e ADAT
Direct ou ts.)
1. Press t h e [ROUTING/ PHASE] k ey t o display t h e 1:ROUTING fu n c-
t ion page.
Th e [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d [ON] keys start to flash (in dicatin g
th eir availability). Th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key also flash es.
66
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring and Soloing Input Channels
2. Use t h e Page Select k eys t o select t h e t arget ch an n el layer.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], or [ON] k ey t h at represen t s t h e
desired rou t in g for t h e t arget ch an n el.
See th e followin g table:
KEY
TARGET ROUTING
ADAT DIRECT OUT
REC BUS
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
STEREO BUS
Wh en you press an [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], or [ON] key, th e key ligh ts u p
an d th e correspon din g in dicator on th e display tu rn s dark (h igh -
ligh ted). A ligh t em pty in dicator m ean s th e rou tin g is n ot selected
(off).
If ch an n els are con figu red as stereo pairs, th eir Rou tin g switch es
are also lin ked. (For m ore in form ation on pairin g ch an n els, see
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Monitoring and Soloing Input Channels
For in form ation on m on itorin g in pu t ch an n els, see “Mon itorin g Sig-
n als” on page 97
Feeding Outputs
REC Buss Out
You can rou te in pu t ch an n els 1–20 to th e Rec Bu ss ou ts. See “Usin g
th e REC BUSS OUT” on page 112 for m ore in form ation .
ST Buss Out
You can rou te in pu t ch an n els 1–20 to th e Stereo Bu ss ou ts. See
“Usin g th e ST BUSS OUT” on page 110 for m ore in form ation .
AUX Sends
You can rou te in pu t sign als to Au x 1, 2, 3, or 4 by pressin g th e [AUX1],
[AUX2], [AUX3], or [AUX4] key an d raisin g th e correspon din g fader. (You
can u se Au x 3 an d 4 wh en ADD. AUX m ode is tu rn ed on .) You can
also con figu re in pu t ch an n el sen ds as eith er pre-fader or post-fader.
See “Usin g th e AUX Sen ds” on page 115 for m ore in form ation .
VM200 User’s Guide
67
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Digital Outs
You can select in pu t ch an n els 1–20 as sou rces for th e digital ou ts.
See “Digital Con n ection s” on page 159 for m ore in form ation .
Pairing Channels
You can create u p to ten pairs of ch an n els from in pu t ch an n els 1–20
to facilitate stereo sign al processin g.
You can pair on ly adjacen t odd/ even ch an n els, su ch as 1 an d 2, 5
an d 6, etc. (You can n ot pair n on -adjacen t ch an n els, su ch as 2 an d 7,
or even / odd pairs su ch as 4 an d 5.)
Th e followin g param eters are lin ked wh en in pu t ch an n els are paired:
EQ, [ON], [SOLO], an d [EQ EDIT] keys, faders, Au x sen ds, Effect sen ds,
Pre/ post settin gs, an d Rou tin g switch es.
1. Press t h e [PAIR/ GROUP] k ey t o display t h e 1:CH PAIR fu n ct ion
page.
Th e [PAIR/ GROUP] key an d th e [EQ EDIT] keys start to flash .
2. If t h e appropriat e ch an n el layer is n ot yet select ed, press a
Page Select k ey t o select t h e desired ch an n el layer.
Th e selected Page Select key ligh ts u p.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for on e of t h e ch an n els you wish t o
pair.
Th e [EQ EDIT] keys for the chan nel pair light u p. The display high-
ligh ts th e in dicator for the chann el pair.
You can press a correspon ding [EQ EDIT] key to cancel any stereo
pair.
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Grouping Mute Channels
You can grou p ch an n els 1-20 in to m u te grou ps. Th is en ables you to
m u te several ch an n els sim u ltan eou sly by pressin g a sin gle [ON] key.
For exam ple, you m ay wish to tu rn all th e ch an n els devoted to a ch o-
68
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Grouping Faders
ru s or dru m kit on an d off sim u ltan eou sly du rin g m ixdown . You can
grou p th ese ch an n els in to a m u te grou p.
Th ree grou ps are available: Mu te Grou ps A, B, an d C.
1. Press t h e [PAIR/ GROUP] k ey t wice t o display t h e 2:MUTE GROUP
fu n ct ion page.
THE [PAIR/ GROUP] key an d all [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d [ON] keys
flash .
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k eys for t h e ch an n els you wish t o add t o
Mu t e Grou p A.
The [EQ EDIT] keys ligh t u p and the corresponding indicators on the
display tu rn on (h ighligh t).
In th e exam ple above, chan nels 5, 6, 7, and 8 are assigned to Mu te
Grou p A. (No other channels are assigned to a Mu te grou p.)
3. Press t h e [SOLO] k eys for t h e ch an n els you wish t o add t o
Mu t e Grou p B.
The [SOLO] keys light u p and the corresponding in dicators on the
display tu rn on (h ighlight).
4. Press t h e [ON] k ey for t h e ch an n els you wish t o add t o Mu t e
Grou p C.
The [ON] keys light u p and the corresponding in dicators on the dis-
play tu rn on (h ighlight).
5. To rem ove a ch an n el from t h e m u t e grou p, press t h e corre-
spon din g [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], or [ON] k ey.
The key resu m es flashing and the corresponding display indicator
tu rns off.
6. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Grouping Faders
You can grou p faders 1-8 in to Fader grou ps. Th is en ables you to con -
trol several faders sim u ltan eou sly u sin g on ly on e fader.
Three grou ps are available: Mu te Grou ps A, B, and C.
1. Press t h e [PAIR/ GROUP] k ey repeat edly t o display t h e 3:FADER
GROUP fu n ct ion page.
VM200 User’s Guide
69
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
THE [PAIR/ GROUP] key an d all [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], an d [ON] keys
start to flash .
In th e followin g exam ple, ch an n els 2, 6, an d 7 are assign ed to
Fader Grou p A. (No oth er ch an n els are assign ed to Fader
Grou ps.)
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k eys for t h e faders you wish t o add t o
Fader Grou p A.
Th e [EQ EDIT] keys light u p an d the corresponding indicators on the
display tu rn on (highligh t).
3. Press t h e [SOLO] k eys for t h e faders you wish t o add t o Fader
Grou p B.
Th e [SOLO] keys ligh t u p and the corresponding in dicators on the
display tu rn on (highligh t).
4. Press t h e [ON] k eys for t h e faders you wish t o add t o Fader
Grou p C.
Th e [ON] keys ligh t u p and the corresponding indicators on the dis-
play tu rn on (highligh t).
5. To rem ove a fader from t h e fader grou p, press t h e correspon d-
in g [EQ EDIT], [SOLO], or [ON] k ey.
Th e key resu m es flashing and the corresponding display indicator
tu rn s off.
6. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
View ing Input Channel Settings
Th e CHANNEL VIEW fu n ction page en ables you to view th e settin gs for
an y in pu t ch an n el.
You can n ot adju st an y param eters on th e CHANNEL VIEW fu n ction page.
(If you try to adju st th e pan settin g, th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL
EDIT fu n ction page.)
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey t o display t h e 1:CH VIEW fu n ct ion page.
Th e [CH VIEW] key an d the [EQ EDIT] keys for all viewable chann els
flash . Th e selected Page Select key lights u p; u n selected Page Select
keys flash .
70
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Viewing Input Channel Settings
2. Press t h e appropriat e Page Select k ey t o select t h e desired
ch an n el layer.
The selected Page Select key lights u p; u nselected Page Select keys
contin u e to flash.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e t arget ch an n el.
The selected [EQ EDIT] key lights u p. The nu m ber of the selected
chan nel appears in the u pper left portion of the CHANNEL VIEW fu n c-
tion page.
The followin g illu stration describes the com ponents of the CHANNEL
VIEW fu nction page.
channel pan setting
channel number
routing (Direct, Rec buss, St buss)
EQ curve graphic
sub-page title
EQ on/off
level meter
function page title
phase
aux send levels effect send levels
channel fader level
[ON] key status
EQ numeric settings
(gain, freq, Q)
fader group
mute group
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
71
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
Copying Channel Settings
You can u se th e Ch an n el Copy fu n ction to copy in pu t ch an n el set-
tin gs from on e ch an n el to an oth er.
Th e CHANNEL COPY fu n ction page featu res a 1-by-20 m atrix th at
en ables you to select on e sou rce ch an n el, an d en able or disable th e
oth er ch an n els as copy destin ation s.
Th e selected sou rce ch an n el is m arked by an “S.” A h igh ligh ted in di-
cator m arks th e ch an n els targeted as copy destin ation s. A dark in di-
cator m ean s th e ch an n el is n ot selected (disabled) as a copy
destin ation .
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey t wice (from st art of cycle) t o display
t h e 2:CH COPY fu n ct ion page.
Th e [CH VIEW] key and th e [EQ EDIT] keys for all chan nels flash . The
selected Page Select key lights u p; the u nselected Page Select keys
flash .
2. Press t h e appropriat e Page Select k ey t o select t h e desired
ch an n el layer.
Th e selected Page Select key lights u p; u nselected Page Select keys
contin u e to flash.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e copy sou rce ch an n el.
You can select only one sou rce channel to copy at a tim e.
Th e selected [EQ EDIT] key lights u p. The CHANNEL COPY fu nction page
m arks th e sou rce chann el with an “S” and prom pts you to select a
destination ch annel.
4. Press t h e appropriat e Page Select k ey t o specify t h e ch an n el
layer, t h en press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey of t h e copy dest in at ion
ch an n el(s).
You can select m u ltiple channels as destinations.
72
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying Channel Settings
The selected [EQ EDIT] key(s) light u p. The CHANNEL COPY fu nction
page highligh ts (enables) the selected destin ation channel(s) as fol-
lows.
5. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o execu t e t h e copy operat ion .
Th e CHANNEL COPY fu n ction page flash es th e word “COMPLETE!” on
th e display for a few secon ds, an d th e VM200 displays th e first CH
COPY fu n ction page.
6. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Not e: Even if ch an n els are paired, you can copy to an d from each
of th e paired ch an n els in depen den tly.
VM200 User’s Guide
73
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Input Channels
74
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 5
EQ
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter explain s h ow to u se th e VM200 fou r -ban d param etric
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
equ alizer (EQ) an d h ow to edit, recall, an d store EQ settin gs.
ON
AN
P
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
Chapter Contents
ON
EQ EDIT
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
Q
SOLO
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
75
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Equalizers (EQ)
Th e VM200 featu res a fou r -ban d param etric equ alizer for in pu t
ch an n els 1–16.
Th e fou r -ban d equ alizer su bdivides th e au dio spectru m in to LO,
LO-MID, HI-MID, an d HI frequ en cy ran ges. Each of th e fou r ban ds
in clu des rotary con trols for Gain , Frequ en cy, an d Q.
Th e LO-MID an d HI-MID ban ds u se param etric EQ. Th e LO ban d can
fu n ction as an HPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ; th e HI ban d can
fu n ction as an LPF, sh elvin g, or param etric EQ.
Th e Gain con trol adju sts th e am ou n t of in crease in a sign al, gen erally
m easu red in decibels (dB).
Th e Frequ en cy con trol specifies th e n u m ber of cycles-per -secon d of
a waveform (in ou r case, sou n dwaves).
Th e Q con trol adju sts th e sh arpn ess of th e EQ peak respon se.
Th e LO ban d Q can fu n ction as a h igh -pass filter (HPF), an d HI ban d
Q can fu n ction as a low-pass filter (LPF).
A low-pass filter (LPF) rejects sign als above a certain cu t-off fre-
qu en cy wh ile passin g lower -frequ en cy sign als th rou gh .
A h igh -pass filter (HPF) rejects sign als below a certain cu t-off fre-
qu en cy wh ile passin g h igh er -frequ en cy sign als th rou gh .
In a sh elvin g-type (SHLV) EQ, th e boosted or cu t-off frequ en cies form
a sh elf-sh ape on a frequ en cy respon se cu rve. A h igh -frequ en cy sh elf
affects sign als at an d h igh er th an th e specified frequ en cy; a low fre-
qu en cy sh elf affects sign als at an d h igh er th an th e specified fre-
qu en cy.
Th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page displays a graph ic EQ respon se cu rve for
ch an n els 1 - 16. Th e EQ respon se cu rve provides visu al feedback to
h elp you sh ape th e EQ, wh ile th e n u m erical read-ou ts en su re
extrem ely accu rate settin gs th at you can store in th e EQ Library an d
later recall.
Th e EQ Library con sists of 50 Preset program s an d 50 User pro-
gram s. You can store EQ settin gs in to User program s, or in to Scen e
Mem ory alon g with all oth er m ix settin gs. You can also recall EQ set-
tin gs from th e Preset program s or User program s, or from Scen e
Mem ory alon g with all oth er m ix settin gs.
Th e Presets are a special collection of EQ settin gs th at can be u sefu l
You can also u se th e Presets as tem plates th at you can cu stom ize to
create you r own EQ settin gs. You can n am e an d store u p to 50 of you r
favorite EQ settin gs as User program s.
If ch an n els are con figu red as a stereo pair, th eir EQs are lin ked.
Th e EQ param eters an d respon se cu rve for in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh
76
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Adjusting the EQ
16 appear on th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page, as sh own below:
EQ On
indicator
Adjusting the EQ
You can adju st th e EQ for each of th e fou r ban ds u sin g th ree rotary
con trols: Gain , Freq, an d Q. Th ese th ree EQ con trols form a trian gu -
lar sh ape on th e top pan el of th e VM200.
Th e LCD display also featu res fou r sets of th ree circu lar kn ob icon s.
Each set of th ree is arran ged in a trian gle th at correspon ds to th e
h ardware EQ rotary con trols. (Th at is, Gain is on top, Freq is on th e
lower -left, an d Q is on th e lower -righ t.)
Note th at in EQ Edit m ode, th e Pan rotary con trols adju st Freq an d Q.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
1. Mak e su re t h at t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey is lit . Ot h erwise,
press it t o t u rn it on .
2. Press a Page Select k ey t o specify a ch an n el layer, su ch as [1 -8
ANALOG IN] k ey.
Th e selected Page Select key ligh ts u p red.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e ch an n el wh ose EQ you wish t o
edit .
VM200 User’s Guide
77
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Th e selected [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p an d th e VM200 displays th e
EQ EDIT fu n ction page.
4. Press t h e [EQ ON] k ey in t h e Select ed EQ sect ion t o t u rn it on .
Th e [EQ ON] key ligh ts u p, an d th e VM200 tu rn s on th e EQ for th e
selected ch an n el.
Th e EQ On / Off in dicator in th e lower -righ t corn er of th e display
sh ows “On ” to in dicate th at th e EQ is tu rn ed on for th e specified
ch an n el.
Not e: Be aware th at th e EQ m ay n ot tu rn on for certain ch an n els
if th e EQ En able param eter settin g is in correct. Th e EQ En able
param eter appears on th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page. See
5. Use t h e rot ary con t rols (Gain , Freq, an d Q) t o adju st t h e Fre-
qu en cy, Gain , an d Q param et ers.
Th e display sh ows a graph ic frequ en cy respon se cu rve.
You can watch a bell-sh aped cu rve swell as you in crease th e gain ,
or drop below th e m id-lin e wh en you redu ce th e gain .For exam -
ple, watch th e respon se cu rve swell as you raise th e EQ/ HI-MID
Gain , as illu strated in figu res A an d B below.
A
B
the response curve swells when Gain is raised
78
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Adjusting the EQ
If you lower th e Freq, th e soft bell-sh aped cu rve in Figu re B wou ld
m ove to th e left, as illu strated in Figu re C:
bell moves left
C
In Figu res D an d E below, n otice h ow th e frequ en cy ran ge is
redu ced an d th e respon se cu rve sh arpen s an d n arrows as th e
EQ/ HI-MID Q valu e is raised.
D
E
If you select HPF or LPF for LO ban d Q or HI ban d Q respectively,
th e Gain rotary con trol for LO EQ or HI EQ fu n ction s as th e
On / Off switch .
Th e followin g table sh ows th e VM200 EQ specification s.
Lo
Lo-Mid
Hi-Mid
Hi
1
Gain (G)
–18.0 dB to +18.0 dB (0.5 dB steps)
20.3 Hz–4.00 kHz
(240 steps per 1/24 octave)
500Hz–20.3kHz
(240 steps per 1/24 octave)
Frequency (F)
HPF, 0.1–20
(45 steps),
Lo-shelf
LPF, 0.1–20
(45 steps),
Hi-shelf
0.1–20
(45 steps)
Q
1. When the LO and HI EQ bands are configured as HPF and LPF, their gain controls
function as filter on and off switches.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
79
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
EQ Enabling Channels
You can en able th e EQ for th ree grou ps of ch an n els: 1–8, 9–16, or
1–16.
(Th e defau lt settin g en ables th e EQs for ch an n els 1–8.)
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page appears. Notice th e EQ
En able param eter in th e u pper -left corn er.
2. Tu rn t h e ch an n el 1 / 2 Gain rot ary con t rol t o select 1 –8 , 9 –1 6 ,
or 1 –1 6 for t h e EQ En able param et er.
Th e selected valu e flash es.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm you r select ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e selected valu e for th e EQ En able param -
eter.
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Bypassing the EQ
You can tu rn a ch an n el’s EQ on or off (bypass) u sin g th e [EQ ON]
key.
Wh ile th e target ch an n el is selected (by pressin g a Page Select key
an d th e ch an n el’s [EQ EDIT] key), press th e [EQ ON] key to toggle
between EQ On an d Off.
Wh en th e EQ is on , a h igh ligh ted “ON” in dicator appears in th e
lower -righ t corn er of th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page. If th e EQ is bypassed,
“OFF” appears in th e sam e location .
1. Press t h e [1 –8 ANALOG IN] or [9 –1 6 ADAT IN] Page Select k ey t o
select a ch an n el layer.
Th e selected Page Select key ligh ts u p.
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e ch an n el wh ose EQ you wish t o
t u rn on or off.
Th e selected [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p an d th e VM200 displays th e
EQ EDIT fu n ction page.
3. Press t h e [EQ ON] k ey in t h e Select ed EQ sect ion .
Th e [EQ ON] key ligh ts u p, an d th e VM200 tu rn s on th e EQ for th e
selected ch an n el.
80
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Resetting the EQ
Th e EQ On / Off in dicator in th e lower -righ t corn er of th e display
displays “On ” to in dicate th at th e EQ is tu rn ed on for th e specified
ch an n el.
4. To t u rn t h e EQ off for t h e ch an n el, press t h e [EQ ON] k ey
again .
Th e [EQ ON] key tu rn s off (goes dark), an d th e VM200 tu rn s off th e
EQ for th e selected ch an n el.
Th e EQ On / Off in dicator in th e lower -righ t corn er of th e display
displays “Off” to in dicate th at th e EQ is tu rn ed off for th e specified
ch an n el.
EQ On/Off indicator. Here, EQ is bypassed.
Resetting the EQ
To reset all EQ param eters for th e selected ch an n el to th eir in itial val-
u es, follow th e steps below.
Th e followin g table sh ows in itial EQ valu es.
Lo
0 dB
Lo-Mid
0 dB
Hi-Mid
0 dB
Hi
Gain (G)
Frequency (F)
Q
0 dB
125 Hz
500Hz
1.0
2.00 kHz
1.0
8.00 kHz
H-S(Hi-Shelf)
L-S(Lo-Shelf)
1. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey of t h e ch an n el wh ose EQ you wish t o
reset t o t h e in it ial valu e.
Th e [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p an d th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page appears.
2. Wh ile pressin g an d h oldin g down t h e [ENTER] k ey, press t h e
[EQ EDIT] k ey.
Th e followin g con firm ation dialog appears on th e display.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o proceed, or press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o
can cel t h e reset operat ion .
VM200 User’s Guide
81
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
If you h ave pressed th e [ENTER] key, all EQ param eters for th e
ch an n el will be reset to th e in itial valu es.
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
82
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ Library
EQ Library
You can store EQ settin gs as program s in th e EQ Library.
Th e EQ Library con tain s 50 preset program s (Preset Library: 0–49)
an d 50 u ser program s (User Library: 50–99).
For in form ation on recallin g EQ program s, see “Recallin g EQ Pro-
For in form ation on storin g a n ew or m odified EQ program , see “Stor -
EQ Preset Library List
#
Name
#
Name
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
Flat_EQ
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Real_Pf
LightKick
TightKick
Loud_Kick
Ana.Kick
Snappy_SD
Power_SD
Deep_SD
Talk_Tom
Melo.Tom
W.GongTom
Brill.Cym
Lo-Fi_Cym
Vivid_HH
Sharp_HH
Lo-Fi_HH
Perc.
E.Pf
Clean_EG
Crunch_EG
OverDrvEG
Dist.EG
Metal_EG
Stroke_AG
StrokeEAG
Arpeg.GG
Arpeg.EAG
Arpeg.AG
Brass_Sec
W.WingSec
Male_Vo1
Male_Vo2
FemaleVo1
FemaleVo2
Chorus
Tamb.
Fat_Bass
Norm.Bass
Loud_Bass
PowerBass
Bright_Pf
Loud_Pf
Speech_1
Speech_2
Digi.Mix
AnalogMix
Telephone
Husky
Power_Pf
VM200 User’s Guide
83
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Recalling EQ Program s
You can recall EQ program s from th e EQ Library, wh ich in clu des 50
Preset program s an d 50 User program s.
1. Press t h e [1 –8 ANALOG IN] or [9 –1 6 ADAT IN] Page Select k ey t o
select t h e desired ch an n el layer.
Th e selected Page Select key ligh ts u p.
Not e: Make su re you select th e “EQ En abled” ch an n el layer.
For m ore in form ation , see “EQ En ablin g Ch an n els” on
page 75.
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e ch an n el t o wh ich you wan t t o
recall an EQ set t in g.
Th e selected [EQ EDIT] key ligh ts u p.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page, wh ich sh ows th e
param eter settin gs for th e selected ch an n el.
indicates EQ parameter settings for Channel 3
3. Press t h e Select ed EQ [EQ ON] k ey t o t u rn it on .
4. Press t h e EQ Library [RECALL] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction page. Th e [EQ
EDIT] key for th e selected ch an n el flash es.
scrollable list of EQ programs
5. Rot at e t h e Dat a Wh eel or u se t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o
select an EQ program .
EQ Program n am es an d n u m bers (00 to 99) scroll in th e
u pper -righ t of th e display.
6. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o recall t h e desired EQ Program .
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page, wh ich sh ows th e
n ew EQ param eter valu es applied to th e cu rren t ch an n el.
84
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recalling EQ Programs
7. To recall an EQ program for an ot h er ch an n el, press t h e [EQ
EDIT] k ey of t h e dest in at ion ch an n el, t h en repeat St eps 2
t h rou gh 5 .
8. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey at an y t im e t o exit t h e EQ Library Recall
page an d ret u rn t o t h e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ct ion page.
VM200 User’s Guide
85
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Storing EQ Program s
You can store n ew EQ settin gs as EQ program s in th e EQ Library.
You can store EQ settin gs as User program s 50 th rou gh 99. (Pro-
gram s 0 th rou gh 49 are read-on ly Presets.)
1. Press t h e EQ Library [STORE] k ey t o display t h e EQ LIBRARY
STORE fu n ct ion page.
Th e [EQ EDIT] key of th e selected ch an n el flash es.
2. Rot at e t h e Dat a Wh eel or u se t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o
select an EQ program locat ion (from 5 0 t o 9 9 , in clu sive).
EQ Program n am es an d n u m bers (50 to 99) scroll in th e
u pper -righ t of th e display.
Not e: EQ program location s th at con tain n o data are labeled
“(No Data)”.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page.
character-selector
cursor
character selector box
title box
Th e EQ LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page in clu des a ch aracter selec-
tor box th at displays all th e letters of th e alph abet, as well as
n u m erals an d pu n ctu ation sym bols. You can u se th ese ch arac-
ters to n am e or title you r EQ program .
You can u se an y trio of Gain , Freq, an d Q rotary con trols to select
th e ch aracters for th e title.
Th e Gain con trol m oves th e cu rsor left an d righ t in th e title box.
Th e Freq con trol m oves th e ch aracter -selector u p an d down th e
m atrix; th e Q con trol m oves th e ch aracter -selector left an d righ t.
86
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing EQ Programs
4. Use t h e Freq an d Q con t rols t o select a ch aract er, t h en t u rn
t h e Gain con t rol on e n ot ch t o t h e righ t t o m ove t h e cu rsor t o
t h e n ext space in t h e n am e, an d repeat t h e process.
Th e very u sefu l “Space to En d” option in th e ch aracter selector box
will fill-in th e rem ain der of you r title with blan k spaces.
5. Wh en you ’ve fi n ish ed n am in g t h e program , press t h e [ENTER]
k ey t o st ore t h e EQ program .
Th e followin g warn in g dialog appears for a brief m om en t, followed
by th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page.
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to m em ory
or you m ay dam age th e system .
6. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey an y t im e t o exit t h e EQ LIBRARY STORE or EQ
LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ct ion pages.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
VM200 User’s Guide
87
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Editing EQ Program Titles
You can edit EQ program titles, ju st in case you wan t to ch an ge its
n am e for som e reason . To do so, you recall th e target EQ program to
a ch an n el, th en store it again with a differen t title.
1. Select a ch an n el t o wh ich you wish t o recall t h e EQ program
you are goin g t o ren am e by pressin g t h e ch an n el [EQ EDIT]
k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page.
2. Press t h e EQ Library [RECALL] k ey t o display t h e EQ LIBRARY
RECALL fu n ct ion page.
Th e [EQ EDIT] key of th e selected ch an n el flash es.
3. Rot at e t h e Dat a Wh eel or u se t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o
select an EQ program you wish t o ren am e.
You can n ot ch an ge th e n am es of Preset program s 00–49.
4. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o recall t h e desired EQ Program .
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page, wh ich sh ows th e
recalled EQ param eter valu es applied to th e cu rren t ch an n el.
5. Press t h e EQ Library [STORE] k ey t o display t h e EQ LIBRARY
STORE fu n ct ion page.
Th e VM200 h igh ligh ts th e selected EQ program n am e an d n u m -
ber.
88
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing EQ Program Titles
6. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page. Th e
title box sh ows th e program n u m ber, bu t th e n am e is n ow blan k.
character-selector
cursor
character selector box
title box
Use an y Gain , Freq, an d Q rotary con trols to re-assign a n am e to
m ore in form ation on con trollin g th e cu rsor an d ch aracter selector.
7. Wh en you ’ve fi n ish ed re-n am in g t h e program , press t h e
[ENTER] k ey t o st ore t h e n ew EQ program t it le.
Th e VM200 displays th e EQ EDIT fu n ction page.
WARNING: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to
m em ory or you m ay dam age th e system .
8. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey at an y t im e t o exit t h e EQ LIBRARY STORE or
EQ LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ct ion pages.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
VM200 User’s Guide
89
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Copying EQ Settings
You can u se th e EQ Copy fu n ction to copy EQ settin gs from on e
ch an n el to an oth er.
Th e EQ COPY fu n ction page featu res a 1-by-20 m atrix th at en ables you
to select on e sou rce ch an n el EQ, an d en able or disable th e oth er
ch an n els as copy destin ation s.
Th e selected sou rce ch an n el EQ is m arked by an “S.” A h igh ligh ted
in dicator m arks th e ch an n els targeted as copy destin ation s. A dark
in dicator m ean s th e ch an n el is n ot selected (disabled) as a copy des-
tin ation .
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey t wice (from st art of cycle).
Th e VM200 displays th e 3:EQ COPY fu n ction page.
Th e [CH VIEW] key and th e [EQ EDIT] keys for all chann els flash. The
selected Page Select key lights u p; u nselected Page Select keys flash.
2. Press t h e appropriat e Page Select k ey t o select t h e desired
ch an n el layer.
Th e selected Page Select key ligh ts u p; u n selected Page Select keys
continu e to flash.
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e EQ copy sou rce ch an n el.
You can select only one sou rce channel EQ to copy at a tim e.
Th e selected [EQ EDIT] key lights u p. The EQ COPY fu nction page
m arks th e sou rce chann el with an “S” and prom pts you to select a
destination ch annel.
90
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Copying EQ Settings
4. Press t h e appropriat e Page Select k ey t o specify t h e ch an n el
layer, t h en press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey of t h e copy dest in at ion
ch an n el(s).
You can select m u ltiple ch annels as EQ copy destinations.
The selected [EQ EDIT] key(s) light u p. The EQ COPY fu nction page
high lights (enables) the selected destination channel(s) as follows.
source channel
oneof four destination channels
5. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o execu t e t h e copy operat ion .
Th e EQ COPY fu n ction page flash es th e word “COMPLETE!” on th e
display for a few secon ds, an d th e VM200 displays th e first CH COPY
fu n ction page.
6. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Not e: Even if ch an n els are paired, you can copy to an d from each
of th e paired ch an n els in depen den tly.
VM200 User’s Guide
91
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
EQ Preset Library Param eters
Parameter
#
Name
Description
Lo
0.0dB
.125
L-S
Lo-Mid Hi-Mid
Hi
0.0dB
8.00K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
0.0dB
500
1.0
0.0dB
2.00K
1.0
A flat equalizing pattern
used for initialized EQ.
00 Flat_EQ
Gain
Freq.
Q
+4.0
105
1.6
-12.0
324
11
+4.0
4.12K
0.40
+6.5
2.83K
2.8
0.0
Relatively light and nim-
ble kick sound.
01 LightKick
02 TightKick
03 Loud_Kick
04 Ana.Kick
05 Snappy_SD
06 Power_SD
07 Deep_SD
08 Talk_Tom
09 Melo.Tom
10 W.GongTom
11 Brill.Cym
12 Lo-Fi_Cym
8.00K
HS
Gain
Freq.
Q
+8.0
70.2
1.1
-7.5
364
5.0
ON
Creates a peak around
13.5K 70Hz, producing a tight,
stiff sound.
LPF
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the attack
of the beat, increasing
the mass of the entire
kick.
+4.5
102
1.0
-6.5
306
3.2
+5.0
1.46K
4.5
+4.0
6.35K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
+5.5
102
L-S
+1.0
91.0
5.0
-6.0
-1.5
Makes an analog kick
sound more boomy.
2.12K
7.9
12.7K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-4.5
111
L-S
0.0
_3.5
3.89K
0.16
+3.5
2.45K
0.45
+4.0
4.24K
2.2
+4.0
8.23K
H-S
Emphasizes snare
sounds.
841
3.5
Gain
Freq.
Q
+2.0
149
L-S
-9.5
281
11
+4.5
Adds powerful thrust
5.04K and clarifies snare
sound.
0.13
Gain
Freq.
Q
0.0
+3.0
545
4.5
0.0
Creates a heavy-weight
125
L-S
8.00K snare sound with great
depth.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
+9.5
102
2.0
-10.0
687
6.3
+9.0
4.36K
1.4
+2.0
Creates the “leathery”
decay of a tom.
10.7K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Creates a melodious
atmosphere by limiting
the body resonance of a
tom.
-10.0
83.4
L-S
+2.0
216
4.5
+2.5
5.50K
1.1
0.0
8.00K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-12.00 +10.00
-8.0
-12.0
8.00K
H-S
Creates a wooden tom
sound.
.125
L-S
-6.0
55.7
L-S
0.0
500
5.0
3.78K
11
Gain
Freq.
Q
-1.0
397
8.9
0.0
+7.0
Creates a “sparkling”
1.94K
1.0
5.66K and brilliant cymbal
sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the mid to
low range to muffle
“sparkling” part of cym-
bals.
+2.5
172
3.2
-4.0
-&.0
4.00K
H-S
40.5
L-S
3.27K
11
92
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ Preset Library Parameters
Parameter
#
Name
Description
Lo
-7.5
93.6
L-S
Lo-Mid Hi-Mid
Hi
+4.0
Gain
Freq.
Q
-2.5
472
0.79
-6.5
771
5.6
+4.0
2.31K
1.0
Emphasizes the pres-
8.00K ence of a high-hat in the
13 Vivid_HH
14 Sharp_HH
15 Lo-Fi_HH
16 Perc.
ensemble.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-9.0
68.2
L-S
+4.5
7.13K
10
+3.5
Creates a tight high-hat
16.0K with stiff and powerful
characteristics.
0.10
Gain
Freq.
Q
-2.5
93.6
L-S
0.0
+4.5
2.31K
0.71
+1.0
1.94K
0.35
+1.0
3.17K
10
-18.0
Eliminates metallic ele-
8.00K ments and emphasizes
472
0.79
0.0
lo-fi high-hat sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the attack and
clarifies the high-range of
instruments, such as con-
gas, and bongos.
-4.0
102
L-S
+7.0
5.82K
H-S
397
4.5
Gain
Freq.
Q
Creates a subtle
essence by emphasiz-
ing the presence of a
tambourine.
-5.0
125
L-S
-0.5
375
2.5
+2.5
8.00K
H-S
17 Tamb.
Gain
Freq.
Q
0.0
+4.5
105
0.10
+4.5
105
5.0
+2.5
2.38K
6.3
+0.5
Makes an electric bass
18 Fat_Bass
19 Norm.Bass
20 Loud_Bass
21 PowerBass
22 Bright_Pf
23 Loud_Pf
24 Power_Pf
25 Real_Pf
99.2
L-S
4.24K sound fatter by empha-
sizing the low range.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Makes an all-round elec-
tric bass sound by cut-
ting very low
-9.0
31.3
L-S
+3.5
2.12K
0.40
+2.5
1.26K
2.2
0.0
4.24K
H-S
frequencies.
Gain
Freq.
Q
+3.5
121
2.0
0.0
0.0
Use for analog bass with
182
7.9
12.0K boosted low limit and
attack ranges.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
+6.0
83.4
L-S
+3.0
917
7.9
0.0
0.0
Use on a PCM bass with
boosted low range.
4.00K
3.2
8.00K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-4.0
81.8
L-S
0.0
+2.5
2.45K
1.6
+5.0
Use to make a piano
sound brighter.
375
3.2
8.98K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
+5.5
187
3.5
-9.0
578
10
+2.5
3.27K
3.2
+4.5
Adds “weight” to the low
5.34K range of a piano sound
with lots of harmonics.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-8.5
28.7
L-S
-5.5
273
1.0
+4.5
3.17K
6.3
+9.0
Use on a piano solo to
8.23K add tightness and
spread.
3.5
Gain
Freq.
Q
Simulates a real
-4.5
51.1
L-S
+8.0
397
4.5
+1.0
1.54K
5.6
-10.0
8.00K
H-S
mid-range piano sound,
including the hammer
action during key strokes.
VM200 User’s Guide
93
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
Parameter
#
Name
Description
Lo
Lo-Mid Hi-Mid
Hi
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the attack
and distortion of popular
electric piano’s key
strokes.
-6.5
22.1
L-S
+5.5
243
5.0
+3.5
3.56K
16
+10.5
20.2K
H-S
26 E.Pf
Gain
Freq.
Q
+3.0
216
0.22
+3.0
140
7.9
-6.5
386
10
+1.0
1.46K
6.3
+3.5
Use for a clean electric
27 Clean_EG
28 Crunch_EG
5.34K guitar to get a brighter
sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the pres-
ence and adjusts the
tonal quality of a slightly
distorted guitar sound.
0.0
+3.5
2.00K
0.89
+3.0
2.59K
+3.0
5.19K
7.1
500
1.0
Gain
Freq.
Emphasizes the mid
range of mellow over-
drive electric guitar to
add fatness and rich-
ness.
+3.5
108
+2.0
375
0.0
8.00K
29 OverDrvEG
Q
7.9
0.50
0.20
H-S
0.0
Gain
Freq.
Q
+5.5
364
L-S
+6.5
250
L-S
-3.0
125
1.0
0.0
917
7.9
+4.0
3.56K
10
Makes a heavily dis-
30 Dist.EG
8.00K torted guitar sound
clearer.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-9.5
1.12K
10
+5.0
4.49K
4.0
+4.0
Emphasizes the edge of
high-gain metal sound.
31 Metal_EG
32 Stroke_AG
33 StrokeEAG
34 Arpeg.GG
35 Arpeg.EAG
36 Arpeg.AG
37 Brass_Sec
38 W.WingSec
12.0K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the bright
chordal strokes of an
acoustic guitar, reduc-
ing the body resonance.
0.0
+1.5
1.94K
2.8
+5.5
7.13K
H-S
794
3.2
Gain
Freq.
Q
-4.0
250
L-S
-3.0
149
L-S
-1.5
210
L-S
0.0
-3.0
687
8.9
0.0
+2.5
Use on a tight elec-
2.00K
1.0
4.49K tric-acoustic guitar in a
band context.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-3.0
223
4.0
+4.0
3.08K
5.6
+2.5
Corrects and clarifies
8.00K the arpeggio technique
of a gutsy guitar sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Adjusts the balance of
chords & arpeggios of
an electric acoustic gui-
tar sound.
0.0
0.0
+3.0
9.42K
0.10
+5.0
4.24K
H-S
1.00K
4.0
3.78K
4.0
Gain
Freq.
Q
Cuts the body resonance
of an acoustic guitar
sound and clarifies an
arpeggio guitar sound.
-6.5
530
7.1
0.0
149
L-S
-2.5
96.4
2.5
2.52K
4.5
Gain
Freq.
Q
Adjusts the balance of
brass section sound
(such as trumpets and
trombones).
0.0
+2.0
2.52K
0.79
0.0
+4.0
5.66K
5.0
917
1.6
Gain
Freq.
Q
Emphasizes the rich
mid-range of wind
instruments, such as
clarinets and oboes.
+3.0
125
L-S
+4.0
257
2.2
0.0
3.38K
2.5
8.00K
H-S
94
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ Preset Library Parameters
Parameter
#
Name
Description
Lo
-1.0
157
L-S
Lo-Mid Hi-Mid
Hi
+3.0
Gain
Freq.
Q
0.0
1.00K
4.5
+2.0
2.00K
0.56
-2.0
Adds changes to
6.17K expression male of tenor
39 Male_Vo1
40 Male_Vo2
41 FemaleVo1
42 FemaleVo2
43 Chorus
vocals.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Adds changes to
expression of bass and
baritone male vocal
sound
+2.5
140
L-S
-4.0
243
7.9
+4.5
6.73K
H-S
2.59
3.2
Gain
Freq.
Q
-2.0
121
L-S
+1.5
408
0.45
+2.0
324
0.20
-0.5
817
2.2
+2.0
2.59K
0.63
+2.5
2.06K
0.22
+1.0
2.12K
0.71
+1.5
2.59K
0.71
+3.5
2.67K
1.0
+3.0
Adds changes to
8.72K expression of soprano
female vocal sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-7.0
118
L-S
+3.5
Adds changes to
6.73K expression of alto
female vocal sound.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-3.0
99.2
3.2
+3.5
Adds changes to
5.34K expression of the entire
high-tone chorus part.
7.9
Gain
Freq.
Q
-4.5
99.2
4.5
-1.5
687
7.1
0.0
Use to record clear male
narration.
44 Speech_1
45 Speech_2
46 Digi.Mix
8.00K
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
-5.0
55.7
L-S
-2.0
229
3.5
0.0
Use to record clear
8.00K
female narration.
H-S
Gain
Freq.
Q
Use to record from classic
analog 6mm or cassette
tape to make the sound
clearer, like digital audio.
+6.0
51.1
L-S
0.0
0.0
+6.0
12.0K
H-S
420
1.0
4.00K
1.0
Gain
Freq.
Q
ON
-7.0
57.3
3.5
-7.0
ON
Cuts the high range to
47 AnalogMix
48 Telephone
49 Husky
33.1
HPF
ON
6.54K
1.4
10.7K obtain the reverse
effects of program 45.
LPF
Gain
Freq.
Q
0.0
+12.0
1.00K
5.0
ON
Emphasizes only the
420
HPF
ON
500
1.0
2.52K mid range to simulate a
telephone sound.
LPF
Gain
Freq.
Q
-5.5
172
1.0
+2.0
4.62K
0.32
+8.0
Emphasizes only the
102
HPF
8.00K high range to creates a
husky voice.
H-S
VM200 User’s Guide
95
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ
96
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
X
A
M
IN
M
CHAPTER 6
Monitoring Signals
2
FF
E
IT
E
RECORDING MIXER
D
R
E
O
T
S
F
F
AL
Y
R
VM200
E
A
R
IB
F1
F
L
F
DIGIT
F
E
E
L
L
A
EXIT
C
E
R
L
L
A
Q
C
E
E
D
R
E
R
TE
N
O
T
C
O
E
S
L
Q
Y
E
R
SE
A
R
ON
IB
L
Q
E
S
S
12
U
-12
LL
B
O
L
-18
A
O
C
C
L
-24
E
O
R
E
O
R
S
-36
R
-40
S/S
S
U
L
T
B
S
8
16
ON
AboutThis Chapter
O
L
O
IT
I
This chapter explains how to monitor signals on the VM200, includ-
S
X
/H
E
Q
Q
IN
E
A
7
15
G
N
ing selecting a monitor output, soloing, using the two-track input,
N
O
ON
A
P
IT
TN
D
R
as well as viewing meters and send levels.
E
-40
-30
Q
E
FF
Q
O
17-20
E
E
L
O
FR
S
N
A
P
N
IT
ON
O
D
E
Q
E
Chapter Contents
ID
I-M
LO
Q
IN
0
O
/H
A
G
S
Q
E
T
N
A
P
C
-10
N
LE
IT
Monitoring and Soloing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
O
E
D
T
A
IN
S
E
ON
E
Q
E
-20
D
G
A
A
MON SEL Parameter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
-30
Q
O
L
9-16
E
O
-40
FR
S
+10
SOLO MODE Parameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
-60
0
N
A
P
N
IT
-
Two Track Input (2TRK IN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
O
D
E
-10
Q
E
ON
Monitoring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
ID
O
-M
-20
L
Q
IN
O
-40
/LO
A
S
+10
-30
Soloing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Q
G
+10
E
-40
0
N
A
P
N
IT
-
Metering Signal Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
O
D
E
-10
Q
E
Viewing Input/Output Level Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Q
ON
O
-20
E
L
R
0
O
F
S
+10
LED Display Meter (L/R or ST BUSS/SOLO). . . . . .
-3
. . . 106
0
-4
0
N
A
P
N
IT
-
Viewing Individual Channel, Aux Send, and Effect Send Meters106
D
O
E
-10
Q
E
2
O
18
-20
10
L
Q
O
ON
S
+10
-30
-40
0
N
A
P
N
IT
-
D
O
E
-10
Q
E
6
O
-20
14
L
O
10
+
1
9
S
-30
-40
ON
0
N
A
P
N
IT
-
O
D
-40
-30
-20
-10
-
E
-10
Q
E
5
O
-20
13
L
O
S
+10
-30
0
-4
0
N
-
O
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
EFF2
-40
AUX4
0
AUX2
/
P
-
U
IR
O
A
P
R
-10
G
/
L
E
3
R
N
CHANNEL
ADD.AUX
E
1
N
-20
T
A
D
E
R
M
O
D
E
1
A
E
F
H
19
D
M
+10
C
-30
N
E
-40
0
S
EFF1
C
AUX3
AUX1
M
-
M
0
VM200 User’s Guide
97
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring Signals
Monitoring and Soloing
Th e flexible m on itorin g an d soloin g capabilities of th e VM200 en able
you to u se th e m ixer in a wide ran ge of application s.
Th e m on itorin g fu n ction s en able you to listen to in pu t ch an n el sig-
n als or bu ss sign als th rou gh con n ected m on itor speakers or h ead-
ph on es.
Th e soloin g fu n ction en ables you to select th e ch an n els you wan t to
h ear wh ile exclu din g all oth er ch an n els. Th is lets you focu s you r
atten tion on certain tracks in th e m ix.
For exam ple, say you wan t to listen closely to th e way th e rh yth m sec-
tion is workin g in a m ix. Th e solo fu n ction lets you “solo” th e ch an -
n els th at carry th e bass an d dru m s, wh ile exclu din g th e ch an n els
dedicated to th e oth er in stru m en ts.
You specify th e ch an n els you wan t to h ear by pressin g th e corre-
spon din g ch an n el [SOLO] keys on th e top pan el.
Th e Setu p:System 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page featu res two param eters
th at con trol th e m on itorin g an d soloin g fu n ction s of th e VM200: th e
MON SEL (m on itor select) an d SOLO MODE param eters.
You can display th e 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page by pressin g th e [SYS-
TEM] key.
MON SEL parameter
SOLO MODE parameter
MON SEL Param eter
Th e Mon Sel (Mon itor Select) param eter en ables you to select th e
sou rce for th e MONITOR OUT an d PHONES jack.
(However, if a ch an n el is “soloed,” it will override th e selection of th e
Mon Sel param eter.)
You can select on e of th e followin g sou rces: ST-B (stereo bu ss),
REC-B (record bu ss), AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4, EFF1, EFF2,
AUX1&2, or AUX3&4. For m ore in form ation on th ese option s, see
SOLO MODE Param eter
Th e Solo Mode param eter en ables you to con figu re th e solo fu n ction
of th e VM200.
You can solo in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20 an d th e bu ss ou ts by
98
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitor Outs and Phones
pressin g th e [SOLO] key for th e desired ch an n el.
Two Solo m odes are available: PFL (Pre-Fader Listen ) an d M–SOLO
(Mix Solo).
Monitor Outs and Phones
You can ou tpu t Mon itor an d Solo sign als via th e MONITOR OUT an d
PHONES jacks.
Make su re th e 2TRK IN switch is n ot pressed in for m on itorin g (u n less
you wan t to con fiden ce m on itor), or you will n ot h ear a sign al. (See
2TRK IN, below, for m ore in form ation .)
You can con n ect a m on itor system (am plifier an d speakers) to th e
MONITOR OUT ph on o jacks on th e rear pan el. You can u se th e Mon -
itor Gain con trol, located at th e top righ t of th e con trol su rface, to
adju st th e level of th e m on itor ou t sign al.
You can con n ect a pair of stereo h eadph on es to th e PHONES stereo
(TRS) ph on e jack. Th e PHONES sign al is th e sam e as th e MONITOR
OUT sign al. You can adju st th e level of th e ph on es sign al u sin g th e
Ph on es Gain con trol.
MONITOR
PHONES
2TRK IN
GAIN
GAIN
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
PHONES Gain
(top panel}
MONITOR Gain
Two Track Input (2TRK IN)
If you press th e 2TRK IN switch on th e top pan el, you can m on itor
sign als th at are con n ected to th e 2TRK IN jacks on th e rear pan el.
Th e sign al is sen t to th e MONITOR OUT an d PHONES jacks.
You can con n ect th e stereo ou tpu ts of a m aster recorder, for exam -
ple, to th e 2TRK IN jacks for con fiden ce m on itorin g or m aster play-
back.
Th e 2TRK IN accepts ph on o jacks with a –10 dBV n om in al in pu t level.
MONITOR
PHONES
2TRK IN
2TRK IN
R
L
GAIN
GAIN
2TRK IN switch
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
2TRK IN jacks (rear panel)
VM200 User’s Guide
99
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring Signals
Monitoring
You can m on itor th e followin g sou rces: Stereo Bu ss, Rec Bu ss,
Au x1, Au x2, Au x3, Au x4, Eff1, Eff2, Au x 1&2, or Au x 3&4. (AUX 3
an d 4 are available on ly wh en th e ADD. AUX param eter is tu rn ed
on . For m ore in form ation , see page 115.)
You can select a m on itor sou rce u sin g th e m on itor select (Mon Sel)
param eter on th e first SYSTEM fu n ction page. Follow th ese steps:
1. Mak e su re a m on it orin g syst em (am p an d speak ers) is con -
n ect ed t o t h e MONITOR OUT jack s, or t h at st ereo h eadph on es
are con n ect ed t o t h e PHONES jack . Also, m ak e su re t h e 2 TRK
IN swit ch is n ot pressed in .
2. Set t h e Mon it or Gain con t rol t o abou t h alfway.
(For h eadph on es, set th e Ph on es Gain con trol to abou t h alfway.)
3. Press t h e Set u p [SYSTEM] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page.
4. Rot at e t h e ch an n el 3 / 4 (EQ/ LO-MID) Gain rot ary con t rol t o
select t h e desired sou rce for t h e Mon Sel param et er.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
MONITOR SELECT (MON. SEL.) PARAMETER OPTIONS
ST-B
Stereo Buss (default setting)
Record Buss
REC-B
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
Auxiliary 1
Auxiliary 2
Auxiliary 3
Auxiliary 4
Effect processor EFF1
Effect processor EFF2
Auxiliary 1 and Auxiliary 2 mixed
Auxiliary 3 and Auxiliary 4 mixed
EFF2
AUX1&2
AUX3&4
5. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] or [EXIT] k ey.
Th e VM200 exits Setu p m ode an d displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n c-
tion page.
100
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Soloing
Soloing
A Solo fu n ction is available for in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20 th at
en ables you to m on itor specific ch an n els.
Two solo m odes are available: PFL an d M-Solo.
PFL is an abbreviation for Pre-Fader Listen , in wh ich you can m on itor
a sign al th at appears before it is adju sted by th e fader.
M-Solo m ean s “m ix solo,” wh ich en ables you to m om en tarily m on itor
th e stereo bu ss sign al (i.e., th e m ix).
You can select a solo m ode by u sin g th e Solo Mode param eter on th e
first SETUP:SYSTEM fu n ction page.
You can also con trol h ow [SOLO] keys are tu rn ed on an d off.
To u se th e Solo fu n ction , follow th e steps below:
1. Mak e su re a m on it orin g syst em (am p an d speak ers) is con -
n ect ed t o t h e MONITOR OUT jack s, or t h at st ereo h eadph on es
are con n ect ed t o t h e PHONES jack . Also, m ak e su re t h e 2 TRK
IN swit ch is n ot pressed in .
2. Set t h e Mon it or Gain con t rol t o abou t h alfway.
(If you are u sin g h eadph on es, set th e Ph on es Gain con trol to
abou t h alfway.)
3. Press t h e Set u p [SYSTEM] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page.
4. Rot at e t h e ch an n el 5 / 6 (EQ/ HI-MID) Gain rot ary con t rol t o
select t h e desired Solo Mode.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
SOLO MODE PARAMETER OPTIONS
PFL
Pre-Fader Listen mode (default setting)
Mix-solo mode
M-SOLO
VM200 User’s Guide
101
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring Signals
PFL: In PFL (Pre-Fader Listen ) m ode, th e VM200 feeds a soloed
ch an n el’s pre-fader sign al to th e Solo bu ss an d th en ou tpu ts it
on ly to th e MONITOR OUT an d PHONES.
Pressin g th e appropriate [SOLO] key en ables you to solo th e stereo
m aster or Rec Bu ss sign al before it is adju sted by th e Master
Fader or Rec Bu ss Gain param eter.
You can u se th is m ode to m on itor in dividu al in pu t sign als du rin g
a recordin g session to m ake isolated EQ adju stm en ts or to en su re
th at th e sign als are n ot clippin g.
You can solo in pu t ch an n els th at are tu rn ed off (i.e., th at h ave
th eir [ON] keys tu rn ed off).
M-Solo: In Mix-Solo m ode, th e VM200 feeds a soloed ch an n el to
th e stereo bu ss, an d th en ou tpu ts it to th e ST BUSS OUT, MONI-
TOR OUT, an d PHONES. You can solo on ly ch an n els th at are
rou ted to th e Stereo Bu ss.
Th e VM200 m u tes all ch an n els except th e ch an n el you select to
solo. (However, you can u se a Solo Safe fu n ction in th is m ode. For
In th is m ode, Master an d Rec Bu ss [SOLO] keys are disabled.
You can u se th is m ode to adju st in dividu al ch an n els du rin g m ix-
down .
5. Rot at e t h e ch an n el 7 / 8 (EQ/ HI) Gain rot ary con t rol t o select
a Solo Key m ode.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
SOLO KEY PARAMETER OPTIONS
In Latch mode, when you press a [SOLO] key, it remains
depressed, and the channel continues to solo until you
press the key again. This is the default setting.
LATCH
In Unlatch mode, when you press and hold a [SOLO] key, it
remains depressed, and the channel continues to solo
until you release the key.
UNLATCH
6. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] or [EXIT] k ey.
Th e VM200 exits Setu p m ode an d displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n c-
tion page.
102
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Soloing
7. Wh en you ’re ready, press t h e [SOLO] k ey for t h e ch an n el(s) you
wish t o solo.
Th e selected [SOLO] keys ligh t u p.
Not e: Solo ch an n els take priority over th e sou rces you select u sin g th e
Mon Sel param eter.
Not e: Wh en ch an n els are con figu red as stereo pairs (“Pairin g Ch an n els”
on page 68), th eir [SOLO] keys are lin ked.
Not e: If Solo Mode is set to M-SOLO, you m u st raise th e fader for th e
soloed ch an n el an d th e Master fader or you will n ot h ear an y ou tpu t.
VM200 User’s Guide
103
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring Signals
Solo Safe Function
Th e VM200 featu res a Solo Safe fu n ction th at en ables you to desig-
n ate specific ch an n els as “solo safe.”
You can m on itor solo safe ch an n el sign als th at are sen t to th e stereo
bu ss regardless of th e ch an n el’s [SOLO] key statu s. Th is fu n ction is
available wh en Solo Mode is set to M-Solo (see page 98).
1. Press t h e Set u p [SYSTEM] k ey fou r t im es (from st art of cycle).
Th e VM200 displays th e SETUP:SYSTEM 4:SOLO SAFE fu n ction page. All
[EQ EDIT] keys flash .
2. Select t h e desired ch an n el layer u sin g t h e [1 –8 ANALOG IN],
[9 –1 6 ADAT IN], an d [1 7 –2 0 EFF RTN] Page Select k eys an d press
t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey of t h e t arget ch an n els.
Th e [EQ EDIT] keys of th e solo safe ch an n els ligh t u p, th e [EQ
EDIT] keys of th e n on -solo safe ch an n els con tin u e to flash .
Th e boxes of th e solo safe ch an n els are h igh ligh ted (dark) on th e
display.
In th e exam ple above, ch an n els 5 & 6 are design ated as “solo
safe” ch an n els. In th is case, pressin g th e ch an n el 1 [SOLO] key in
M-Solo m ode will en able you to m on itor n ot on ly th e ch an n el 1
sign al, bu t also th e ch an n els 5 & 6 sign als from th e stereo bu ss.
Oth er ch an n els will be m u ted.
3. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o
Ch an n el Edit m ode.
104
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Metering Signal Levels
Metering Signal Levels
You can view sign al level m eters for in pu t Ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20 on
th e CHANNEL EDIT/ INPUTS fu n ction page. You can display th is fu n ction
page by pressing the [CHANNEL/ METER] key.
Press the [CHANNEL/ METER] key again to display the CHANNEL EDIT/ OUT-
PUTS fu nction page. This page inclu des m eters for ADAT Ou ts, Stereo
Bu ss Ou t, Rec Bu ss Ou t, Au x Sends, and th e Effect Sends.
You can also m on itor in pu t ch an n el levels for in dividu al ch an n els on
th e correspon din g CH VIEW an d EQ EDIT fu n ction pages. (You can display
th ese pages by pressin g th e [CH VIEW] key or th e correspon din g [EQ
EDIT] key.)
Th e CH VIEW fu n ction page also displays graph ic faders an d n u m erical
valu es to in dicate th e level of th e AUX Sen ds an d th e Effect sen ds. See
You can also m eter stereo ou tpu t levels by watch in g th e dedicated L/ R
or St Bu ss/ Solo LED m eters, wh ich are located to th e righ t of th e LCD
Display.
Th e LED m eters featu re overload (OL) in dicators, wh ich ligh t u p wh en
sign als clip. If th is h appen s, lower th e levels. Oth erwise th e sign al
m ay distort.
View ing Input/ Output Level Meters
1. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey (or t h e [EXIT] k ey in m ost
m odes).
Th e VM200 displays th e first CHANNEL EDIT page, wh ich featu res
in pu t level m eters.
2. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] bu t t on as desired t o t oggle
bet ween t h e in pu t level m et ers an d ou t pu t level m et ers.
CHANNEL EDIT/ INPUT function page (first press of Channel/Meter key)
CHANNEL EDIT/ OUTPUT function page (second press of Channel/Meter key)
VM200 User’s Guide
105
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Monitoring Signals
LED Display Meter (L/ R or ST BUSS/ SOLO)
Th e VM200 featu res two LED m eters to th e righ t of th e LCD Display
th at en able you to view stereo ou tpu t levels. Th ese n in e-segm en t
LED m eters display levels for th e left an d righ t ch an n els (L/ R) or th e
Stereo Bu ss an d soloin g ch an n els (St Bu ss/ Solo).
Th e m eters ran ge from –48 dB to OL (overload). Th e overload in dica-
tor ligh ts wh en th e sign al clips. If an OL LED ligh ts u p wh ile you are
m eterin g levels, redu ce th e stereo ou tpu t level to preven t sign al dis-
tortion .
View ing Individual Channel, Aux Send, and Effect Send Meters
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CH VIEW fu n ction page. [CH VIEW] key an d
all [EQ EDIT] keys flash .
2. Select a t arget ch an n el layer by u sin g a Page Select k ey.
3. Press t h e t arget ch an n el’s [EQ EDIT] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CH VIEW fu n ction page for th e corre-
spon din g ch an n el.
As you m ove th e faders, n otice h ow th e fader icon s m ove to in di-
cate th e fader position s.
CH VIEW function page for Channel 4
channel fader level Aux Send level
EFF Send level
106
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 7
Outputs
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter describes th e ou tpu t con figu ration s of th e VM200,
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
in clu din g th e stereo bu ss ou tpu t, th e recordin g bu ss ou tpu t, th e
ON
AN
P
ADAT an d S/ P DIF digital ou tpu ts, an d th e au xiliary (AUX) sen ds.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Chapter Contents
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
ST BUSS OUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
REC BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
Usin g th e ST BUSS OUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
Mon itorin g th e ST BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
Viewin g th e ST BUSS OUT Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
Usi
SOL
n
O
g th e REC BUSS OUT . . . .
+10
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
-30
-40
0
AN
P
Mon itorin g th e REC BUSS OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
Viewin g th e REC BUSS OUT Meters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
6
-20
14
SOLO
0
AN
P
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
0
Mon itorin g AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
-
ON
-10
Viewin g th e AUX Sen d an d Master Settin g . . . . . . . . . . 116
4
-20
12
+10
0
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
Mu tin g AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
3
1
1
-20
Pairin g AUX Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
Sm ooth in g Fu n ction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
107
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
Overview
Th e VM200 featu res several types of ou tpu ts, in clu din g th e stereo
bu ss ou tpu t, th e recordin g bu ss ou tpu t, th e ADAT an d S/ P DIF dig-
ital ou tpu ts, an d au xiliary (AUX) an d effect (EFF) sen ds.
You can con trol m u ch of th e sign al rou tin g by settin g param eters on
th e ROUTING fu n ction page. You can display th e ROUTING fu n ction page
by pressin g th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key.
Th e Effect Sen d capabilities of th e VM200 are explain ed in m ore
detail in th e “Effects” ch apter page 123.
ST BUSS OUT
Th e VM200 con verts th e digital stereo bu ss (ST BUSS) sign al to an
an alog sign al u sin g 20-bit 128-tim es oversam plin g D/ A con verters.
It th en ou tpu ts it from th e ST BUSS OUT u n balan ced ph on e jack
(located on th e rear pan el) with a –10 dB n om in al ou tpu t level.
To ou tpu t sign als from th ese con n ectors, you n eed to rou te ch an n el
sign als to ST BUSS u sin g th e ROUTING fu n ction page, wh ich you can
access by pressin g th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key. (See “In pu t Ch an n els”
on page 59.)
For m ore in form ation , see “Usin g th e ST BUSS OUT” on page 110.
ST BUSS OUT
ST BUSS OUT
R
L
REC BUSS OUT
Th e VM200 con verts th e digital stereo sign al ou tpu t from th e REC
BUSS to an an alog sign al u sin g 20-bit 128-tim es oversam plin g D/ A
con verters. Th e an alog sign al is th en ou tpu t from th e rear pan el via
th e REC BUSS OUT u n balan ced ph on e jacks with a –10 dB n om in al
ou tpu t level.
To ou tpu t sign als from th ese con n ectors, you n eed to rou te ch an n el
sign als to REC BUSS u sin g th e ROUTING fu n ction page accessed via
th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key. (See “In pu t Ch an n els” on page 59.)
Th e sign als from th e REC BUSS are also rou ted to in pu t ch an n els
1–8. More specifically, th e left ch an n el sign als are rou ted to ch an n els
1, 3, 5, an d 7, an d th e righ t ch an n el sign als are rou ted to ch an n els
2, 4, 6, an d 8. You can th en rou te th e sign als directly to th e ADAT
OUTS 1–8. In th is way, you can ou tpu t two m ixes sim u ltan eou sly.
For m ore in form ation , see “Usin g th e REC BUSS OUT” on page 112.
REC BUSS OUT
REC BUSS OUT
R
4
L
3
ADD.AUX SEND
108
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
ADAT OUT & S/P DIF OUT
Not e: If th e ADD. AUX param eter is tu rn ed on , th e REC BUSS is
ADAT OUT & S/ P DIF OUT
You can ou tpu t digital stereo sign als from th e ADAT OUT an d S/ P
DIF OUT con n ectors.
You can con n ect an y ADAT-com patible recordin g device to th e ADAT
OUT optical con n ector, in clu din g a Fostex VR800 recorder, Alesis®
ADAT, Alesis ADAT-XT, or oth er digital m u ltitrack recorders.
Th e S/ P DIF OUT u ses an optical con n ector. You can u se th is to rou te
th e stereo sign al to an y S/ P DIF form at au dio device, su ch as a com -
pu ter sou n dcard or DAT recorder.
For m ore in form ation , see “Digital Con n ection s” on page 159.
S/P DIF
ADAT
IN
OUT
IN
OUT
ADAT and S/P DIF connections
AUX SEND
You can assign a sign al to AUX Sen ds 1 th rou gh 4. (AUX Sen ds 3 & 4
are available on ly wh en th e ADD. AUX param eter is tu rn ed on . For
Th e AUX Sen ds provide addition al ou tpu ts th at you can u se for a vari-
ety of pu rposes. For exam ple, you can rou te a sign al ou t th e AUX
SENDS to an extern al DAT recorder, talkback system , or oth er appli-
cation .
You can con figu re ch an n el AUX Sen ds as pre-fader or post-fader
sen ds.
REC BUSS OUT
AUX SEND
AUX Sends 1–4
1
R
4
L
3
2
ADD.AUX SEND
VM200 User’s Guide
109
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
Using the ST BUSS OUT
Th e VM200 con verts th e ST BUSS stereo digital sign al to an alog
u sin g 20-bit 128-tim es oversam plin g D/ A con verters. Th e an alog sig-
n al is th en ou tpu t from th e ST BUSS OUT con n ectors on th e rear
pan el. Th ese con n ectors are u n balan ced ph on e jacks with a –10 dB
n om in al ou tpu t level.
Th e sam e ST BUSS stereo digital sign al is also con verted to an S/ P
DIF sign al via th e S/ P DIF en coder an d ou tpu t from th e S/ P DIF OUT
con n ector on th e rear pan el. (For m ore in form ation , see “Usin g S/ P
DIF OUT” on page 168.)
In a typical recordin g setu p, you cou ld u se th e ST BUSS OUT for m as-
ter recordin g.
Monitoring the ST BUSS OUT
You can m on itor th e ST BUSS OUT sign al by con n ectin g th e MONI-
TOR OUT jacks to an am plifier an d speakers. Set th e Mon Sel (Mon -
itor Select) param eter on th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page
to “ST-B” (stereo bu ss) (see page 98).
You can also m on itor th e ST BUSS OUT sign al th rou gh a pair of ste-
reo h eadph on es con n ected to th e PHONES jack. For m ore in form a-
tion , see “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97.
View ing the ST BUSS OUT Meters
You can view th e stereo ou tpu t sign al levels on th e n in e-segm en t
L/ R Stereo/ Solo LED m eters.
You can also view th e stereo ou tpu t level on m eters th at appear on
th e CHANNEL EDIT/ OUTPUTS fu n ction page, wh ich you can display by
pressin g th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key twice.
LED meters
METER
OL
ST BUSS OUT level
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
See th e “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97 for m ore in form ation .
110
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Soloing the ST BUSS OUT
Soloing the ST BUSS OUT
You can solo th e sign al ou tpu t from th e ST BUSS by pressin g th e
[SOLO] key on th e Master ch an n el. Th e Master [SOLO] key ligh ts u p.
Th e Master [SOLO] key works on ly wh en Solo m ode is set to PFL,
wh ich is th e defau lt settin g. If Solo m ode is set to M-Solo, th e Master
[SOLO] key is disabled. For m ore in form ation on Solo m ode, see
page 101.
If you set th e Solo Key param eter to LATCH, pressin g th e [SOLO] key
solos th e stereo ou tpu t u n til you press th e [SOLO] key again . If th e
param eter is set to UNLATCH, th e stereo ou tpu t will solo on ly u n til
you release th e Master [SOLO] key.
Setting the ST BUSS OUT Level
You con trol th e stereo ou tpu t level u sin g th e Master fader.
Sin ce th e Master fader can also con -
SOLO
trol th e Au x an d Effects Sen d m aster
Master SOLO key
levels, depen din g on th e Fader Mode,
ON
you n eed to press th e [CHANNEL] key
Master ON key
before you can adju st th e stereo ou t-
pu t level. Th is places th e VM200 in
Ch an n el Fader Mode, en ablin g th e
Master fader to con trol th e stereo ou t-
pu t level.
0
See “Faders” on page 32 for m ore
-10
in form ation .
-20
-30
-40
Muting the ST BUSS OUT
-60
Master Fader
-
You can m u te th e stereo ou tpu t by
tu rn in g off th e [ON] key for th e Mas-
ter ch an n el. Th e [ON] key ligh ts u p
wh en stereo ou tpu t is on . Tu rn in g off
MASTER
th e [ON] key m u tes th e stereo bu ss
ou tpu t.
Sin ce th e Master [ON] key can also m u te th e Au x an d Effects Sen d
m aster ou tpu ts, depen din g on th e Fader Mode, you m ay n eed to press
th e [CHANNEL] key to place th e VM200 in Ch an n el Fader Mode before
you can m u te th e stereo bu ss ou tpu t.
Th is places th e VM200 in Ch an n el Fader Mode, en ablin g th e Master
[ON] key to m u te th e stereo ou tpu t.
See “[ON] Keys” on page 34 for m ore in form ation .
VM200 User’s Guide
111
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
Using the REC BUSS OUT
Th e VM200 con verts th e REC BUSS stereo sign al to an alog u sin g
20-bit 128-tim es oversam plin g D/ A con verters. Th e an alog sign al is
th en ou tpu t from th e REC BUSS OUT con n ectors on th e rear pan el.
Th ese con n ectors are u n balan ced ph on e jacks with a –10 dB n om in al
ou tpu t level.
Th e REC BUSS also sen ds th e left sign al to ch an n els 1, 3, 5, an d 7,
an d th e righ t sign al to ch an n els 2, 4, 6, an d 8 so th at you can rou te
th em to ADAT OUT 1–8 directly. Th is con figu ration en ables you to
sen d two m ixes to two differen t extern al recorders at th e sam e tim e
(assu m in g on e recorder is ADAT-com patible). (For m ore in form ation
on ADAT OUT con n ection s, see “Digital Con n ection s” on page 159.)
Not e: If th e ADD. AUX param eter is on , th e REC BUSS is disabled.
Fore m ore in form ation , see “En ablin g AUX Sen ds 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX
Param eter)” on page 115.
Monitoring the REC BUSS OUT
You can m on itor th e REC BUSS OUT sign al by con n ectin g th e MON-
ITOR OUT jacks to an am plifier an d speakers. Set th e Mon Sel (Mon -
itor Select) param eter on th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON page to
“REC-B” (see page 98).
You can also m on itor th e REC BUSS OUT sign al th rou gh a pair of ste-
reo h eadph on es con n ected to th e PHONES jack. For m ore in form a-
tion , see “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97.
View ing the REC BUSS OUT Meters
You can view th e REC BUSS OUT level on m eters th at appear on th e
CHANNEL EDIT/ OUTPUTS fu n ction page. You can display th is fu n ction
page by pressin g th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key twice.
See th e “Mon itorin g” ch apter on page 97 for m ore in form ation .
REC BUSS OUT meter
112
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Soloing the REC BUSS OUT
Soloing the REC BUSS OUT
You can solo th e sign al ou tpu t from th e REC BUSS by pressin g th e
REC BUSS [SOLO] key (located n ext to th e Master [SOLO] key). Th e
Rec Bu ss [SOLO] key ligh ts u p. Th e Rec Bu ss [SOLO] key works on ly
wh en Solo m ode is set to PFL, wh ich is th e defau lt settin g. If Solo
m ode is set to M-Solo, th e Rec Bu ss [SOLO] key is disabled. For m ore
in form ation on Solo m ode, see page 101.
If you set th e Solo Key param eter to LATCH, pressin g th e Rec Bu ss
[SOLO] key solos th e stereo ou tpu t u n til you press th e Rec Bu ss [SOLO]
key again . If th e param eter is set to UNLATCH, th e Rec Bu ss ou tpu t
will solo on ly u n til you release th e Rec Bu ss [SOLO] key.
REC BUSS
SOLO
REC BUSS SOLO key
Setting the REC BUSS OUT Level
You can set th e Rec Bu ss ou tpu t level on th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS
fu n ction page.
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ HI Gain rot ary con t rol (ch an n els 7 / 8 ) t o adju st
t h e REC-B GAIN param et er.
Th e REC-B GAIN param eter con trols th e Rec Bu ss Ou t level.
VM200 User’s Guide
113
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
You can adju st th e level (-∞, -90 to 0dB) in 128 in crem en ts. Th e
defau lt settin g is 0dB.
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
FREQ
PAN
Q
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
Not e: If you try to operate th e Gain rotary control wh ile th e ADD.AUX
param eter is tu rn ed ON, th e VM200 displays a warn in g m essage an d you
will be u n able to adju st the REC-B Gain . Use th e EQ/ LO-MID Gain rotary
con trol (ch an n els 3/ 4) to tu rn off th e ADD.AUX param eter on th e CURRENT
SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
114
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using the AUX Sends
Using the AUX Sends
Th e VM200 featu res fou r au xiliary (AUX) sen ds, wh ich en able you to
sen d a sign als to variou s destin ation s. You can sen d sign als from
in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20 to AUX Sen ds 1 th rou gh 4. You can u se
th e fou r AUX Sen ds in dividu ally or in stereo pairs.
REC BUSS OUT
AUX SEND
AUX Sends 1–4
1
R
4
L
3
2
ADD.AUX SEND
You can con figu re each ch an n el AUX Sen d as a pre-fader or
post-fader sen d.
AUX Sen ds 1 th rou gh 4 sign als are rou ted to th e AUX SEND 1
th rou gh 4 jacks respectively. (AUX 3 & 4 are available on ly if you tu rn
on th e ADD.AUX param eter, as described below.)
Th e VM200 also featu res a Sm ooth in g fu n ction th at redu ces CPU load
to ach ieve sm ooth er fader adju stm en t.
Th e VM200 does n ot in clu de dedicated AUX retu rn in pu ts. Use th e
in sert ch an n els to retu rn AUX sign als. For m ore in form ation , see
“In sert Ch an n els 1–4” on page 62.
Enabling AUX Sends 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX Param eter)
If you wish to u se AUX Sen ds 3 & 4, you m u st tu rn on th e ADD. AUX
param eter on th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
ADD.AUX parameter
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO-MID Gain con t rol t o t u rn on t h e ADD.AUX
param et er.
Th e ON in dicator in th e ADD. AUX param eter field flash es.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e ch an ge.
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o display t h e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ct ion page.
Not e: Wh en th e ADD.AUX param eter is tu rn ed on , th e REC BUSS OUT
jacks fu n ction as AUX Sen ds 3 an d 4, an d th e REC BUSS OUT rou tin g
is disabled.
VM200 User’s Guide
115
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
Monitoring AUX Sends
You can m on itor th e REC BUSS OUT sign al by con n ectin g th e MON-
ITOR OUT jacks to an am plifier an d speakers. Set th e Mon Sel (Mon -
itor Select) param eter on th e 1:CLOCK/ MON page to AUX1, AUX2,
AUX3, or AUX4 (see page 98).
You can also m on itor th e REC BUSS OUT sign al th rou gh a pair of ste-
reo h eadph on es con n ected to th e PHONES jack. For m ore in form a-
tion , see “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97.
View ing the AUX Send and Master Setting
You can view th e AUX Sen d level an d sen d m aster level on m eters
th at appear on th e CH VIEW fu n ction page an d th e Ch an n el Edit/ Ou t-
pu ts fu n ction page respectively.
To view th e AUX Sen d level, press th e [CH VIEW] key to display th e
1:CH VIEW fu n ction page, press a Page Select key to select th e desired
ch an n el layer, an d press th e [EQ EDIT] key for th e Au x Sen d ch an n el.
You can display th e CHANNEL EDIT/ OUTPUTS fu n ction page to view th e
AUX Sen d m aster level by pressin g th e [CHANNEL/ METER] key twice.
See “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97 for m ore in form ation .
116
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Sending Channel Signals to AUX Sends
Sending Channel Signals to AUX Sends
You can sen d sign als from in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20 to AUX Sen ds
1 th rou gh 4.
If th e AUX Sen d is con figu red post-fader (see “Pre-fader/ Post-fader
AUX Sen ds” below), first raise th e ch an n el’s regu lar fader l prior to
step 1 by pressin g th e [CHANNEL] bu tton , an d th en raisin g th e fader.
1. In t h e Fader Mode sect ion , press t h e [AUX1 ], [AUX2 ], [AUX3 ], or
[AUX4 ] k ey t o select an AUX Sen d.
Th e faders n ow fu n ction as ch an n el AUX Sen d con trols for th e
selected AUX Sen d.
Not e: If th e ADD. AUX param eter is on , th e REC BUSS is disabled. Fore
ter)” on page 115.
2. Raise t h e fader of t h e ch an n el you wan t t o sen d t o t h e AUX
Sen d.
3. Use t h e Mast er fader t o adju st t h e AUX Sen ds m ast er level.
Wh en ch an n els are con figu red as stereo pairs th eir AUX Sen d
con trols are lin ked. (See “Pairin g Ch an n els” on page 68).
Not e: If th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction is set to Level 2 (defau lt), AUX1 an d EFF1
are lin ked, an d AUX2 an d EFF2 are lin ked. Th erefore, settin g th e AUX1
level also sets EFF1 to th e sam e level; sim ilarly, settin g th e AUX2 level
sets EFF2 to th e sam e level. If th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction is set to Level 1,
you m ay h ear a sligh t steppin g n oise wh en you m ove th e fader. For m ore
in form ation on th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction , see “Sm ooth in g Fu n ction ” on
page 120.
Pre-fader/ Post-fader AUX Sends
You can con figu re each AUX Sen d as pre-fader or post-fader by
adju stin g param eters on th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
Pre-fader sign als do n ot pass th rou gh th e ch an n el faders an d are
th erefore u n affected by ch an n el fader settin gs. Post-fader sign als
pass th rou gh th e ch an n el faders an d are affected by ch an n el fader
settin gs.
Follow th ese steps to con figu re each AUX Sen d as pre-fader or
post-fader.
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
pre-fader/post-fader AUX Sends
VM200 User’s Guide
117
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
2. Use t h e Freq an d Q rot ary con t rols for ch an n els 1 –4 t o select
PRE or POST for AUX1 , AUX2 , AUX3 , an d AUX4 .
Th e defau lt settin g is POST.
Wh en you ch an ge th e settin g, th e selected valu e flash es.
3. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o display t h e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ct ion page.
Muting AUX Sends
You can m u te th e AUX Sen d Masters by tu rn in g off th e [ON] key for
th e Master ch an n el.
Sin ce th e Master [ON] key can also m u te th e Stereo Bu ss an d Effects
Sen d m aster ou tpu ts, depen din g on th e Fader Mode, you n eed to
press th e [AUX1], [AUX2], [AUX3], or [AUX4] key to select an AUX Sen d
before you can m u te it.
1. Press t h e [AUX1 ], [AUX2 ], [AUX3 ], or [AUX4 ] k ey t o select an AUX
Sen d.
Th e selected AUX key flash es.
2. Use t h e MASTER [ON] bu t t on t o t u rn t h e AUX Sen d on an d off.
Wh en AUX Sen ds are con figu red as stereo pairs, th eir [ON] bu tton s
are lin ked (see “Pairin g Ch an n els” on page 68).
See “[ON] Keys” on page 34 for m ore in form ation .
SOLO
ON
Master ON key
118
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Pairing AUX Sends
Pairing AUX Sends
You can pair AUX Sen ds 1 an d 2 an d AUX Sen ds 3 an d 4 for stereo
sign al processin g.
Wh en paired, th e Master Faders, [ON] keys, an d m on itors of each AUX
Sen d are set th e sam e an d lin ked for sim u ltan eou s con trol.
Follow th ese steps to pair AUX Sen ds:
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
AUX PAIR parameters
2. Use t h e Freq an d Q rot ary con t rols for ch an n els 7 / 8 t o t u rn
t h e A1 &A2 an d A3 &4 param et ers On or Off.
Th e defau lt settin g is “off.”
If you ch an ge th e param eter settin g, th e in dicator flash es.
3. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o ret u rn t o Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Not e: If th e ADD. AUX param eter is on , th e REC BUSS is disabled. For
m ore in form ation , see “En ablin g AUX Sen ds 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX Param e-
ter)” on page 115.
Not e: Wh en AUX1 an d 2 are paired, th e AUX1 sign al is sen t to th e left
ch an n el an d AUX2 sign al is sen t to th e righ t. Sim ilarly, wh en AUX3 an d
4 are paired, th e AUX3 sign al is sen t to th e left ch an n el an d th e AUX4
sign al is sen t to th e righ t ch an n el.
Not e: If th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction is set to Level 2 (defau lt), th e AUX pair
settin g will affect th e EFF pair settin g. For m ore in form ation on th e
Sm ooth in g fu n ction , see “Sm ooth in g Fu n ction ” on page 120.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
119
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
Sm oothing Function
Depen din g on th e sou n d you are m ixin g, you m ay h ear a sligh t step-
pin g n oise wh en you slide th e faders. Th is in dicates an overloaded
CPU. To resolve th is problem , th e VM200 featu res a Sm ooth in g fu n c-
tion th at redu ces CPU load to ach ieve sm ooth er fader adju stm en t.
Wh en th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction is set to Level 2, AUX1 an d EFF1 are
lin ked an d AUX2 an d EFF2 are lin ked. Th erefore, th e level settin gs,
pair settin gs, an d pan settin gs for AUX Sen d 1 an d AUX Sen d 2 will
be applied to th e level settin gs, pair settin gs, an d pan settin gs for
EFF1 an d EFF2. However, fader operation will be m u ch fin er.
Follow th e steps below to set th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction . Th e defau lt set-
tin g is Sm ooth in g “LEVEL 2.”
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
Smoothing parameter
2. Use t h e EQ/ HI-MID Gain rot ary con t rol t o t oggle bet ween
Level1 an d Level2 .
Level 1: AUX Sen ds 1/ 2 an d EFF Sen ds 1/ 2 are n ot lin ked, bu t
th e faders’ sm ooth in g fu n ction m ay be coarse, an d depen din g on
th e sou n d, you m ay h ear a sligh t steppin g n oise wh en you slide
th e faders in AUX Sen d m ode.
Level 2: AUX Sen d 1 an d EFF Sen d 1 are lin ked, an d AUX Sen d 2
an d EFF Sen d 2 are lin ked. Th e level settin gs, pair settin g, an d
pan settin g for AUX Sen d 1 an d AUX Sen d 2 will be applied to th e
level settin gs, pair settin gs, an d pan settin gs for EFF1 an d EFF2.
However, fader operation will be m u ch sm ooth er an d you sh ou ld
n ot h ear an y n oise.
Not e: If th e EQ En able param eter in th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS page is set
to “1–16,” th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction rem ain s Level 2 even if you can ch an ge
to Level 1 on th e display.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e set t in g.
120
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Viewing Buss Routing for Each Channel
View ing Buss Routing for Each Channel
Th e CH VIEW fu n ction page in clu des a ROUT display th at in dicates
wh eth er th e specified ch an n el is rou ted to th e ADAT Direct Ou ts, th e
Stereo Bu ss, or th e Record Bu ss.
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey.
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e desired ch an n el.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:CH VIEW fu n ction page, wh ich in clu des
th e ROUT in dicator in th e top cen ter of th e display.
Th e D, R, an d S in dicators represen t th e ADAT Direct Ou ts, th e
Record Bu ss, an d th e Stereo Bu ss. A h igh ligh ted (dark) in dicator
m ean s th e ch an n el is bein g sen t to th e specified bu ss.
ROUT D, R, S indicator
VM200 User’s Guide
121
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Outputs
122
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 8
Effects
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter describes h ow to apply th e VM200 in tern al effects to
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
th e sign als, an d h ow to recall, store, an d edit th e program s in th e
ON
AN
P
Effects library.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
Th is ch apter also in clu des a com plete effects param eter list.
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
Chapter Contents
AN
P
-10
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-60
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
6
Mu tin g Effect Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
Mon itorin g Effects Sen ds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
0
AN
P
-
ON
Con trollin g th e Retu rn Sign als . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
-10
EQ EDIT
5
Settin g th e Effect Retu rn Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
Pan n in g Effects Retu rn s . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
-40
0
-
ON
4
12
20
+10
-30
0
-
AIR/
P
GROUP
3
1
1
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
123
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
VM200 Effects
Th e VM200 featu res two on -board stereo m u lti-effects processors
(EFF1, EFF2) that provide a wide range of high -qu ality effects, inclu d-
ing reverbs, delays, choru ses, flan gers, and m ore.
Th ese in tern al effect processors u se A.S.P. (Fostex Advan ced Sign al
Processin g Tech n ology, developed exclu sively by Fostex). Th is tech -
n ology extracts m axim u m efficien cy from lim ited DSP power. It
ach ieves an overwh elm in gly h igh -den sity Early Reflection sou n d an d
a sm ooth High Du m p respon se th rou gh th e application of H.F.A.
(Harm on ic Feedback Algorith m ). Fu rth erm ore, it carries ou t an elab-
orate reverb sim u lation to create clear sou n ds th rou gh H.D.L.P.
(Hi-Den sity Logarith m ic Processin g), wh ich elim in ates th e m u tu al
in terferen ce between th e n u m erou s in tegrated delay m odu les an d
redu ces son ic im pu rities an d “grit.”
Th e VM200 in clu des an Effects Library th at con tain s 50 Preset pro-
for m ore in form ation .
You can recall an d edit an y Preset or User program to create a n ew
effect, th en store it in an y User program location .
You can load differen t effect program s to processors EFF1 an d EFF2
an d rou te sign als th rou gh eith er as desired.
To recall an effect, press th e EFF1 or EFF2 to specify th e processor
you wish to u se. Th en press th e Recall key an d select th e effect from
To edit an effect, press th e EFF1 or EFF2 key to display th e EFF1 or
EFF2 fu n ction pages, wh ich in clu de th e n am e an d n u m ber of th e
selected effect an d a set of param eters associated with th e effect. You
can adju st th e param eters u sin g th e rotary con trols (Gain , Freq, Q).
Effect bu sses 1 an d 2 feed effects processors 1 an d 2 respectively.
Processed sign als retu rn to ch an n els 17–20.
You m ay apply effects to in pu t ch an n els 1–20.
You can also store effects selection in Scen e Mem ory.
124
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Library
Effects Library
Th e VM200 also in clu des an Effects Library th at con tain s 50 Preset
program s an d 50 User program s.
Effect Preset Library List
Th e followin g table lists th e Preset effect program s. See “Effects
Reverb effects
#
Name
Display
Description
Normal Large
Hall
Conventional large hall, with sonic detail, clarity,
and an appropriate amount of early reflections.
00
NomL.Hall
Lo-Freq Large
Hall
Large hall with lingering low-frequency reverb
components.
01
02
LowL.Hall
Presence Large
Hall
PrsL.HALL
Reverb with crispness and good presence.
Reverb with restrained high-frequency range and
gentle character.
03 Wet Large Hall
04 Stadium
WetL.HALL
STADIUM
NomS.Hall
Stadium reverb with many long early reflections.
Normal Small
Conventional small hall, with sonic detail, clarity,
and an appropriate amount of early reflections.
05
Hall
Lo-Freq Small
Hall
Small hall with lingering low-frequency reverb
components.
06
LowS.HALL
PrsS.HALL
WetS.HALL
NoER.HALL
Nom.ROOM
GARAGE
Presence Small
Hall
General-purpose small hall with crisp sound and
few early reflections.
07
Small hall with little high-frequency range and
calming effects.
08 Wet Small Hall
09 No-E/R Hall
10 Normal Room
11 Garage
Small hall with no early reflections, and the entire
frequency range decays in the same way.
Conventional room reverb simulating a nice space
with just enough “sparkle.”
Room reverb with crisp presence simulating a
small, live space such as a garage.
Room reverb simulating a small, dead room. Add
12 Dead Room
Dead.ROOM just a bit of this to give warmth to a sound. Ideal
for narrations.
All-purpose room reverb with few early reflections
and good definition.
13 Presence Room
14 Drum_Booth
15 Normal Plate
Prs.ROOM
Dr.BOOTH
Room reverb simulating a drum booth.
Contemporary-feeling plate reverb with a wide
bandwidth.
Nom.PLATE
Conventional plate reverb with the character of
classic plate devices.
16 Old Plate
Old.PLATE
17 Presence Plate
18 Wet Plate
Prs.PLATE
Wet.PLATE
Crisp plate reverb with extended highs.
Plate reverb with a gentle character.
Plate reverb emphasizing a digital feel, with metal-
lic-sounding early reflection.
19 Digital Plate
DigiPLATE
VM200 User’s Guide
125
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
#
Name
Display
Description
The early reflections of an ideal vocal booth plus
short reverberation with extended high range.This
adds sparkle to the sound, and is effective when
you want to make the vocal stand out in the
ensemble.
Presence Vocal
Booth
20
PVo.BOOTH
The early reflections of an ideal vocal booth plus
gentle short reverberation. This adds a natural
feeling of air, and is effective with simple arrange-
ments with an unhurried vocal.
Natural Vocal
Booth
21
NVo.BOOTH
All-around reverb that makes any vocal sound
great.
22 Vocal Reverb
23 Solo Vocal
Vo.REVERB
Solo.VO
Spacious short delay plus a reverb with a real
plate character. Blends naturally into any back-
ground.
Spacious stadium-type early reflections plus short
reverberation with extended high range. Good for
chorus parts.
24 Arena Vocal
Arena VO
Early Reflection-type Reverbs
#
Name
Display
Description
Normal Gate
Reverb
25
Nom.GATE
Standard gate reverb
Lo-Freq Mono
Kick Gate
Gate reverb tuned for kick drums, with pan set to
the center.
26
27
MnBD.GATE
StSD.GATE
Hi-Freq Stereo
Snare Gate
Gate reverb tuned for snare drums and percussion
28 Hall E/R
Hall.ER
Simulation of early reflections in a large hall.
Simulation of early reflections in a room.
Simulation of early reflections of a spring reverb.
29 Room E/R
30 Spring E/R
31 Random E/R
32 Reverse E/R
Room.ER
Spring.ER
Random.ER Random early reflections.
Reverse.ER
Reversed early reflections of a hall reverb.
Delays
#
Name
Display
Description
Mono delay with longer delay time, which can cre-
ate special effects using HPF and LPF.
33 Mono Delay
MonoDELAY
34 Pan Delay
35 Dual Delay
Pan.DELAY
DualDELAY
Panning delay that pans sound left to right.
Two independent delays.
3-tap delay, which can create interesting effects
with your wizardry.
36 3ch Delay
3ch.DELAY
Modulation effects
#
Name
Display
Description
37 Chorus
CHORUS
Standard chorus effect setting.
38 3D Chorus
3D.CHORUS More natural and spacious effects than Chorus.
Standard flanging effect setting.You can pan two
FLANGE
39 Flange
types of effects sound to any position.
126
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effect Preset Library List
Pitch Changer
#
Name
Display
Description
40 Mono PitCh
MonoPITCH
Standard pitch shifter.
Stereo pitch shift with two channels pitch-shifted
independently.
41 Dual PitCh
DualPITCH
Multi-effects
#
Name
Display
Description
Mono Delay
-Normal Hall
42
MnDL-NmHL Combination of mono delay and hall reverb.
MnDL-NmPL Combination of mono delay and plate reverb.
PnDL-NmHL Combination of pan delay and hall reverb.
PnDL-NmPL Combination of pan delay and plate reverb.
CHORS-REV An effect which adds reverb to chorus.
REV-CHORS An effect which adds chorus to reverb.
Mono Delay
-Normal Plate
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
Panning Delay
-Normal Hall
Panning Delay
-Normal Plate
CHORUS-
REVERB
REVERB-
CHORUS
FLANGE-
REVERB
FLG-REV
REV-FLG
An effect which adds reverb to flange.
An effect which adds flange to reverb.
REVERB
-FLANGE
VM200 User’s Guide
127
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Applying Effects
To apply an effect, you m u st do two th in gs:
❑ rou te th e sign al to on e of two effects processors, an d
❑ retu rn th e processed sign al back to th e m ix.
Th e followin g section s explain th ese tasks.
Not e: Wh en EQ En able param eter is set to “EQ1–16,” both effects proces-
sors are disabled. For m ore in form ation , see “EQ En ablin g Ch an n els” on
page 80.
Selecting an Effects Processor
1. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
2. Ch eck t h e in pu t ch an n el, t u rn on t h e [ON] k ey, an d raise t h e
fader for t h e ch an n el.
3. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit sect ion t o select
an effect s processor.
Th e selected key ligh ts u p an d th e VM200 displays th e EFF EDIT
fu n ction page, wh ich in clu des param eters for th e cu rren t effect.
4. Recall t h e desired effect s program from t h e Effect s Library.
(For m ore in form ation on h ow to recall th e effects program , see
Setting Effects Return
Before you sen d a sign al to an effects processor, you m u st set u p a
rou tin g path to retu rn it to th e m ix so it can be m on itored an d ou tpu t.
Follow th e steps below:
5. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey, t h en t h e [1 7 –2 0 EFF RTN]
k ey.
Th e [17–20 EFF RTN] key ligh ts u p.
128
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Sending Signal to Effects Processor
6. Lower t h en raise t h e faders t h at correspon d t o t h e effect you
are u sin g for ret u rn sign als. Mak e su re t h e correspon din g
ch an n el [ON] k ey is t u rn ed on .
(Ch an n els 17 & 18 faders con trol th e EFF1 processor; ch an n els
19 & 20 faders con trol EFF2.)
You m u st lower th en raise th e fader to set th e in itial retu rn level.
(See “Faders” on page 32 for m ore in form ation .)
7. Adju st t h e PAN con t rol for t h e effect s ret u rn ch an n el if you
desire.
Sending Signal to Effects Processor
8. Press t h e [1 –8 ANALOG IN] Page Select k ey.
Th e [17–20 EFF RTN] key LED tu rn s off an d th e [1–8 ANALOG IN]
Page Select key ligh ts u p.
9. Press t h e [EFF1 ] k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion . (If you are
u sin g t h e EFF2 processor, press t h e [EFF2 ] k ey.)
Th e [EFF1] key flash es oran ge an d th e [AUX1] key flash es red in th e
Fader Mode section .
10. Lower t h en raise t h e fader for t h e ch an n el you wish t o rou t e
t o t h e effect s processor. Th en lower an d raise t h e Mast er fader
t o set t h e desired effect s sen d sign al level.
Th is sen ds th e ch an n el sign al to th e selected effects processor.
Th e effects sen d m eter in th e CH VIEW fu n ction page displays th e
level of th e effects sen d sign al, in dicatin g th at sign als are bein g fed
to th e selected effects processor. As you raise th e faders, you
sh ou ld h ear m ore of th e effect sou n d.
If in pu t ch an n els are paired, th eir effect sen d con trols will be
lin ked.
You can edit an d store effects settin gs. Refer to “Storin g Effects
Not e: If you set th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction to Level 2 (defau lt), AUX1 an d
EFF1 are lin ked, an d AUX2 an d EFF2 are lin ked. Th erefore, settin g th e
EFF1 level will set AUX1 to th e sam e level. Sim ilarly, settin g th e EFF2 level
sets AUX2 to th e sam e level. If th e Sm ooth in g fu n ction is set to Level 1, you
m ay h ear a sligh t steppin g n oise wh en you m ove th e fader. For m ore in for -
m ation , see “Sm ooth in g Fu n ction ” on page 120.
Routing Effects Returns
On ce you ’ve rou ted a sign al to an effects processor an d retu rn ed it to
th e m ix as described in th e precedin g section s, you can rou te it to sev-
eral destin ation s.
You can rou te Effects retu rn s to th e stereo bu ss (ST BUSS) or th e
recordin g bu ss (REC BUSS). See “Rou tin g In pu t Ch an n els” on
page 66 for m ore in form ation .
You can also rou te sign als to AUX Sen ds 1 th rou gh 4. (Note th at th e
REC BUSS OUT is disabled if AUX Sen ds 3 an d 4 are selected).
VM200 User’s Guide
129
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Controlling the Sends Signals
Pre-fader/ Post-fader Effect Sends
You can con figu re each Effect Sen d on in pu t ch an n els 1 th rou gh 20
as “pre-fader” or “post-fader” by adju stin g param eters on th e CURRENT
SCENE STATUS fu n ction page.
Pre-fader sign als do n ot pass th rou gh th e ch an n el faders an d are
th erefore u n affected by ch an n el fader settin gs. Post-fader sign als
pass th rou gh th e ch an n el faders an d are affected by ch an n el fader
settin gs.
Th e ch an n el faders en able you to adju st th e ch an n el level an d th e
Effect Sen d level of post-fader sign als sim u ltan eou sly.
Follow th e steps below to select “pre-fader” or “post-fader” for an
effect processor.
1. Press t h e [CURRENT SCENE STATUS] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CURRENT SCENE STATUS fu n ction page:
2. Rot at e t h e Freq an d Q rot ary con t rols for ch an n els 5 –6 t o
select PRE or POST for t h e EFF1 an d EFF2 param et ers.
Th e defau lt settin g is “POST.”
Wh en you ch an ge th e settin g, th e selected valu e flash es.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e select ion .
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o display t h e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ct ion page.
View ing and Adjusting the Effect Send Level
Th e VM200 en ables you to view an d adju st effect sen d levels for
effects processors EFF1 an d EFF2 on th e Ch an n el View (CH VIEW)
fu n ction page. A graph ic im age of a fader an d a n u m erical valu e rep-
resen t th e sen d levels on th e display.
To view an d adju st th e effect sen d levels, follow th ese steps:
1. Press t h e [CH VIEW] k ey.
Th e [CH VIEW] key an d all [EQ EDIT] keys flash .
130
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Viewing and Adjusting the Effect Send Master Level
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:CH VIEW fu n ction page, wh ich in clu des
graph ic an d n u m eric in dicators of th e effect sen d levels for EFF1
an d EFF2.
channel number
effect send fader level
2. If you wish t o adju st t h e effect sen d level, specify a ch an n el
wh ose fader you wish t o u se by pressin g a Page Select k ey an d
t h e [EQ EDIT] k ey for t h e ch an n el.
Th e VM200 displays a n ew ch an n el n u m ber in th e CH section ,
n ear th e u pper -left corn er of th e display.
3. Press t h e EFF1 or EFF2 k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion t o
specify an effect s processor.
Th e selected key flash es.
4. Raise t h e fader for t h e correspon din g ch an n el.
Th e graph ic fader an d n u m erical read-ou t on th e display reflect
th e adju stm en t in real-tim e.
View ing and Adjusting the Effect Send Master Level
You can con trol Effect Sen d m aster levels u sin g th e Master fader in
th e appropriate Fader Mode.
1. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion t o
specify t h e effect s processor you wish t o adju st .
Th e selected key flash es.
2. Raise or lower t h e Mast er fader t o adju st t h e Effect Sen d m as-
t er level.
Th e Effect Sen ds m aster level is displayed on th e ou tpu t ch an n el
page of th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page (also called th e “CHANNEL
EDIT/ OUTPUT” fu n ction page).
effect send master level
VM200 User’s Guide
131
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Muting Effect Sends
You can m u te Effect Sen d m asters u sin g th e Master [ON] key. Th e
fu n ction of th is key depen ds on th e selected Fader m ode. See “[ON]
Keys” on page 34 for m ore in form ation .
1. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion t o
select Effect Sen d 1 or 2 .
2. Press t h e Mast er [ON] k ey t o t u rn t h e Effect Sen d on or off.
Monitoring Effects Sends
You can m on itor th e EFF sen d sign al by con n ectin g th e MONITOR
OUT jacks to an am plifier an d speakers. Set th e Mon Sel (Mon itor
Select) param eter on th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1: CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page to
EFF1 or EFF2.
You can also m on itor th e EFF sen d sign al th rou gh a pair of stereo
h eadph on es con n ected to th e PHONES jack. For m ore in form ation ,
see “Mon itorin g Sign als” on page 97.
Controlling the Return Signals
Th is section explain s h ow to set levels an d pan effect retu rn .
Setting the Effect Return Level
You can u se the channels 17–20 faders to adju st the Effect retu rn level.
1. Press t h e [CHANNEL] k ey in t h e Fader Mode sect ion .
2. Press t h e [1 7 –2 0 EFF RTN] Page Select k ey.
3. Raise t h e ch an n el fader t o adju st t h e level.
You can view th e effect retu rn level on th e CHANNEL EDIT/ INPUT fu n c-
tion page.
effect return level
Panning Effects Returns
Th e Ch an n els 17–20 pan pots pan sign als between th e left an d righ t
ch an n els of th e Stereo Bu ss Ou t an d Rec Bu ss Ou t, an d th e odd an d
even AUX bu ss ou ts. See “Pan n in g In pu t Ch an n els” on page 65 for
m ore in form ation .
132
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Library
Effects Library
Th e VM200 stores effects settin gs as program s in th e Effects Library,
wh ich con tain s 50 Preset program s (0–49) an d 50 User program s
(50–99).
Th e Preset effects program s are design ed for specific application s an d
in stru m en ts, an d in clu de n u m erou s reverbs, delays, ch oru ses,
You can cu stom ize th e Preset program s, assign each on e a n am e, an d
store th em as User program s.
You can load effects from th e Effects Library to eith er effects proces-
sor (EFF1 or EFF2).
Editing Effects
You can edit effects program s an d th en store th em as u ser program s
in program n u m bers 50–99.
1. Recall t h e effect you wish t o edit t o t h e EFF1 or EFF2 proces-
sor.
tion on recallin g effects.
2. Press t h e correspon din g [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit
sect ion .
(If you recalled th e effect to EFF1 in step 1, press th e [EFF1] key in
th is step, etc.)
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF EDIT fu n ction page for th e selected
effect, an d th e selected key ligh ts u p.
3. Use t h e Gain , Freq, an d Q rot ary con t rols t o adju st t h e valu e
of each param et er.
If you wish to store th e ch an ge, refer to “Storin g Effects Program s”
on page 135.
4. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o ret u rn t o Ch an n el Edit m ode.
page 139.
VM200 User’s Guide
133
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Recalling Effects Program s
You can recall Effects program s 0 th rou gh 99.
1. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit sect ion t o specify
t h e effect s processor t o wh ich you wan t t o recall t h e effect .
Th e VM200 displays th e fu n ction page for th e effect cu rren tly
loaded to th e effects processor. Th e [EFF1] or [EFF2] key you
selected ligh ts u p.
2. Press t h e [RECALL] k ey in t h e Eff Library sect ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction page, an d th e
[EFF1] or [EFF2] key flash es.
scroll list
3. Use t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o select t h e
desired effect program n u m ber from t h e program list in g on
t h e fu n ct ion page.
4. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 recalls th e effect program to th e specified effects pro-
cessor an d displays th e selected effect’s param eter fu n ction page.
5. You can press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o ret u rn t o Ch an n el Edit m ode
at an y t im e.
Not e: If an effect program in th e library con tain s n o data, th e term
“NO_DATA” will appear on th e display. You can n ot recall su ch program s
u n til you store effect data in th e program .
134
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing Effects Programs
Storing Effects Program s
You can store effect settin gs in User program s 50 th rou gh 99.
1. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit sect ion t o specify
t h e effect s processor t o wh ich you wan t t o st ore t h e effect .
Th e VM200 displays th e fu n ction page for th e effect cu rren tly
loaded to th e effects processor, an d th e [EFF1] or [EFF2] key you
selected ligh ts u p.
You can m odify an y Preset program or previou sly-stored User pro-
gram . Make an y adju stm en ts you like, th en con tin u e with th is
procedu re to store th e “n ew” effect.
2. Press t h e [STORE] k ey in t h e Eff Library sect ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY STORE fu n ction page, an d th e
[EFF1] or [EFF2] key flash es.
3. Rot at e t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o select an
Effect program locat ion .
Th e effect program n u m bers an d n am es scroll in th e u pper -righ t
of th e display. You can select program n u m bers 50 to 99, in clu -
sive. Effect program s th at con tain n o data are labeled “(No Data)”.
4. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page, wh ich
en ables you to n am e or re-n am e effect program s. Th e program
title appears in th e u pper -righ t of th e display.
character set box
title box
character-selector
cursor
Th e EFF LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page in clu des a ch aracter set
box th at displays all th e letters of th e alph abet, as well as n u m er -
als an d pu n ctu ation sym bols. You can u se th ese ch aracters to
n am e or title you r effect program .
You can u se an y trian gle of Gain , Freq, an d Q rotary con trols to
select th e ch aracters for th e title.
VM200 User’s Guide
135
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Th e Gain con trol m oves th e cu rsor position left an d righ t in th e
title box. Th e Freq con trol m oves th e ch aracter -selector u p an d
down th e m atrix; th e Q con trol m oves th e ch aracter -selector left
an d righ t.
You can also press th e [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to m ove th e cu rsor
an d rotate th e Data Wh eel to select ch aracters or n u m bers.
5. Rot at e t h e Freq an d Q rot ary con t rols t o select a ch aract er,
t h en t u rn t h e Gain rot ary con t rol on e n ot ch righ t t o m ove
t h e cu rsor t o t h e n ext space in t h e n am e, an d repeat t h e pro-
cess.
Th e very u sefu l “Space to En d” option in th e lower -righ t corn er of
th e ch aracter set box will fill-in th e rem ain der of you r title with
blan k spaces.
6. Wh en you ’ve fi n ish ed n am in g t h e program , press t h e [ENTER]
k ey t o st ore t h e Effect program .
Th e followin g warn in g dialog appears for a brief m om en t.
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to th e flash
m em ory or you m ay dam age th e VM200.
After th e warn in g, th e VM200 displays th e EFF EDIT fu n ction page.
7. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey an y t im e t o exit t h e EFF LIBRARY STORE or
EFF LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ct ion pages.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
136
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing Effect Program Titles
Editing Effect Program Titles
You can edit Effect program titles, ju st in case you wan t to ch an ge
th eir n am e for som e reason . To do so, you recall th e target Effect pro-
gram to a ch an n el, th en re-store it with a differen t title.
1. Press t h e [EFF1 ] or [EFF2 ] k ey in t h e Eff Edit sect ion t o specify
t h e effect s processor t o wh ich you wan t t o recall t h e effect .
Th e VM200 displays th e fu n ction page for th e effect cu rren tly
loaded to th e effects processor, an d th e [EFF1] or [EFF2] key you
selected ligh ts u p.
2. Press t h e [RECALL] k ey in t h e Eff Library sect ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY RECALL fu n ction page, an d th e
[EFF1] or [EFF2] key flash es.
3. Rot at e t h e Dat a Wh eel or u se t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o
select an Effect program you wish t o ren am e.
You can n ot ch an ge th e title of Preset program s 00–49.
4. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o recall t h e desired Effect program .
Th e VM200 recalls th e effect program to th e specified effects pro-
cessor an d displays th e selected effect’s param eter fu n ction page.
5. Press t h e [STORE] k ey in t h e Eff Library sect ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY STORE fu n ction page, an d th e
[EFF1] or [EFF2] key flash es.
VM200 User’s Guide
137
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
6. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e EFF LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ction page. Th e
title box sh ows th e program n u m ber an d th e cu rren t n am e.
character set box
title box
character-selector
cursor
Use an y Gain , Freq, an d Q rotary con trols to re-assign a n am e to
th e Effect program .
You can also press th e [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to m ove th e cu rsor
an d rotate th e Data Wh eel to select ch aracters or n u m bers.
in form ation on assign in g a n am e.
7. Wh en you ’ve fi n ish ed re-n am in g t h e program , press t h e
[ENTER] k ey t o st ore t h e n ew Effect program t it le.
Th e followin g warn in g dialog appears for a brief m om en t.
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to th e flash
m em ory or you m ay dam age th e VM200.
After th e warn in g, th e VM200 displays th e EFF EDIT fu n ction page.
8. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey an y t im e t o exit t h e EFF LIBRARY STORE or EQ
LIBRARY NAME EDIT fu n ct ion pages.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
138
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Parameters
Effects Param eters
Th e followin g tables list th e param eters of each effect type. Th e n u m -
bers in paren th eses in dicate th e preset effects th at belon g to th e
effect types.
Reverb-type Effects (00–24)
Parameter
REV TIME
Value
Description
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Length of the reverberation.
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
PRE DLY
DENSITY
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
1
Density of the reverb.
0–10, AUTO
Volume balance between the early reflections
and the reverb. Only ER with 0%, and only reverb
with 100%.
E/R BAL
0–100 [%] (1 step)
ROOM SIZE
E/R FB
0.1–2.0 (0.1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–10 (1 step)
The size of the room (relative to E/R).
Degree of repeated early reflections
Left/right spread of the reverb effects.
DIFFUSION
Length of the low frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to the REV.TIME.
LO RATIO
HI RATIO
0.1–2.0 (0.1 step)
0.1–2.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
2
PRESENCE
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
1. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
2. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
Early Reflection-type Effects (25–32)
Parameter
Value
Description
ROOM SIZE
0.1–2.0 (0.1 step)
The size of the room (relative to E/R).
0–200 [ms] (1 step)
TBD
Delay time from the dry sound until the early
reflections of the reverb are heard.
INI.DLY
1
LIVENESS
E/R FB
Adjusts how the reflections decay.
Degree of repeated early reflections
Low frequency amount of the feedback.
Low frequency amount of the feedback.
Left/right spread of the reflections.
0–10 (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
0–10 (1 step)
LO RATIO
HI RATIO
DIFFUSION
VM200 User’s Guide
139
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Parameter
DENSITY
Value
0–10 (1 step)
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
Description
Density of the reverb.
2
PRESENCE
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
1. 0: dead, 10: live
2. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
MONO_DELAY (33)
Parameter
Value
Description
1
DELAY TIME
0.1–1360.0 [ms] (0.1 step)
Delay time.
Tempo value used to calculate DELAY TIME and
TEMPO
NOTE
30–250 [bps] (1 step)
2
NOTE.
3
Note value used to calculate DELAY TIME.
DELAY FB
LO RATIO
HI RATIO
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Amount of delay feedback.
Low frequency amount of the feedback.
High frequency amount of the feedback.
THRU, Same as EQ
value [Hz]
HPF
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the high pass filter.
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Same as EQ value [Hz],
THRU
1. If you adjust DELAY TIME, NOTE will be automatically changed.
2. If you adjust TEMPO, DELAY TIME will be automatically changed.
3. If you adjust NOTE, DELAY TIME will be automatically changed.
PAN_DELAY (34)
Parameter
Value
Description
1
DELAY TIME
TEMPO
0.1–1360.0 [ms] (0.1 step)
Delay time.
Tempo value used to calculate DELAY TIME and
30–250 [bps] (1 step)
2
NOTE.
3
NOTE
Note value used to calculate DELAY TIME.
DELAY FB
LO RATIO
HI RATIO
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Amount of delay feedback.
Low frequency amount of the feedback.
High frequency amount of the feedback.
140
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Parameters
Parameter
HPF
Value
Description
Cut-off frequency of the high pass filter.
THRU, Same as EQ
value [Hz]
PAN1
PAN2
L10.0–0.0–R100 (0.5 step) Pan position of the first delay.
L10.0–0.0–R100 (0.5 step) Pan position of the second delay.
Same as EQ value [Hz],
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
THRU
LPF
1. If you adjust DELAY TIME, NOTE will be automatically changed.
2. If you adjust TEMPO, DELAY TIME will be automatically changed.
3. If you adjust NOTE, DELAY TIME will be automatically changed.
DUAL_DELAY (35)
Parameter
Value
Description
1
DLYTIME1/2
TEMPO
0.0–680.0 [ms] (0.1 step)
Delay time of DELAY 1 or 2.
Tempo value used to calculate DLY TIME1, DLY
30–250 [bps] (1 step)
2
TIME2, NOTE1, and NOTE2.
3
DLY1/2NOTE
Note value used to calculate DLY TIME1 or 2.
DLY FB1/2
DLY1/2HI-R.
DLY1/2PAN
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Amount of DELAY1 or 2 feedback.
High frequency amount of the DELAY 1 or 2 feed-
back.
L10.0–0.0–R10.0 (0.5 step) Pan position of the DELAY 1 or 2.
1. If you change DELAY TIME, NOTE will be automatically changed.
2. If you change TEMPO, DELAY TIME will be automatically changed. Two TEMPO
parameter rotary controls operate in sync.
3. If you change DELAY TIME or TEMPO, the closest note value will be selected.
3CH_DELAY (36)
Parameter
Value
0.1–1360.0 [ms] (0.1 step) Delay time. (0.1 step when ENTER is pressed.)
0–100 [%] (1 step) Delay 1/2/3 level.
Description
DLY TIME
1/2/3
DLY1/2/3
GAIN
DLY1/2/3
PAN
L10.0–0.0–R10.0 (0.5 step) Delay 1/2/3 pan position.
0.1–1360.0 [ms] (0.1 step) Delay time of feedback
FB DLY
TIME
DELAY FB
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Amount of delay feedback.
VM200 User’s Guide
141
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Parameter
HI RATIO
Value
Description
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
High frequency amount of the feedback.
CHORUS (37)
Parameter
Value
Description
Modulation depth
DEPTH
0–100 [%] (1 step)
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
1
PRESENCE
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
3D_CHORUS (38)
Parameter
Value
Description
DEPTH
0–100 [%] (1 step)
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
Modulation depth.
1
PRESENCE
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
FLANGE (39)
Parameter
Value
Description
RATE
0.01–2.00 [Hz] (0.01 step) Modulation speed.
DEPTH
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Modulation depth.
Delay time from the direct sound until the modu-
lated sound.
MOD DLY
0.0–30.0 [ms] (0.1 step)
FLANGE FB
FLA1/2GAIN
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Feedback amount.
Gain of FLANGE 1 or 2.
L10.00–0.0–R10.0 (0.5
step)
FLA1/2PAN
PRESENCE
Pan position of FLANGE 1 or 2.
1
Brightness in the high range of the reverberation.
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
142
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Parameters
Parameter
LPF
Value
Description
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
MONO_PITCH (40)
Parameter
Value
Description
Amount of pitch shift.
-24–0–+24 (1 step)
(+/-2 octave)
PITCH
-100–0–+100 (1 step)
(+/- semitone)
ADJUST
Fine adjustment to the pitch shift.
PITCH DLY
PITCH FB
0–340 [ms] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Delay time of the pitch shift.
Feedback amount.
L10.0–0.0–R10.0 (0.5
step)
PITCH PAN
Pan position of the pitch shift.
1
PITCH MODE
Selects the size of the buffer for pitch shift.
1, 2, 3, 4
1. Select “1” when response speed is priority. Select “2” for a typical setting. Select “3” or
“4” for more clarity.
DUAL_PITCH (41)
Parameter
Value
Description
-24–0–+24 (1 step)
(+/-2 octave)
PITCH1/2
Amount of pitch shift for PITCH SHIFT 1 or 2.
-100–0–+100 (1 step)
(+/- semitone)
Fine adjustment to the pitch shift for PITCH
SHIFT 1 or 2.
ADJUST1/2
Delay time of the pitch shift for PITCH SHIFT 1 or
2.
PIT1/2 DLY
PIT1/2 FB
PIT1/2 PAN
0–340 [ms] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Feedback amount for PITCH SHIFT 1 or 2.
L10.0–0.0–R10.0 (0.5
step)
Pan position of PITCH SHIFT 1 or 2.
Selects the size of the buffer for PITCH SHIFT 1
or 2.
1
PIT1/2 MODE
1, 2, 3, 4
1. Select “1” when response speed is priority. Select “2” for a typical setting. Select “3” or
“4” for more clarity.
VM200 User’s Guide
143
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
Delay->Reverb-type Effects (42–45)
Parameter
DELAY TIME
DELAY FB
DELAY BAL
REV TIME
Value
Description
1–500 [ms] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Delay time.
Amount of delay feedback.
Delay sound level.
Length of the reverberation.
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
PRE DLY
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
1
DENSITY
Density of the reverb.
0–10, AUTO
DIFFUSION
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Left/right spread of the reverb effects.
Length of the low frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to the REV.TIME.
LO RATIO
HI RATIO
0.1–2.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
2
PRESENCE
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
1. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
2. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
CHORUS-REVERB (46)
Parameter
Value
Description
CHO DEPTH
REV TIME
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Modulation depth.
Length of the reverberation.
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
PRE DLY
HI RATIO
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
1
PRESENCE
DENSITY
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Density of the reverb.
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
2
0–10, AUTO
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Level of reverb sound.
REV BAL
0–100 [%] (1 step)
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
2. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
144
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects Parameters
REVERB-CHORUS (47)
Parameter
Value
Description
Length of the reverberation.
REV TIME
PRE DLY
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
HI RATIO
1
PRESENCE
DENSITY
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Density of the reverb.
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
2
0–10, AUTO
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
CHO DEPTH
CHO BAL
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Modulation depth.
Level of chorus sound.
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
2. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
FLANGE-REVERB (48)
Parameter
Value
Description
Modulation speed. (0.01 step when ENTER is
pressed.)
FLA RATE
0.01–2.00 [Hz] (00.1 step)
DEPTH
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Modulation depth.
FLA FB
REV TIME
Feedback amount.
Length of the reverberation.
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
PRE DLY
HI RATIO
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
1
PRESENCE
DENSITY
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Density of the reverb.
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
2
0–10, AUTO
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Level of reverb sound.
REV BAL
0–100 [%] (1 step)
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
2. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
VM200 User’s Guide
145
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Effects
REVERB-FLANGE (49)
Parameter
Value
Description
Length of the reverberation.
REV TIME
PRE DLY
0.1–30.0 [s] (0.1 step)
Delay time from the early reflections until the
reverb.
0–160 [ms] (1 step)
0.1–1.0 (0.1 step)
Length of the high frequency reverberation,
expressed as a ratio relative to REV.TIME.
HI RATIO
1
PRESENCE
DENSITY
Brightness in the high range of the reverb.
Density of the reverb.
-10–0–+10 (1 step)
2
0–10, AUTO
1.00kHz–20.2kHz, THRU
(step: same as EQ)
LPF
Cut-off frequency of the low pass filter.
Modulation speed. (0.01 step when ENTER is
pressed.)
FLA RATE
0.01–2.00 [Hz] (0.01 step)
FLA FB
0–100 [%] (1 step)
0–100 [%] (1 step)
Feedback amount.
FLA BAL
Level of flange sound.
1. Brightness increases with a positive setting, and decreases with a negative setting.
2. With AUTO, the optimum value for the REV TIME setting will be used.
146
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 9
Scene Memory
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter describes Scen e Mem ory an d explain s h ow to store
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
an d recall scen es an d h ow to preven t specific param eters from
ON
AN
P
bein g u pdated by a scen e recalled from m em ory.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Chapter Contents
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
-60
0
AN
P
-
Preset Scen e Mem ory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
Rec
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
147
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
What is Scene Mem ory?
“Scen e Mem ory” refers to specific location s in th e flash m em ory of
th e VM200 in wh ich you can store m ix scen es. A m ix scen e is a
sn apsh ot of settin gs for virtu ally all VM200 param eters (i.e., EQ,
fader position s, effects, an d so on ) at a given poin t in tim e.
Say you h ave fin ally arrived at th e perfect m ix settin g for recordin g a
particu lar in stru m en talist in you r stu dio. It sou n ds great, bu t n ext
week you wan t to be able to recall th e sam e settin gs. Sim ply store th e
scen e in to th e Scen e Mem ory, an d recall it n ext week. Th is is on e of
th e prin ciple advan tages of a digital recordin g m ixer.
Th e VM200 featu res 100 (0–99) scen e m em ories. You can assign a
n am e to each on e.
Th e VM200 also featu res th ree preset scen es: P0 [In it Mix], P1
[Recordin g], an d P2 [Mix Down ]. Th ese are u sefu l for com m on m ixin g
situ ation s.
You can set in dividu al ch an n els or param eters as “recall safe.” Th is
m ean s th at wh en you recall a n ew scen e from m em ory, th e settin gs
for th e specified ch an n els or param eters rem ain u n ch an ged.
You can store an d recall scen e m em ories in th ree ways:
❑ By pressin g th e [RECALL] key in th e Scen e Mem ory section an d
selectin g a scen e;
❑ By program m in g th e VM200 to au tom atically recall a scen e wh en
th e VM200 is powered on ;
❑ By sen din g rem ote MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages from a com -
pu ter or MIDI sequ en cer (see “Program Ch an ge To Scen e Mem ory
Assign m en t Tables” on page 210).
You can also back u p scen e m em ory data to an extern al MIDI device
u sin g MIDI Bu lk Du m p m essages. See “Bu lk Du m p” on page 189 for
m ore in form ation .
You store scen es u sin g th e SCENE MEMORY STORE fu n ction page, an d
recall th em u sin g th e SCENE MEMORY RECALL fu n ction page. On both
pages, you will u tilize th e Scen e Mem ory [STORE] an d [RECALL] keys.
scene number
scrollable list of scene names and numbers
scene name
EQ Enable indicator
Th e SCENE MEMORY STORE fu n ction page in clu des th e followin g in form a-
tion :
❑ cu rren t scen e n am e an d n u m ber (in th e above exam ple, “P0”
m ean s “Preset 0”)
❑ EQ-en abled ch an n el layers in th e cu rren t scen e
❑ a scrollable list of scen e n am es an d n u m bers
148
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Edit Indicator
The bottom half of the function page is identical to the CHANNEL EDIT fu nc-
tion page, displaying PAN controls for each channel in the current layer.
scene number
scrollable list of scene names and numbers
scene name
EQ Enable indicator
EQ Enabled channel layer in selected scene
Th e SCENE MEMORY RECALL fu n ction page in clu des th e followin g in form a-
tion :
❑ cu rren t scen e n am e an d n u m ber (in th e above exam ple “P0” m ean s
“Preset 0”)
❑ EQ-en abled ch an n el layers in th e cu rren t scen e (left side of page)
❑ a scrollable list of scen e m em ory location n am es an d n u m bers
❑ EQ-en abled ch an n el layers in th e scen e selected in th e list (righ t
side of page)
❑ th e bottom h alf of th e fu n ction page is iden tical to th e Ch an n el Edit
fu n ction page. It displays PAN con trols for each ch an n el in th e cu r -
ren t layer. Adju stm en ts you m ake to th e PAN con trols will be saved
with th e scen e.
Scene Edit Indicator
Th e VM200 featu res an EDIT in dicator th at ligh ts u p wh en you
adju st an y param eter in th e scen e, in dicatin g th at th e cu rren t scen e
n o lon ger exactly m atch es th e param eters of th e scen e you recalled.
Init Mix
Init Mix
EDIT indicator
PO
PO
EDIT
What Can You Store in a Scene?
You can store th e followin g VM200 m ix settin gs in a scen e:
Section
Items
Ch fader, Ch on, Ch pan, AUX1–4 sends, Eff1/2 sends, AUX1&2 pan,
AUX 3&4 pan, EQ/LO Gain/Freq/Q, EQ/LO-MID Gain/Freq/Q,
EQ/HI-MID Gain/Freq/Q, EQ/LO Gain/Freq/Q, EQ on, Routing, Phase,
Ch pair, Mute/Fader group, S/P DIF IN
Channel
(ch1–ch20)
Master
ST Buss master/on, AUX1–4 master/on, Eff1/2 master/on
EQ Enable, ADD AUX, AUX1–4 post/pre, Eff1/2 post/pre, AUX1&2 pair,
AUX3&4 pair
Scene Status
Others
Scene name, Effects 1/2 selection
VM200 User’s Guide
149
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
Preset Scene Mem ory
Th e VM200 in clu des th ree preset scen es: P0, P1, an d P2.
Th ese presets were design ed as scen es you can qu ickly recall for
th ree com m on pu rposes:
❑ In it Mix: For in itial m ixin g
❑ Recordin g: For a typical recordin g situ ation
❑ Mix Down : For m ixin g down
You can recall a preset scen e, edit its param eters, an d store it again
u n der a n ew n am e. However, you can n ot overwrite th e pre-pro-
gram m ed settin gs of a preset scen e.
Th ese preset program s are all qu ite sim ilar; th ey differ on ly in th e fol-
lowin g settin gs an d u sage:
EQ
ADD.
#
Name
Routing
Usage
Enable AUX
Normal mixing application, such as
PA, live, etc.
P0
Init_Mix
1–8
ON
1–20:ST Buss
1–8:Rec Buss Overdubbing or bounce recording via
9–20:ST Buss Rec Buss.
P1
P2
Recording 1–8
Mix_Down 9–16
OFF
ON
1–20:ST Buss ADAT mixdown
150
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Recalling Mix Scenes
Recalling Mix Scenes
You can recall scen es from Scen e Mem ory in th ree ways:
❑ m an u ally
❑ au tom atically, wh en th e power is tu rn ed on to th e VM200
❑ rem otely u sin g MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages.
You can recall preset scen es P0, P1, or P2, or an y scen e th at h as been
saved to Scen e Mem ory location 00 to 99.
Recalling a Scene Manually
1. Press t h e Scen e Mem ory [RECALL] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e SCENE MEMORY RECALL fu n ction page.
2. Use t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o select a
scen e.
Th e “EQ En abled” readou t on th e righ t side of th e display in di-
cates th e ch an n el layers for wh ich EQ is en abled. Th e readou t
ch an ges to reflect th e statu s of th e scen e h igh ligh ted by th e cu rsor
in th e scrollin g list. Also, if th e ADD.AUX param eter is tu rn ed on
for th e selected scen e program , “ADD.AUX” appears in th is area of
th e display. See “En ablin g AUX Sen ds 3 & 4 (ADD. AUX Param e-
ter)” on page 115 for m ore in form ation .
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e select ion .
Th e VM200 loads th e scen e an d retu rn s to th e previou s m ode.
Not e: You can n ot recall scen es titled “NO_DATA, becau se th ere is n o
data in th e scen e.
Not e: You can press th e [EXIT] key to retu rn to Ch an n el Edit m ode at
an y tim e, can cellin g th e scen e m em ory recall process.
Cau t ion : Wh en you recall a scen e, volu m e levels m ay su dden ly ch an ge
becau se of ch an ges in param eter valu es an d fader settin gs. Before you
recall th e scen e, lower th e Master Fader or tu rn down th e Mon itor an d
Ph on es Gain con trols as n ecessary to protect you r ears an d speakers.
Also, if th e Motor param eter is tu rn ed on , th e faders m ay su dden ly m ove
au tom atically. Watch you r fin gers!
Recalling a Scene Autom atically at Start-up
You can specify a scen e to be recalled au tom atically wh en you power
on th e VM200. Th is is u sefu l if you wish to start all session s with a
particu lar scen e, or if you wish to con tin u e workin g with th e cu rren t
scen e in you r n ext session .
VM200 User’s Guide
151
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
You can select on e of th e followin g option s: LAST-STORED, P0, P1,
P2, 0–99. Th e defau lt settin g is “LAST-STORED,” wh ich cau ses th e
m ost-recen tly stored scen e to be recalled.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey fi ve t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 5:PWR ON RCL fu n ction page.
2. Use t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o select a
scen e.
You can select on e of th e followin g:
❑ an y Preset scen e (P0, P1, P2)
❑ an y User scen e (0-99)
❑ LAST-STORED (th e last scen e you stored)
Th e selected item flash es in th e Scen e Nu m ber field in th e lower
left corn er.
Not e: Press th e [EXIT] key at an y tim e to can cel th is process.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm t h e select ion .
Th e n ext tim e you power on th e VM200, th e selected scen e will be
au tom atically recalled.
Recalling Mix Scenes Using MIDI Program Change Messages
You can u se MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages to recall scen es for
sn apsh ot-style m ix au tom ation .
You can tran sm it Program Ch an ge m essages from a com pu ter, MIDI
sequ en cer, or MIDI keyboard. Most MIDI keyboards tran sm it a Pro-
gram Ch an ge m essage wh en a voice is selected. You can u se th is
m essage to recall a scen e on th e VM200. Usin g th is tech n iqu e, th e
syn th esizer an d VM200 can be recon figu red in stan tan eou sly.
To recall scen e m em ories u sin g MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages, do
th e followin g:
1. Con n ect t h e VM2 0 0 t o MIDI equ ipm en t capable of t ran sm it -
t in g Program Ch an ge m essages.
See “Con n ectin g MIDI devices” on page 175 for m ore in form ation .
2. Con fi gu re t h e VM2 0 0 t o receive MIDI Program Ch an ge m es-
sages.
See “Program Ch an ge Messages” on page 177 for m ore in form a-
tion .
3. Assign Program Ch an ge m essages t o scen e m em ories.
See “Program Ch an ge To Scen e Mem ory Assign m en t Tables” on
page 210 for m ore in form ation .
152
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Motorized Faders
If you h ave set th e Program Ch an ge/ Tx param eter to On , th e VM200
tran sm its a Program Ch an ge m essage each tim e you recall a scen e.
(Th e Program Ch an ge/ Tx param eter appears on th e Setu p: MIDI
1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction page. See “Program Ch an ge Messages” on
page 177 for m ore in form ation .) Usin g th is capability, you can recall
program s on oth er MIDI equ ipm en t, su ch as a ton e program on a syn -
th esizer. You can record tran sm ission of Program Ch an ge m essages
from th e VM200 to a MIDI sequ en cer to later au tom ate m ix scen e
ch an ges. Refer to th e “Usin g Program Ch an ge Messages to Recall
Scen es” on page 180 for m ore in form ation .
Motorized Faders
In order for th e faders to m ove to th eir n ew position s au tom atically
wh en you ch an ge scen es, th e Motor param eter m u st be tu rn ed on .
Th e Motor param eter appears on th e SETUP: SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n c-
tion page.
Follow th e steps below to tu rn th e m otorized faders on or off.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey on ce t o display t h e 1: CLOCK/ MON fu n c-
t ion page.
turning motorized faders on and off
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO Q rot ary con t rol t o t u rn t h e Mot or param e-
t er on or off.
Th e defau lt settin g is “OFF.”
Warn in g: Do n ot force th e au tom ated faders or you m ay dam age th e
VM200.
Not e: If th e Motor param eter is tu rn ed on , th e fader will m ove su dden ly
an d au tom atically wh en a n ew scen e is recalled or th e Fader Mode is
ch an ged.
VM200 User’s Guide
153
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
Storing Mix Scenes
You can store m ix scen es in Scen e m em ory location s 0–99.
1. Press t h e Scen e Mem ory [STORE] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e SCENE MEMORY STORE fu n ction page.
2. Use t h e Dat a Wh eel or t h e [</ -1 ] an d [+1 / >] k eys t o select a
scen e m em ory locat ion t o wh ich you wish t o st ore t h e cu r-
ren t scen e.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e SCENE MEMORY NAME EDIT fu n ction page.
character-selector
cursor
title box
character set box
Th e SCENE MEMORY NAME EDIT fu n ction page in clu des a ch aracter set
box th at displays all th e letters of th e alph abet, as well as n u m er -
als an d pu n ctu ation sym bols. You can u se th ese ch aracters to
n am e or title th e scen e m em ory.
You can u se an y Gain , Freq, an d Q rotary con trols to select th e
ch aracters for th e title.
Th e Gain rotary con trol m oves th e cu rsor position left an d righ t in
th e title box. Th e Freq rotary con trol m oves th e ch aracter -selector
u p an d down th e m atrix; th e Q rotary con trol m oves th e ch arac-
ter -selector left an d righ t.
You can also press th e [</ -1] an d [+1/ >] keys to m ove th e cu rsor
an d rotate th e Data Wh eel to select ch aracters or n u m bers.
4. Use t h e Freq an d Q rot ary con t rols t o select a ch aract er, t h en
t u rn t h e Gain con t rol on e n ot ch righ t t o m ove t h e cu rsor t o
t h e n ext space in t h e n am e, an d repeat t h e process.
Th e “Space to En d” option will com plete you r title with blan k
spaces.
Not e: Press th e [EXIT] key at an y tim e to can cel th is process an d retu rn
to Ch an n el Edit m ode.
154
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing Mix Scenes
5. Wh en you ’ve fi n ish ed n am in g t h e scen e, press t h e [ENTER]
k ey.
Th e followin g warn in g m essage appears on th e display.
Th e VM200 stores th e scen e in to th e selected Scen e Mem ory loca-
tion an d retu rn s to th e previou s m ode.
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to th e flash
m em ory or you m ay dam age th e system .
VM200 User’s Guide
155
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
Editing Scene Mem ory Titles
You can edit scen e n am es by recallin g a scen e an d re-n am in g it.
Recall Safe Function
Wh en you recall a scen e, all param eters are u pdated with settin gs
from th e n ew scen e. However, in som e cases you m ay wish to retain
th e settin gs for specific ch an n els or param eters.
Th e VM200 featu res a Recall Safe fu n ction th at en ables you to desig-
n ate ch an n els an d certain param eters as “recall safe.” Wh en a n ew
scen e is recalled, “safe” ch an n els an d param eters are n ot u pdated.
Recall Safe settin gs are available for each in pu t ch an n el 1-20 an d for
th e followin g param eters:
❑ Ch an n el Fader
❑ Ch an n el Pan
❑ Ch an n el On
❑ Rou tin g
❑ AUX1, AUX2, AUX3, AUX4
❑ EFF1, EFF2
❑ EQ
❑ EQ On
You can specify safe ch an n els u sin g th e CH RCL SAFE fu n ction page. You
can specify safe param eters on th e RCL SAFE fu n ction page.
Specifying Recall Safe Channels
Th e VM200 featu res a Recall Safe fu n ction th at en ables you to desig-
n ate in pu t ch an n els 1-20 as “recall safe.” Wh en a n ew scen e is
recalled, “safe” ch an n els are n ot u pdated.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey t h ree t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 3:CH RCL SAFE fu n ction page. All selectable
[EQ EDIT] keys flash .
2. Select a ch an n el layer by pressin g Page Select k ey [1 –8 ANA-
LOG IN], [9 –1 6 ADAT IN], or [1 7 –2 0 EFF RTN].
156
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Specifying Recall Safe Parameters
3. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k eys of t arget ch an n els t o design at e t h em
“safe” from bein g overwrit t en by recalled param et ers.
Th e [EQ EDIT] in dicators of th e recall safe ch an n els ligh t u p, an d
th e [EQ EDIT] in dicators of th e n on -safe ch an n els con tin u e to
flash .
Th e box in dicators of th e recall safe ch an n els are h igh ligh ted.
4. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o Ch an n el Edit
m ode.
Specifying Recall Safe Param eters
Th e VM200 featu res a Recall Safe fu n ction th at en ables you to desig-
n ate specific param eters as “recall safe.” Wh en a n ew scen e is
recalled, “safe” param eters are n ot u pdated.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey t h ree t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:CH RCL SAFE fu n ction page.
2. Use t h e EQ Gain , Freq, an d Q rot ary con t rols for each param e-
t er t o t u rn Recall Safe on or off.
Th e defau lt settin g is all Off.
3. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey t o ret u rn t o Ch an n el Edit
m ode.
VM200 User’s Guide
157
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Scene Memory
158
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 10
Digital Connections
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is ch apter describes th e VM200’s digital in pu ts an d ou tpu ts,
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
in clu din g th e ADAT an d S/ P DIF digital con n ectors, word clock
ON
AN
P
m asters an d slaves, an d h ow to cascade m u ltiple VM200s.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Chapter Contents
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
Word Clock Setu p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
WORD IN/ OUT Con n ectors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
-60
0
AN
P
-
Settin g th e Master Word Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
Q
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
0
AN
P
-
Digital I/ Os . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
Digital I/ Os . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
-20
FREQ
SOLO
+10
ADAT IN/ OUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
Usin g ADAT IN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
-30
-40
0
AN
P
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
159
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
Digital Connections, Word Clocks, and Sam ple Rates
Th e VM200 is equ ipped with two types of digital con n ectors: an
ADAT in terface an d S/ P DIF In an d Ou t con n ectors.
Th ese con n ectors en able you to in terface th e VM200 to oth er digital
com pon en ts in you r recordin g stu dio. You can u se th e ADAT in ter -
face to con n ect to an y ADAT-com patible recorder, su ch as th e FOS-
TEX VR800 or an Alesis ADAT. For m ore in form ation “ADAT IN/ OUT”
Th is section reviews som e basic issu es involved in setting u p a digital
recordin g environm ent. (If you ’ve worked with digital au dio equ ipm ent
before, you are probably already fam iliar with word clock syn chron i-
zation issu es and can skip this section .)
Th e followin g illu stration sh ows a typical waveform . Tech n ically, th is
graph represen ts force alon g th e vertical axis (i.e., th e force an au dio
speaker requ ires to m ove a certain am ou n t of air to create sou n d),
an d time alon g th e h orizon tal axis. Th e waveform is an an alogy for th e
sou n dwave position at specific poin ts in tim e.
(Mu sically, h owever, this waveform cou ld represen t you r next big hit :-)
force
time
A digital-to-an alog (D/ A) au dio con verter takes n u m erou s tin y sam -
ples of su ch a waveform each secon d, an d con verts th e sam ple data
to digital bin ary digital in form ation .
Th e n u m ber of sam ples taken each secon d is called th e “sam ple rate.”
Th e VM200, like m an y cu rren t digital devices, can sam ple at a rate of
44,100 tim es per secon d (44.1kHz) or 48,000 tim es per secon d
(48kHz).
Each tim e th e con verter sam ples th e waveform , it records waveform
data as a bin ary n u m ber in a form at called a “word.” A bit is a u n it of
data, a sin gle digit in a word, th e “on e-or -zero,” “on -or -off” fu n da-
m en tal en codin g of th e digital u n iverse. For in stan ce,
1011011110111001 is a 16-bit bin ary word. It con tain s 16 digits or
“bits” of data. If you are u sin g 16-bit words, you r system is said to
h ave a bit-rate of 16 bits. (Th is is also called th e “bit resolu tion .”)
A word clock is a clock sign al th at you can u se to syn ch ron ize all th e
devices in a digital au dio system . If th e VM200 is th e on ly digital
au dio com pon en t in you r stu dio, you don ’t n eed to worry abou t set-
tin g th e word clock. (Th e VM200 will syn ch ron ize to its own in tern al
word clock.)
However, if you u se a secon d digital device, su ch as a DAT or digital
m u ltitrack recorder, you m u st design ate on e device th e word clock
ma s ter an d th e rest s la ves . You m ay n eed to ch an ge word clock set-
tin gs on occasion , su ch as wh en you record from a DAT or CD player.
If th e word clocks are n ot correctly syn ch ron ized th rou gh ou t you r
160
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections, Word Clocks, and Sample Rates
system , n oise or glitch es m ay creep in to you r m ixes.
Each device in a digital system m ay u tilize a differen t word len gth ,
becau se m ost digital devices are capable of in terpretin g words an d
tru n catin g or protractin g th eir len gth .
However, it is im portan t th at every com pon en t in you r digital au dio
system do two th in gs:
❑ u tilize th e sam e sam ple rate (44.1 or 48kHz)
❑ syn ch ron ize with a design ated word clock m aster.
Not e: Word clocks differ from SMPTE or MIDI tim ecode, wh ich are u sed
to syn ch ron ize MIDI sequ en cers an d au dio recorders. Word clocks syn -
ch ron ize th e digital au dio processin g circu its in each digital au dio device.
Th e word clock sign al ru n s at th e sam e frequ en cy as th e sam plin g
rate. Th e VM200 gen erates its own word clock at 44.1 kHz (th e
in du stry-stan dard sam plin g rate for m u sic CDs) an d can be u sed as
th e word clock m aster. (In gen eral, if you r work is destin ed for CD, it
is probably best to u se th e 44.1 kHz sam pling rate.)
Altern atively, you can u se th e VM200 as a word clock slave syn ch ro-
n ized to an extern al word clock in th e ran ge of 44.1kHz to 48kHz,
+/ -6%.
Be aware of th e followin g word clock gu idelin es:
❑ You can distribu te word clock sign als via dedicated cables or derive
th em from stan dard digital au dio con n ection s.
❑ If all devices sh are a com m on word clock, leave all th e devices pow-
ered on , even if th ey’re n ot bein g u sed.
❑ First tu rn on th e word clock m aster, th en th e slaves.
❑ Wh en you sh u t down th e system , first tu rn off th e slaves, th en th e
m aster.
❑ Before a recordin g session , m ake su re th at all word clock slaves are
syn ch ron ized to th e m aster word clock.
For m ore in form ation , refer to th e docu m en tation for each device.
VM200 User’s Guide
161
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
Word Clock Setup
Th e VM200’s in tern al word clock gen erator su pports a sam plin g fre-
qu en cy of 44.1kHz, th e au dio stan dard for m u sic CDs.
You m ay also syn ch ron ize th e VM200 to an extern al word clock.
WORD IN/ OUT Connectors
Th ese BNC con n ectors receive/ tran sm it th e word clock. You can
con n ect a device th at h as a WORD IN/ OUT con n ector, su ch as th e
Fostex VR800 digital m u ltitrack recorder, to th ese con n ectors.
If th e VM200 is th e last device in th e word clock ch ain , set th e word
clock term in ation switch to ON.
WORD
75
WORD IN/OUT
ON OFF
IN
OUT
word clock termination switch
Setting the Master Word Clock
Follow th e steps below to set th e m aster word clock.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e SYSTEM fu n ction page.
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO Gain con t rol t o select a m ast er clock from
t h e followin g opt ion s:
Select this option to use the VM200 as the word clock
master.
INT44
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock from an ADAT-compatible machine
running at 44.1kHz.
ADAT44
ADAT48
S/PDIF44
S/PDIF48
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock from an ADAT-compatible pro audio
machine running at 48kHz.
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock from a CD player or S/PDIF-compati-
ble machine running at 44.1kHz.
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock from a connected CD player or
S/P DIF-compatible machine running at 48kHz.
162
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Setting the VM200 as Master or Slave
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock from a connected FOSTEX VR800
digital multitrack recorder, or a digital device equipped with
a WORD OUT connector, running at 44.1kHz.
WORD44
WORD48
Select this option to use the VM200 as a word clock slave,
syncing to the clock coming from a connected digital
device equipped with a WORD OUT connector that is run-
ning at 48kHz.
Cau t ion : Selectin g an in appropriate sam plin g frequ en cy will in terfere
with n orm al recordin g an d playback.
Not e: If th e VM200 is on ly th e digital device in you r system , u se th e
defau lt settin g of INT44.
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o con fi rm you r select ion .
Th e VM200 displays th e previou s fu n ction page.
4. If you select an y opt ion ot h er t h an “INT4 4 ” in st ep 2 , an d t h e
VM2 0 0 is t h e last device in t h e word clock ch ain , t u rn t h e
WORD IN Term in at ion ON/ OFF swit ch t o ON on t h e rear
pan el.
WORD
75
ON OFF
IN
OUT
WORD IN Termination ON/OFF switch
Setting the VM200 as Master or Slave
Th e followin g exam ples illu strate th e VM200 in variou s recordin g
con figu ration s, bein g u sed as both word clock m aster an d word clock
slave.
Recording to a Digital Multitrack Recorder or DAT
In th is exam ple, a stereo sign al is recorded to a DAT recorder. Th e
VM200 is th e word clock m aster; th e DAT recorder is th e word clock
slave. Set th e Master Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “INT44.”
Th e VM200 will gen erate th e word clock an d th e DAT recorder will
slave to it.
VM200 is the w ord clock MASTER
S/PDIF OUT
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
DIGITAL INPUT
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-20
-10
-20
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
VM200 User’s Guide
163
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
Mixing a CD Source and Recording to a Digital Multitrack Recorder
In th is exam ple, a sign al from a CD player is m ixed with a sign al from
an ADAT-com patible digital m u ltitrack recorder, su ch as th e Fostex
VR800, an d recorded to th e digital m u ltitrack recorder.
Th e CD player serves as th e word clock m aster, an d u ses a sam plin g
frequ en cy of 44.1kHz. Th e VM200 an d th e digital m u ltitrack recorder
are word clock slaves, both syn cin g to th e CD player word clock.
Set th e Master Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “SPDIF44.”
The VM200 is w ord clock SLAVE.
Word Clock Master
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
S/PDIF OUT
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
P
AD
P
AD
P
AD
PAD
CD player
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
S/PDIF IN
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
P
AGE SELECT
Digital in
1-8 ANALOG IN
9
-
1
6
A
D
A
T
I
N
17-20 EFF RTN
ADAT OUT
ADAT IN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
OPTICAL
ACCESS
OL
0
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
6
12
24
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
RECORD TRACK
CHANNEL/
METER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CH VIEW
Digital out
ON
ON
Digital MTR
AUTO RTN
CLIPBOARD
EXIT
EXECUTE
AUTO PUNCH
/
NO
/
YES
START
IN
OUT
END
IN
OUT
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
PREVIEW
EJECT
HOLD/
STORE
EDIT
UNDO
/
REDO
DISP SEL
SETUP
EXIT
DATA
PGM SEL
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
AUTO RTN
AUTO PLA
JOG
SHUTTLE
ADD.AUX
V
ARI PITCH
Y
LOCATE
TIME BASE SEL
SCRUB
0
-10
-20
0
-10
SHIFT
P.EDIT
LOC MEM
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
RECORD
STOP
PLAY
REW
F
FWD
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CLIPBOARD PLAY
LOCATE ABS
LOCATE REC END
AUTO
PUNCH
WORD OUT
0
WORD IN
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
Multitrack Recording and Mastering to a DAT
In th is exam ple, an au dio sign al is recorded to an ADAT-com patible
digital m u ltitrack recorder, su ch as th e Fostex VR800, wh ile also
bein g m ixed from th e digital m u ltitrack, an d sen t to a DAT m aster
recorder.
Th e digital m u ltitrack recorder is th e word clock m aster. Th e VM200
an d th e DAT m ach in e slave to it.
Set th e Master Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “ADAT44” or
“ADAT 48,” depen din g on th e sam plin g frequ en cy of th e digital m u l-
titrack recorder.
(If you are u sin g th e Fostex VR800 digital m u ltitrack recorder, set th is
param eter to “ADAT44.”)
The VM200 is w ord clock SLAVE.
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
S/PDIF OUT
B
B
B
B
P
AD
P
AD
P
AD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
DAT
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
S/PDIF IN
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
Digital in
ADAT OUT
ADAT IN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
OPTICAL
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
ACCESS
OL
0
PAN
P
AN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
6
12
24
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC
ROUTING/
PHASE
PAIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
RECORD TRACK
CHANNEL/
METER
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
CH VIEW
ON
ON
Digital out
AUTO RTN
CLIPBOARD
EXIT
EXECUTE
AUTO PUNCH
/
NO
/
YES
START
IN
OUT
END
IN
OUT
Digital MTR
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
PREVIEW
EJECT
HOLD/
STORE
EDIT
UNDO
/
REDO
DISP SEL
SETUP
EXIT
DA
T
A
PGM SEL
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
AUTO RTN
AUTO PLA
JOG
SHUTTLE
VARI PITCH
Y
LOCATE
TIME BASE SEL
SCRUB
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
SHIFT
P.EDIT
LOC MEM
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-10
ENTER
CHANNEL
RECORD
STOP
PLAY
REW
F
FWD
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
CLIPBOARD PLA
LOCATE ABS
LOCATE REC END
Y
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
AUTO
PUNCH
WORD OUT
WORD IN
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
Word Clock Master
164
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital I/Os
Digital I/ Os
Th e VM200 featu res two types of digital in s an d ou ts: ADAT IN/ OUT
an d S/ PDIF IN/ OUT.
ADAT IN/ OUT
ADAT
IN
OUT
ADAT is a digital au dio form at developed by th e Alesis Corporation
th at en ables eigh t ch an n els of digital au dio to flow th rou gh a sin gle
optical cable.
It in clu des eigh t digital in pu ts an d eigh t assign able digital ou tpu ts
an d can be directly con n ected to digital m u ltitrack recorders.
You can connect an y ADAT-com patible recorder to these con nectors,
inclu ding an Alesis ADAT, Alesis ADAT-XT, Fostex VR-800, and others.
Using ADAT IN
You can u se an optical cable to conn ect the ADAT IN connector on th e
VM200 to the ADAT Ou t connector on an Alesis ADAT or other
ADAT-com patible device, su ch as the Fostex VR800.
Th e sign al, wh ich carries eigh t-ch an n el data from th e ADAT IN con -
n ector, will be assign ed to in pu t ch an n els 9 th rou gh 16 on th e VM200.
.
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
ADAT IN
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
OPTICAL
ACCESS
OL
0
6
12
24
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC
DATA OUT
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
RECORD TRACK
EQ ON
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
AUTO RTN
CLIPBOARD
EXIT
EXECUTE
AUTO PUNCH
START
IN
OUT
END
IN
OUT
/
NO
/
YES
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
VR800
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
PREVIEW
EJECT
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
WORD IN
HOLD/
STORE
EDIT
UNDO
/
REDO
DISP SEL
SETUP
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
PGM SEL
CHANNEL/
METER
AUTO RTN
AUTO PLA
JOG
SHUTTLE
CH VIEW
VARI PITCH
Y
LOCATE
TIME BASE SEL
SCRUB
ON
ON
SHIFT
P.EDIT
LOC MEM
RECORD
STOP
PLAY
REW
F
FWD
FADER MODE
WORD OUT
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
CLIPBOARD PLA
LOCATE ABS
LOCATE REC END
Y
0
AUTO
PUNCH
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
In th is exam ple, a Fostex VR800 is con n ected to th e ADAT IN con -
n ector on th e VM200 to m ix from a digital sou rce.
Th e VR800 serves as th e word clock m aster; th e VM200 is th e word
clock slave. Th e VR800 WORD OUT con n ector tran sm its th e word
clock to th e WORD IN con n ector on th e VM200.
Set th e Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “WORD44,” an d m ake
su re th at th e WORD IN switch on th e rear pan el is tu rn ed on .
If a con n ected ADAT-com patible device does n ot h ave a WORD OUT
con n ector, set th e Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “ADAT44”
or “ADAT48” depen din g on th e sam plin g frequ en cy of th e sou rce.
For m ore in form ation on th e m aster word clock setu p, refer to “Settin g
th e Master Word Clock” on page 162.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
165
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
Using ADAT OUT
You can u se an optical cable to con n ect th e ADAT OUT con n ector on
th e VM200 to an ADAT-com patible recorder, su ch as th e Fostex
VR800 digital m u ltitrack recorder.
Th e ADAT OUT con n ector ou tpu ts th e sam e in form ation as th e REC
BUSS, bu t in digital form . Th e left ch an n el of th e REC BUSS stereo
sign al is ou tpu t to tracks 1, 3, 5, an d 7, an d th e righ t ch an n el to
tracks 2, 4, 6, an d 8.
You can sen d ch an n el 1–8 sign als to ADAT DIRECT u sin g th e ROUTING
fu n ction page. Th e ch an n el 1 sign al is ou tpu t to ADAT track 1, th e
ch an n el 2 sign al is ou tpu t to ADAT track 2, etc.
.
optical cable
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
P
AD
P
AD
P
AD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
OPTICAL
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
ACCESS
VM200
OL
0
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
6
12
24
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC
DATA IN
RECORD TRACK
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
AGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9
-
1
6
A
D
A
T
I
N
17-20 EFF RTN
AUTO RTN
CLIPBOARD
EXIT
EXECUTE
AUTO PUNCH
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
/
NO
/
YES
START
IN
OUT
END
IN
OUT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
PREVIEW
EJECT
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
HOLD/
STORE
EDIT
UNDO
/
REDO
DISP SEL
SETUP
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
ADAT OUT
VR800
PGM SEL
P
AN
P
AN
P
AN
P
AN
P
AN
P
AN
P
AN
PAN
AUTO RTN
AUTO PLA
JOG
SHUTTLE
V
ARI PITCH
Y
LOCATE
TIME BASE SEL
SCRUB
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
GROUP
SHIFT
P.EDIT
LOC MEM
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
RECORD
STOP
PLAY
REW
F
FWD
CH VIEW
ON
ON
CLIPBOARD PLA
LOCATE ABS
LOCATE REC END
Y
0
AUTO
PUNCH
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
In th is con figu ration , th e VM200 is th e word clock m aster an d th e
m u ltitrack recorder or ADAT is th e slave.
Set th e Word Clock param eter on th e VM200 to “INT44.”
For m ore in form ation on th e m aster word clock setu p, refer to “Set-
tin g th e Master Word Clock” on page 162.
To rou te a digital sign al to ADAT OUT, follow th e steps below:
Assigning Channels to ADAT DIRECT SENDs
Not e: Th e VM200 is u n able to rou te sign als from ch an n els 9–16 (ADAT
IN) an d ch an n els 17–20 (EFF TN) to th e ADAT DIRECT SEND.
1. Press t h e Page Select [1 –8 ANALOG IN] k ey t o select t h e 1 –8
ch an n el layer.
Th e [1–8 ANALOG IN] key ligh ts u p.
2. Press t h e [ROUTING/ PHASE] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1: ROUTING fu n ction page. Th e [ROUT-
ING/ PHASE] key an d selectable [EQ EDIT] keys flash ; selected [EQ
EDIT] keys ligh t u p.
Th e ROUTING fu n ction page featu res a 3-by-20 m atrix. Th e top row
of th e m atrix, labelled “DIRECT,” in dicates wh ich ch an n els h ave
been sen t to th e ADAT OUT.
166
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Assigning Channels to ADAT DIRECT SENDs
3. Use t h e [EQ EDIT] k eys t o t u rn on t h e ch an n els you wish t o
sen d t o t h e ADAT OUT.
Selected [EQ EDIT] keys ligh t u p. On th e display, th e “DIRECT”
in dicators h igh ligh t (darken ).
In th e exam ple above, ch an n els 1–8 are sen t directly to th e corre-
spon din g ADAT ch an n els.
4. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
Not e: Th e Rec Bu ss also sen ds th e left sign al to ch an n els 1, 3, 5 an d
7, an d th e righ t sign al to ch an n els 2, 4, 6 an d 8 so th at you can rou te
th em to ADAT OUT 1–8 directly. Th is con figu ration en ables you to sen d
two m ixes to two differen t extern al recorders at th e sam e tim e.
VM200 User’s Guide
167
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
S/ P DIF IN/ OUT
S/P DIF
IN
OUT
Th e VM200 featu res S/ P DIF digital in an d ou t con n ectors on th e rear
pan el.
“S/ PDIF” is an abbreviation for th e Son y/ Ph ilips Digital In terFace, a
digital form at th at en ables two ch an n els of digital au dio to flow
th rou gh an RCA con n ector (coaxial) or an optical cable. Th e VM200
requ ires an optical S/ P DIF con n ection .
Using S/ P DIF OUT
Th e VM200 ou tpu ts th e ST BUSS sign al in digital S/ P DIF form at
from th e S/ P DIF Ou t optical con n ector on th e rear pan el.
You can con n ect th is ou tpu t to an y digital device th at featu res an
S/ P DIF Optical in pu t, su ch as a DAT recorder or Min iDisc recorder
to m ixdown in stereo.
You can also con n ect th e S/ P DIF ou t to th e S/ P DIF IN of an oth er
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
.
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
-3
-6
DIGITAL IN
S/P DIF OUT
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
P
AGE SELECT
DAT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9
-
1
6
A
D
A
T
I
N
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
-10
-20
ENTER
CHANNEL
-40
-60
optical cable
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
In th is exam ple, th e VM200 S/ P DIF ou tpu t is con n ected to th e digital
in pu t of a DAT recorder for digital m ixdown recordin g.
Th e VM200 serves as th e word clock m aster; th e DAT is a word clock
slave. Set th e “Master Word Clock” param eter on th e V200 to “INT44.”
Refer to “Settin g th e Master Word Clock” on page 162 for m ore in for -
m ation .
If you select th e digital in pu t on th e DAT recorder as th e recordin g
sou rce, th e DAT sh ou ld au tom atically syn ch ron ize to th e word clock
sign al from th e VM200. On som e DAT recorders, you m ay n eed to
specify th e word clock sou rce. Refer to th e in stru ction s su pplied with
you r DAT recorder.
Not e: If th e con n ected digital device h as on ly th e COAXIAL (RCA pin )
jack as a digital in pu t, u se a Fostex COP-1 (an optical-to-coaxial con -
verter).
168
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Using S/P DIF IN
Not e: Make su re th at sign als are rou ted to ST Bu ss so th at th ey are
also ou tpu t to th e S/ P DIF OUT. (See “Rou tin g In pu t Ch an n els” on
page 66 for m ore in form ation .)
Using S/ P DIF IN
You can con n ect th e S/ P DIF ou tpu t from a CD player, DAT, or Min i-
Disc player to th e S/ P DIF IN optical con n ector on th e rear pan el of
th e VM200.
You can also con n ect th e S/ P DIF ou tpu t from a s econd VM200 to th e
S/ P DIF IN optical con n ector in a cascade con figu ration . See “Cascad-
.
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
P
AD
P
AD
P
AD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
DIGITAL OUT
S/P DIF IN
-3
-6
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
DAT
P
AGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9
-
1
6
A
D
A
T
I
N
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
ON
ON
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
EXIT
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
optical cable
ENTER
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
In th is con n ection exam ple, a DAT m ach in e is con n ected to th e S/ P
DIF OUT con n ector on th e rear pan el of th e VM200 to en able m ixin g
from a digital sou rce.
Th e DAT m ach in e serves as word clock m aster, an d th e VM200 is
word clock slave. You n eed to set th e Master Word Clock settin g to
“S/ P DIF44” or “S/ P DIF48” depen din g on th e sam ple frequ en cy of th e
sou rce. For m ore in form ation on th e m aster word clock setu p, refer to
“Settin g th e Master Word Clock” on page 162.
Not e: If th e con n ected digital device h as on ly th e COAXIAL (RCA pin )
jack as a digital ou tpu t, u se a Fostex COP-1 optical-to-coaxial con verter.
Assigning S/ P DIF Signals to Channels
Follow th ese steps to assign a two-ch an n el digital stereo sign al (in pu t
via S/ P DIF IN) to specific ch an n els:
1. Press t h e [ROUTING/ PHASE] k ey t wice.
Th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key an d selectable [EQ EDIT] keys flash , an d
th e VM200 displays th e 2:S/ P DIF IN fu n ction page.
VM200 User’s Guide
169
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
2. Press t h e [EQ EDIT] k eys for ch an n els t o wh ich you wish t o
sen d t h e S/ P DIF sign al.
You can assign m u ltiple ch an n els.
Not e: Sin ce S/ P DIF carries a two-ch an n el sign al, you m u st always set
th e ch an n els in pairs. For exam ple, if you select ch an n el 1 to assign S/ P
DIF sign al, ch an n el 2 will be also selected an d paired. You do n ot n eed
to pair th e ch an n els u sin g th e Pairin g fu n ction in th is case.
On th e display, th e in dicators for th e assign ed ch an n el pairs
h igh ligh t (darken ), an d th eir [EQ EDIT] keys ligh t u p in paired u n i-
son .
In th e exam ple above, ch an n els 7–8 are assign ed to receive th e
S/ P DIF sign al.
3. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey or [EXIT] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n ction page.
170
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Cascading the VM200
Cascading the VM200
You can con n ect u p to th ree VM200s togeth er in a cascade con figu -
ration to en able 36-plu s ch an n els of digital m ixin g. A two-m ixer cas-
cade is illu strated below.
S/P DIF OUT
S/P DIF IN
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
INPUT
1
INPUT
2
INPUT
3
INPUT
4
INPUT
5
INPUT
6
INPUT
7
INPUT
8
MONITOR
PHONES
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
2TRK IN
2TRK IN
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
PAD
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
26dB
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
TRIM
GAIN
GAIN
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-16
-60
-34
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
-10
-50
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
+10
+10
+10
+10
+10
+10
+10
+10
METER
OL
METER
OL
-3
-6
-3
-6
-9
-9
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
-12
-18
-24
-36
-48
VM200
VM200
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
DIGITAL RECORDING MIXER
L
R
L
R
ST BUSS/SOLO
ST BUSS/SOLO
PAGE SELECT
PAGE SELECT
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
1-8 ANALOG IN
9-16 ADAT IN
17-20 EFF RTN
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SETUP
EQ/LO
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
GAIN
EQ/HI
GAIN
SELECTED EQ
EFF EDIT
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
SYSTEM
MIDI
EFF1
EFF2
EQ ON
EQ ON
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
EQ LIBRARY
EFF LIBRARY
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
FREQ
Q
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
CURRENT SCENE STATUS
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
RECALL
STORE
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
PAN
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
EQ EDIT
SOLO
ON
KEY MODE
KEY MODE
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
ROUTING/
PHASE
P
AIR/
GROUP
GROUP
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
REC BUSS
SOLO
SCENE MEMORY
RECALL STORE
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
SOLO
MMC SEND
MMC SEND
CHANNEL/
METER
CHANNEL/
METER
CH VIEW
CH VIEW
ON
ON
ON
ON
FADER MODE
FADER MODE
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
AUX1
AUX3
EFF1
AUX2
AUX4
EFF2
/-1
+1/
EXIT
EXIT
DA
T
A
DATA
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
+10
+10
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
+10
0
0
ADD.AUX
ADD.AUX
0
-10
-20
0
0
-10
-20
0
-10
-10
-20
-30
-20
-30
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-20
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
-10
ENTER
ENTER
CHANNEL
CHANNEL
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-20
-40
-60
-40
-60
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-30
-40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
ANALOG IN
ADA IN
EFF RTN
1
9
17
2
10
18
3
11
19
4
12
20
5
13
6
14
7
15
8
16
T
MASTER
T
MASTER
VM200-A
VM200-B
In th is figu re, th e stereo bu ss sign al flows from th e VM200-A S/ P DIF
OUT to th e VM200-B S/ P DIF IN. (S/ P DIF OUT ou tpu ts th e stereo
bu ss sign al in digital form .)
VM200-A serves as word clock m aster. Its Clock param eter is set to
INT44.
(You can access th e Clock param eter by pressin g th e [SYSTEM] key to
display th e 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page as sh own below.)
Th e oth er VM200 serves as word clock slave. Its Clock param eters is
set to SPDIF44. Refer to “Settin g th e Master Word Clock” on page 162
for m ore in form ation on word clock.
To con figu re m u ltiple VM200s in a cascade, follow th ese steps:
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e Setu p:System 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page.
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO Freq rot ary con t rol t o select on e of t h e fol-
lowin g opt ion s:
OFF
This is the default setting. The VM200s will not cascade.
The Cascade function is turned on. Channels 7 and 8 are
disabled.
ON-A
The Cascade function is turned on. Channels 15 and 16
are disabled.
ON-B
ON-C
The Cascade function is turned on. Channels 19 and 20
are disabled.
3. Press t h e [EXIT] k ey or [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey.
VM200 User’s Guide
171
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Digital Connections
Th e VM200 exits Setu p m ode an d displays th e CHANNEL EDIT fu n c-
tion page.
Not e: Wh en you attem pt to cascade m u ltiple VM200s, be certain n ot
to assign S/ P DIF IN to an y ch an n els, or th e cascade operation will fail.
(You can ch eck assign m en ts by pressin g th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key
twice to display th e S/ P DIF IN fu n ction page.) Refer to “Assign in g S/ P
172
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 11
VM200 & MIDI
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
MIDI is an acron ym for Mu sical In stru m en t Digital In terface, wh ich
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
is an in tern ation al tech n ology stan dard th at facilitates th e
ON
AN
P
exch an ge of m u sical data between digital devices.
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
Th is ch apter explain s th e MIDI-related capabilities of th e VM200,
FREQ
SOLO
in clu din g its MIDI ports an d param eters, as well as MIDI Mach in e
AN
P
ON
Con trol (MMC). Th is ch apter also featu res several illu stration s of
EQ EDIT
var
Q
iou s system con figu ration s in volvin g MIDI.
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
P
-10
ON
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
Chapter Contents
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
Bu lk Du m p . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
AN
P
-
ON
Fram e Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
173
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Using the VM200 w ith MIDI
Usin g MIDI with th e VM200 en ables you to take fu llest advan tage of
all th e VM200’s capabilities.
You can sen d MIDI Program Ch an ge m essages to recall scen es from
Scen e Mem ory, or sen d MIDI Con trol Ch an ge m essages to en able
real-tim e param eter con trol. Fostex System Exclu sive m essages sim -
ilarly en able addition al param eter con trol.
To backu p an d tran sfer data between two VM200s, you can u se Sys-
tem Exclu sive Bu lk Du m p com m an ds.
If a recorder is con n ected to th e VM200, you can con trol it rem otely
via MIDI Mach in e Con trol (MMC).
You can also cascade m u ltiple VM200s via MIDI con n ection s an d
rem otely operate th e VM200 via MIDI Local Con trol.
MIDI Ports
Th e VM200 h as stan dard MIDI IN, MIDI OUT, an d MIDI THRU ports
on th e rear pan el.
Th e MIDI IN port receives MIDI m essages.
Th e MIDI OUT port tran sm its MIDI m essages.
Th e MIDI THRU ports tran sm its th e exact sam e MIDI m essages
received at th e MIDI IN port.
In addition to variou s MIDI in stru m en ts an d devices, you can con n ect
a person al com pu ter to th e MIDI ports u sin g a MIDI in terface.
174
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Connecting MIDI devices
Connecting MIDI devices
The system illustrated below uses a standard MIDI interface to con-
nect the VM200, a MIDI keyboard, and a MIDI sampler to a com-
puter.
MIDI IN
serial port
MIDI sequencer
MIDI
interface
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
MIDI IN
MIDI keyboard
MIDI sampler
VM200
CascadingTwoVM200s
In the configuration illustrated below, two VM200s are cascaded
(linked) together via MIDI. This type of connection enables you, for
example, to perform the following functions on both machines while
operating only one:
• Recall, store, and change the name of scene memories
• Update the display
• Control Solo mode
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
Note: When you cascade two VM200s, be sure to set the ECHO param-
eter on 1: MIDI TX&RX page to “OFF” to avoid message loop.
VM200 User’s Guide
175
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
MIDITransm it and Receive Channels
Th is section explain s th e MIDI Tran sm it an d Receive Ch an n els.
Press th e [MIDI] key to display th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu nction page. Th is
page enables you to set the transm it (TX) an d Receive (RX) ch an n els
for th e VM200.
TX CH (Transm it Channel)
Th is param eter specifies th e MIDI Tran sm it Ch an n el. Th is is th e
ch an n el th e VM200 will u se to tran sm it MIDI m essages. Select a
ch an n el from 1 th rou gh 16.
Set th e device th at will receive MIDI m essages from th e VM200 to th e
sam e MIDI Ch an n el.
Wh en th e VM200 receives a requ est for MIDI data, it tran sm its a
respon se on th e sam e MIDI ch an n el th at received th e requ est.
Th e defau lt settin g is “1.”
RX CH (Receive Channel)
Th is param eter specifies th e MIDI Receive Ch an n el. Th is is th e ch an -
n el on wh ich th e VM200 will receive MIDI m essages. Select a ch an n el
from 1 th rou gh 16, or “Om n i.”
Set th e device th at will tran sm it MIDI m essages to th e VM200 to th e
sam e MIDI Ch an n el.
If you select OMNI for th e RX CH param eter, th e target m essages (Pro-
gram Ch an ge or Con trol Ch an ge) will be received on all ch an n els.
Th e defau lt settin g is “Om n i.”
ECHO
Th e ECHO param eter en ables you to “ech o” Program Ch an ge, Con trol
Ch an ge, or System Exclu sive m essages th at are received by th e
VM200 th rou gh to th e MIDI OUT port, regardless of th e MIDI Ch an -
n el settin gs. Th e defau lt settin g is “Off.”
176
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Program Change Messages
Program Change Messages
You can send a Program Ch ange m essage to th e VM200 to recall a
scene from th e VM200’s Scene Mem ory. (For m ore inform ation, see
Inversely, by recalling a scene on the VM200, you can tran sm it Pro-
gram Chan ge m essages to connected MIDI devices or instru m ents.
Program Change TX
Th e Program Ch an ge TX param eter determ in es wh eth er th e VM200
will tran sm it Program Ch an ge m essages wh en you recall a scen e from
Scen e Mem ory.
Tu rn th e Program Ch an ge TX param eter on if you wan t to ch an ge pro-
gram s on a con n ected syn th esizer wh en you ch an ge scen es on th e
VM200.
Th e defau lt settin g is “On .”
Program Change RX
Th e Program Ch an ge RX param eter determ in es wh eth er th e VM200
will recall a scen e from Scen e Mem ory wh en th e VM200 receives a
Program Ch an ge m essage.
Tu rn th e Program Ch an ge RX param eter on if you wan t to ch an ge
scen es on th e VM200 from a con n ected sequ en cer.
Th e defau lt settin g is “On .”
Program Change Table
Th e Program Ch an ge Table assign s program ch an ge n u m bers to
scen es in Scen e Mem ory.
Th ese assign m en ts en able you to sen d MIDI m essages from an exter -
n al MIDI device to recall scen es on th e VM200.
For exam ple, you cou ld assign Program Ch an ge Nu m ber 07 to Scen e
07. If you th en sen d Program Ch an ge Nu m ber 07 from a con n ected
sequ en cer to th e VM200, th e VM200 will recall Scen e 07.
Th e VM200 featu res two Program Ch an ge Tables (01 User Table, an d
02 Preset Table). You can u se th e Program Ch an ge Table param eter
to select Table 01 or 02.
Th e defau lt settin g is “01.”
For m ore in form ation , refer to th e “Program Ch an ge To Scen e Mem ory
Assign m en t Tables” on page 210.
VM200 User’s Guide
177
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Control Change Messages
You can sen d Con trol Ch an ge m essages to th e VM200 to con trol
VM200 param eters in real tim e. (For m ore in form ation , see “Usin g
In versely, wh en you adju st param eters on the VM200, the VM200 can
tran sm it Control Ch ange m essages to rem otely control the param e-
ters of con nected MIDI devices or instru m ents.
Control Change TX
Tu rn on th e Con trol Ch an ge TX param eter if you wan t th e VM200 to
tran sm it Con trol Ch an ge m essages wh en you adju st m ix param eters.
Th e defau lt settin g is “Off.”
Control Change RX
Tu rn on th e Con trol Ch an ge RX param eter if you wan t th e VM200 to
adju st m ix param eters wh en a Con trol Ch an ge m essage is received.
Th e defau lt settin g is “Off.”
Control Change Table
Th e Con trol Ch an ge Tables assign Con trol Ch an ge n u m bers to vari-
ou s con troller n u m bers.
Th ese assign m en ts en able you to sen d MIDI m essages from an exter -
n al MIDI device to con trol VM200 param eters in real tim e.
For exam ple, you cou ld assign Con trol Ch an ge n u m ber 5 to ch an n el
fader 5. If you th en sen d Con trol Ch an ge n u m ber 5 from a con n ected
device to th e VM200, th e VM200 will adju st fader 5.
Th e VM200 featu res two Con trol Ch an ge Tables (01 User Table, an d
02 Preset Table). You can u se th e Con trol Ch an ge Table param eter to
select Table 01 or 02.
Th e defau lt settin g is “01.”
For m ore in form ation , refer to th e “Con trol Ch an ge To Con trol
Param eters Assign m en t Tables” on page 211.
178
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
System Exclusive Messages (Fostex Exclusive)
System Exclusive Messages (Fostex Exclusive)
You can con trol VM200 param eters in real tim e u sin g System Exclu -
sive m essages. For m ore in form ation , see System Exclu sive Param e-
ter Con trol on page 188.
If you wan t th e VM200 to receive System Exclu sive m essages, tu rn on
th e “System Exclu sive TX & RX” param eter (described below).
Th e “DevID” (device ID) sh ou ld m atch th e n u m ber selected on th e
extern al MIDI device.
System Exclusive TX & RX
Th is param eter determ in es wh eth er or n ot th e VM200 adju sts m ix
param eters wh en System Exclu sive m essages are received, or
wh eth er th e VM200 tran sm its param eter settin gs in respon se to
Param eter Requ ests.
It also determ in es wh eth er th e VM200 tran sm its System Exclu sive
m essages on th e “DevID” ch an n el wh en m ix param eters are adju sted,
or wh eth er th e VM200 tran sm its Param eter Requ ests on th e “DevID”
ch an n el.
You can set th is param eter to “On ” or “Off.” Th e defau lt settin g is
“Off.”
System Exclusive DevID
Th is param eter determ in es th e ID n u m ber of th e device to an d from
wh ich th e VM200 tran sm its an d receives System Exclu sive m essages.
You can set th is param eter to 0 – 126. Th e defau lt settin g is “0.”
Bulk Dum p
You can u se th e System Exclu sive Bu lk Du m p to tran sfer VM200 data
(su ch as Scen e Mem ory, EQ Library, Effects Library, an d Setu p data)
to an oth er MIDI device.
Th is is u sefu l for backin g-u p VM200 data to a MIDI data filer or com -
pu ter, or for exch an gin g data between VM200s.
Not e: Fostex does n ot gu aran tee com patibility of MIDI Bu lk Du m p m es-
sages between two VM200s with differen t software version s.
Bulk RX
Th e Bu lk RX param eter determ in es wh eth er th e VM200 receives MIDI
Bu lk requ ests an d MIDI Bu lk Du m p m essages.
If you tu rn on th e Bu lk RX param eter, th e VM200 tran sm its Bu lk
Du m p m essages in respon se to Bu lk Du m p requ ests.
Bu lk Du m p m essages an d Bu lk Du m p requ ests are n ot ech oed.
You can tran sm it Bu lk Du m p m essages from th e VM200 regardless of
th is settin g.
See “Bu lk Du m p” on page 189 for m ore in form ation .
VM200 UserÕs Guide
179
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Using Program Change Messages to Recall Scenes
Wh en th e VM200 receives a MIDI Program Ch an ge, it can recall a
scen e from Scen e Mem ory. (Wh ich scen e it recalls is determ in ed by
th e Program Ch an ge Assign m en t Table. For m ore in form ation , see
page 210.)
Sim ilarly, wh en you recall a scen e on th e VM200, it can tran sm it a
Program Ch an ge m essage th at will recall a scen e on an oth er VM200.
Altern atively, th e Program Ch an ge m essage can be recorded to a
MIDI sequ en cer an d later u sed to recall a particu lar scen e au tom ati-
cally.
Scen e Mem ories 0 th rou gh 99 an d Preset Scen es P0, P1, an d P2 are
in itially assign ed to Program Ch an ges 1 th rou gh 128. However, you
can edit th ese assign m en ts u sin g th e 3:PGM. TABLE2 fu n ction page,
wh ich you can access by pressin g th e [MIDI] fu n ction key.
Th ese assign m en ts con trol both tran sm ission (TX) an d reception
(RX). For exam ple, wh en th e VM200 receives Program Ch an ge 07
from an extern al MIDI device, it will recall Scen e 07. In versely, wh en
Scen e 07 is recalled, th e VM200 will tran sm it Program Ch an ge 07.
Follow th ese steps to set u p th e VM200 to receive an d tran sm it MIDI
Program Ch an ge m essages:
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction page.
2. Set t h e VM2 0 0 an d t h e ext ern al MIDI device t o t h e sam e
MIDI ch an n el.
Th e external MIDI device that receives MIDI m essages from the
VM200 sh ou ld be set to th e MIDI Chan nel specified by the TX CH
param eter.
Th e RX CH param eter of the VM200 sh ou ld be set to the sam e
MIDI Ch an n el as the device transm itting MIDI m essages.
3. Set t h e TX CH an d/ or RX CH param et ers t o ON.
Use th e EQ/ LO an d EQ/ LO-MID Gain rotary con trols. Refer to
th e illu stration below.
Program Change TX and RX are “ON.”
180
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing the User Program Change Assign Table
Editing the User Program Change Assign Table
Th e VM200 featu res two Program Ch an ge Assign Tables.
Th e first is th e User Table, wh ich appears on th e 2:PGM TABLE1 fu n ction
page. You can edit th e assign m en ts in th is table.
Th e secon d table is th e Preset Table, wh ich appears on th e 3:PGM
TABLE2 fu n ction page. You can view th e assign m en ts in th e Preset
table, bu t n ot edit th em .
Follow th e steps below to assign a Scen e Mem ory to a Program
Ch an ge n u m ber.
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey t wice.
Th e VM200 displays th e 2:PGM TABLE1 fu n ction page.
2. Select a Program Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to select a n u m ber from 1
th rou gh 128.
As you tu rn th e con trol, th e PGM CHG No. param eter ch an ges an d
th e Assign Table reflects th e ch an ge.
3. Select a Scen e n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO-MID GAIN rotary con trol to select a scen e n u m -
ber from P0, P1, P2, or 00 th rou gh 99.
As you tu rn th e con trol, th e SCENE No. param eter ch an ges, an d
th e Assign Table scrolls to reflect th e ch an ge.
VM200 User’s Guide
181
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
View ing the Preset Program Change Assign Table
Th e Preset Program Ch an ge Assign Table appears on th e 3:PGM TABLE2
fu n ction page.
Follow th ese steps to view th e Preset assign m en ts:
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey t h ree t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 3:PGM TABLE2 fu n ction page.
2. Select a Program Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to select a n u m ber from
001 th rou gh 128.
As you tu rn th e con trol, th e PGM CHG No. param eter ch an ges,
an d th e Assign Table scrolls to reflect th e ch an ge.
Th e Scen e n u m ber assign ed to th e selected Program Ch an ge
n u m ber will appear n ext to it in th e Assign Table.
Program Change Assign Table Notes
Th e “Scen e Mem ory to Program Ch an ge Assign Table” appears on
page 210.
To reset th e assign m en ts to th eir in itial settin gs, press th e [SYSTEM]
key six tim es or u n til it displays th e 6:INITIALIZE fu n ction page. Tu rn
th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to set th e INIT ITEM param eter to
“PGM TBL,” an d press th e [ENTER] key. For m ore in form ation , see
“In itializin g th e VM200” on page 197.
You can store th e Program Ch an ge Assign Table to an extern al MIDI
device, su ch as a MIDI data filer, u sin g MIDI Bu lk Du m p. (See “Bu lk
Du m p” on page 179 for m ore in form ation .)
If a scen e is assign ed to two or m ore program ch an ges, th e lowest pro-
gram ch an ge is tran sm itted wh en th e scen e is recalled.
182
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Examples: Using Program Change Messages
Exam ples: Using Program Change Messages
Th e followin g figu res illu strate typical ways in wh ich to u tilize MIDI
Program Ch an ge m essages with th e VM200.
In th e followin g exam ple, if you are u sin g th e Preset Program Ch an ge
Table (wh ich appears on fu n ction page 3:PGM TABLE2), wh en you sen d
Program Ch an ge 10 from th e MIDI keyboard, th e VM200 will recall
Scen e 10, du e to preset assign m en t.
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI keyboard
In th e followin g exam ple, Program Ch an ge 33 h as been program m ed
in to a son g on th e MIDI sequ en cer an d will be tran sm itted to th e
VM200 at th e specified poin t wh en th e son g is played.
If you are u sin g th e Preset Program Ch an ge Table (2), th e VM200 will
recall Scen e 33, du e to preset assign m en t.
Sin ce th e VM200 ou tpu ts Program Ch an ge m essages wh en scen es are
recalled, you can record “scen e recalls” to th e MIDI sequ en cer in real
tim e.
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
sequencer
MIDI
You can also con n ect two VM200s via MIDI an d recall a scen e on th e
first VM200, so th at th e correspon din g Program Ch an ge m essage will
be tran sm itted to th e secon d VM200 recall th e assign ed scen e.
VM200 User’s Guide
183
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Using Control Change Messages
Wh en th e VM200 receives a MIDI Con trol Ch an ge m essage, it can
adju st a m ix param eter specified by th e Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table.
(For m ore in form ation , see page 211.)
Sim ilarly, wh en a m ix param eter is adju sted on th e VM200, th e
VM200 can tran sm it a Con trol Ch an ge m essage to con trol an oth er
VM200.
Altern atively, you can record Con trol Ch an ge m essages to a MIDI
sequ en cer an d u se th em later to au tom ate param eter con trol.
You can assign u p to 114 m ix param eters to Con trol Ch an ges 0
th rou gh 95 an d 102 th rou gh 119. (Du e to th e MIDI stan dard, Con trol
Ch an ges 96 th rou gh 101 are u n available.)
Th e VM200 “Con trol Ch an ge To Con trol Param eters Assign m en t
Tables” on page 211 lists in itial assign m en ts. You can edit th ese
assign m en ts u sin g th e 4:CTL TABLE1 fu n ction page.
Follow th ese steps to set u p th e VM200 to receive an d tran sm it MIDI
Con trol Ch an ge m essages:
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction page.
2. Set t h e VM2 0 0 an d t h e ext ern al MIDI device t o t h e sam e
MIDI ch an n el.
Th e external MIDI device that receives MIDI m essages from the
VM200 shou ld be set to th e MIDI Ch annel specified by the TX CH
param eter.
Th e RX CH param eter of th e VM200 sh ou ld be set to th e sam e
MIDI Ch an n el as th e device tran sm ittin g MIDI m essages.
3. Set t h e TX CH an d/ or RX CH param et ers t o ON.
Use th e EQ/ LO an d EQ/ LO-MID GAIN rotary con trols. Refer to
th e illu stration below.
184
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Editing the Control Change Assign Table
Editing the Control Change Assign Table
Th e VM200 featu res two Con trol Ch an ge Assign Tables.
Th e first is th e User Table, wh ich appears on th e 4:CTL TABLE1 fu n ction
page. You can edit th e assign m en ts in th is table.
Th e secon d table is th e Preset Table, wh ich appears on th e 5:CTL TABLE2
fu n ction page. You can view th e assign m en ts in th e Preset table, bu t
n ot edit th em .
Follow th e steps below to assign a con trol param eter to a Con trol
Ch an ge n u m ber.
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey fou r t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 4:CTL TABLE1 fu n ction page.
Th e followin g page appears on th e display.
2. Select a Con t rol Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to select a Con trol Ch an ge
n u m ber from 0 th rou gh 95 or 102 th rou gh 119. (Nu m bers 096
th rou gh 101 are u n available).
3. Select t h e sect ion of t h e VM2 0 0 you wish t o con t rol wit h t h e
Con t rol Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO-MID GAIN rotary con trol to select th e section
you wish to con trol with th e selected Con trol Ch an ge n u m ber.
Option s in clu de NON, CHANNEL, MASTER, EFFECT, an d SCENE
ST.
4. Select t h e su b-sect ion of t h e VM2 0 0 you wish t o con t rol.
Rotate th e EQ/ HI-MID GAIN rotary con trol to select a su b-section .
Option s in clu de CH1–20, ST BUSS, REC BUSS, AUX1–4, EFF1–2,
MODE, PST/ PRE, an d AUX PAIR. Th e available option s vary
depen din g on you r previou s selection s.
5. Select a param et er it em you wish t o con t rol wit h t h e select ed
Con t rol Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ HI [GAIN] rotary con trol to select a param eter item .
Th e available option s vary depen din g on you r previou s selection s.
For m ore in form ation , refer to th e “Con trol Ch an ge To Con trol
Param eters Assign m en t Tables” on page 211.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
185
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
View ing the Preset Control Change Assign Table
Th e Preset Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table appears on th e 5:CTL TABLE2
fu n ction page.
Follow th ese steps to view th e Preset assign m en ts:
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey fi ve t im es.
Th e VM200 displays th e 5:CTL TABLE2 fu n ction page.
2. Select a Con t rol Ch an ge n u m ber.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to select from 0 th rou gh 95
or 102–119.
As you tu rn th e con trol, th e CTL CHG No. param eter ch an ges,
an d th e Assign Table scrolls to reflect th e ch an ge.
Th e param eter item assign ed to th e selected Con trol Ch an ge
n u m ber will appear n ext to it in th e Assign Table.
Control Change Assign Table Notes
Th e“Con trol Ch an ge To Con trol Param eters Assign m en t Tables” on
page 211.
To reset th e assign m en ts to th eir in itial settin gs, press th e [SYSTEM]
key six tim es or u n til it displays th e 6:INITIALIZE fu n ction page. Tu rn
th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol to set th e INIT ITEM param eter to
“CTL TBL,” an d press th e [ENTER] key. For m ore in form ation , see “In i-
tializin g th e VM200” on page 197.
You can store th e Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table to an extern al MIDI
device, su ch as a MIDI data filer, u sin g MIDI Bu lk Du m p. (See “Bu lk
Du m p” on page 179 for m ore in form ation .)
If a param eter is assign ed to two or m ore con trol ch an ges, th e lowest
con trol ch an ge is tran sm itted wh en th e param eter is recalled.
186
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Examples: Using Control Change Messages
Exam ples: Using Control Change Messages
Th e followin g figu res illu strate typical ways in wh ich to u tilize MIDI
Con trol Ch an ge m essages with th e VM200.
Th e followin g exam ple assu m es you are u sin g th e Preset Con trol
Ch an ge Table (wh ich appears on fu n ction page 5:CTL TABLE2) an d th at
an assign able MIDI con troller on th e MIDI keyboard h as been
assign ed Con trol Ch an ge 83.
Wh en you adju st th e con troller, Con trol Ch an ge 83 will be tran sm it-
ted to th e VM200, wh ich will th en adju st th e effect sen d 2 level for
in pu t ch an n el 2.
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI keyboard
In th e followin g exam ple, in pu t ch an n el 5 fader m ovem en ts are
recorded in real tim e to a MIDI sequ en cer u sin g Con trol Ch an ge 5.
Du rin g playback, th e sequ en cer tran sm its Con trol Ch an ge 5 back to
th e VM200 an d fader 5 m oves accordin gly, du e to preset assign m en t.
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
MIDI sequencer
You can also con n ect two VM200s via MIDI to en able you to con trol
th e secon d VM200 from th e first. For exam ple, you cou ld m ove th e
Master Fader on th e first VM200, cau sin g th e secon d VM200 to oper -
ate its Master Fader as well.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
187
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Controlling Param eters Using Fostex Exclusive
Messages
You can also con trol VM200 param eters in real tim e u sin g MIDI Sys-
tem Exclu sive m essages.
Wh en you adju st a m ix param eter, th e VM200 tran sm its a System
Exclu sive Param eter Ch an ge m essage.
To tran sm it an d receive System Exclu sive m essages on th e VM200,
set th e SYSTEM EX. TX&RX param eter on th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction
page to “On ” an d set th e DevID (Device ID) param eter to m atch th e
device ID assign ed to th e extern al MIDI device.
Data form ats for Fostex Exclu sive m essages are provided in th e
Appen dix.
System Exclusive TX&RX
Device ID
188
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Bulk Dump
Bulk Dum p
Th e VM200 can tran sfer Setu p data, Scen e Mem ories, Effect an d EQ
Libraries, an d Program an d Con trol Ch an ge Assign Tables to an oth er
MIDI device u sin g th e System Exclu sive Bu lk Du m p fu n ction .
Th is fu n ction en ables you to back u p im portan t VM200 data to a MIDI
data filer or com pu ter, or to tran sfer data between m u ltiple VM200s.
Th e VM200 can also receive Bu lk Du m p requ ests from oth er MIDI
devices.
Transm itting MIDI Bulk Dum p Messages
Th e VM200 tran sm its Bu lk Du m p data on th e tran sm ission ch an n el
you specify u sin g th e TX CH param eter on th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction
page.
To execu te a Bu lk Du m p operation , you specify th e data you wish to
tran sfer u sin g th e param eters on th e 6:BULK DUMP fu n ction page, th en
press th e [ENTER] key. Th e VM200 can also tran sm it data au tom ati-
cally wh en it receives MIDI Bu lk Du m p Requ est.
Th e BLOCK param eter on th e 6:BULK DUMP fu n ction page en ables you
to specify th e block of data you wish to sen d.
Follow th ese steps to execu te a Bu lk Du m p.
Autom atic transm ission in response to Bulk Dum p Request
If you set th e BLK DMP REQ. param eter on th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction
page to RX ON, th e VM200 will be able to receive a MIDI Bu lk Du m p
requ est m essage from an extern al MIDI device.
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction page.
Bulk Dump Request RX parameter
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ HI GAIN rot ary con t rol t o set t h e BLK DMP
REQ param et er t o “RX ON.”
Th e defau lt settin g of th e Bu lk Du m p Requ est param eter is “RX
ON.”
Th e VM200 will tran sm it Bu lk Du m p data on th e specified MIDI
tran sm it ch an n el wh en it receives Bu lk Du m p Requ est from th e
con n ected MIDI device.
To specify wh ich data you wish to tran sm it, see “Specifyin g th e
data you wan t to tran sfer” on page 190.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
189
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
Manual transm ission of Bulk Dum p Messages
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey six t im es (from st art of cycle).
Th e VM200 displays th e 6:BULK DUMP fu n ction page.
2. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e VM200 starts tran sm ittin g Bu lk Du m p Data to th e con n ected
MIDI device an d displays th e followin g m essage:
“WARNING! Tran sm it Bu lk Du m p Data Now...”
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is tran sm ittin g data or
you m ay dam age th e system or th e con n ected MIDI device.
Specifying the data you w ant to transfer
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey six t im es (from st art of cycle).
Th e VM200 displays th e 6: BULK DUMP fu n ction page.
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO GAIN rot ary con t rol t o adju st t h e It em
param et er.
Th is param eter specifies th e data you wan t th e VM200 to tran s-
fer.
3. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO-MID GAIN rot ary con t rol t o adju st t h e
Block param et er.
Th is param eter specifies th e block of data you wan t th e VM200 to
tran sfer. Th e Block param eter is available on ly if you select
SETUP, SCENE, EFF LIB, or EQ LIB for th e Item param eter.
4. Rot at e t h e EQ/ HI-MID GAIN rot ary con t rol t o adju st t h e
In t erval param et er.
Th e In terval param eter specifies th e in terval between data blocks
du rin g Bu lk Du m p tran sm ission .
Item
ALL (default)
SETUP
Contents
Block
All items listed in this table
VM200 all current setup data
Scene memories
N/A
ALL, SYSTEM, MIDI, LOC MEM
ALL, CURRENT, 00–99
ALL, 50–99
SCENE
EFF LIB
Effect library user programs
190
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Receiving Bulk Dump Requests
Item
EQ LIB
Contents
Block
EQ library user programs
ALL, 50–99
Program Change Assign Table 1
(user-definable table)
PGM TBL1
CTL TBL1
N/A
N/A
Control Change Assign Table 1
(user-definable table)
If you sen d too m u ch data at on ce, you m ay overload MIDI devices
th at h ave sm all data bu ffers. Settin g a lon ger in terval will allow
slower devices to process received MIDI data.
You can u se an in terval settin g of 0 wh en you Bu lk Du m p between
m u ltiple VM200s.
You can set th e in terval from 0–500 in 10m s in crem en ts.
5. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o sen d t h e specifi ed Bu lk Du m p dat a
im m ediat ely, or press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o ret u rn t o t h e previou s
screen .
Receiving Bulk Dum p Requests
If th e receive ch an n el (RX CH param eter on th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction
page) an d th e DevID (device ID n u m ber) param eter on th e VM200
m atch th ose of th e sen din g device, th e sen din g device will tran sm it
th e specified Bu lk Du m p data to th e VM200.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
191
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
MMC (MIDI Machine Control) Send
MMC is an abbreviation for MIDI Mach in e Con trol. You can con trol
MMC-com patible recorders from th e VM200 by sen din g MIDI
Mach in e Con trol (MMC) com m an ds.
In MMC Sen d m ode, th e VM200’s [ON] keys 1 th rou gh 8 fu n ction as
th e tran sport keys, store, recall keys for locate m em ories.
You can u se th e [EQ EDIT] keys an d [SOLO] keys to locate sixteen
defin able locate poin ts (LOCATE 1–16).
Wh ile you h old down th e [ENTER] key, th e [SOLO] keys fu n ction as
th e record track select keys. MMC com m an ds are tran sm itted via
MIDI.
Th e followin g exam ple illu strates rem ote con trol of an MMC-com pat-
ible digital MTR (su ch as th e Fostex VR800) from th e VM200 u sin g
MMC com m an ds.
ADAT IN
ADAT OUT
ADAT IN
ADAT OUT
OPTICAL
ACCESS
OL
0
6
12
24
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
A
SYNC
RECORD TRACK
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MIDI Machine Control Data
AUTO RTN
CLIPBOARD
EXIT
EXECUTE
AUTO PUNCH
START
IN
OUT
END
IN
OUT
/
NO
/
YES
PREVIEW
EJECT
HOLD/
STORE
EDIT
UNDO
/
REDO
DISP SEL
SETUP
PGM SEL
AUTO RTN
AUTO PLA
JOG
SHUTTLE
VARI PITCH
Y
LOCATE
TIME BASE SEL
SCRUB
MIDI IN
SHIFT
P.EDIT
LOC MEM
RECORD
STOP
PLAY
REW
F
FWD
CLIPBOARD PLA
LOCATE ABS
LOCATE REC END
Y
0
AUTO
PUNCH
ADAT-compatible Digital multitrack recorder
Setting the Device ID Num ber
1. Press t h e [MIDI] k ey.
Th e VM200 displays th e 1:MIDI TX&RX fu n ction page.
2. Select an ID n u m ber for t h e DevID param et er.
Rotate th e EQ/ LO-MID Freq rotary con trol to specify th e device ID
n u m ber of th e con n ected digital MTR. Select a n u m ber from 000
to 126.
Entering MMC Send Mode
3. Press t h e [ROUTING/ PHASE] k ey an d t h e [PAIR/ GROUP] k ey
sim u lt an eou sly t o en t er MMC Sen d m ode.
192
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Entering MMC Send Mode
Th e two keys flash an d th e VM200 displays th e MMC SEND fu n ction
page.
Not e: Press th e [EXIT] key at an y tim e to can cel MMC Sen d m ode an d
retu rn to Ch an n el Edit m ode.
Refer to th e table below for an explan ation of th e fu n ction s an d
con trols on th e MMC SEND fu n ction page.
Key
Function
MMC Command Value
06
ON 1
ON 2
ON 3
ON 4
ON 5
ON 6
ON 7
ON 8
Record
Stop
01
02
05
04
Play
Rewind
Fast Forward
-----
Recalls a locate memory.
Stores a locate memory.
Locate points 1–8
EQ EDIT 1–8
SOLO 1–8
Locate points 9–16
ENTER + SOLO
1–8
Record track select 1–8
4. Press t h e [ON] k eys 1 –6 t o t ran sm it t h e t ran sport com m an ds
t o t h e MTR.
To start recordin g on th e MTR, press th e ch an n el 1 [ON] key an d
th e ch an n el 3 [ON] key sim u ltan eou sly.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
193
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
MMC Send and Tim ecode
Wh en sen din g Locate Tim e in MMC Sen d m ode, th e VM200 refers to
th e fram e rate set by th e Fram e Mode param eter fou n d on th e
SETUP:SYSTEM 1: CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page.
Before you can correctly set a locate tim e on th e VM200 to locate a
position on a con n ected extern al digital recorder via MMC Sen d com -
m an ds, you n eed to set th e correct fram e rate for th e tim ecode.
Th e VM200 su pports fou r fram e rates: 24, 25, 30D (drop-fram e), an d
30fps.
It is im portan t th at you set th e tim ecode fram e rate to m atch th e
m aterial recorded on th e digital recorder. Oth erwise, th e locate poin t
you set on th e VM200 will be ou t of syn c with th e recorded m aterial.
Fram e Mode
Follow th e steps below to set th e fram e rate for th e MIDI tim ecode.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey.
Th e system displays th e SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/ MON fu n ction page.
FRAME MODE
2. Specify a valu e for t h e Fram e Mode param et er by rot at in g t h e
EQ/ LO-MID Freq con t rol.
Th e Fram e Mode param eter specifies th e fram e rate. Select a
fram e rate appropriate for you r project.
Th e option s in clu de 24, 25, 30DF (drop-fram e), an d 30ND
(n on -drop fram e).
Th e defau lt settin g is 24.
3. Press t h e [CHANNEL/ METER] k ey or t h e [EXIT] k ey.
Th e VM200 retu rn s to th e previou s m ode.
Altern atively, press th e [ROUTING/ PHASE] key an d th e
[PAIR/ GROUP] key sim u ltan eou sly to select MMC Sen d m ode
im m ediately after you set th e Fram e Mode param eter.
194
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Storing Locate Points
Storing Locate Points
Follow th e steps below to store a locate poin t to th e desired Locate
key.
1. Wh ile t h e MMC SEND fu n ct ion page is displayed, rot at e t h e
[GAIN] rot ary con t rols t o set t h e locat e t im es in h ou rs, m in -
u t es, secon ds, an d fram es.
Th e EQ/ LO GAIN rotary con trol adju sts th e h ou rs (MTC-[h ]).
Th e EQ/ LO-MID GAIN rotary con trol adju sts th e m in u tes
(MTC-[m ]).
Th e EQ/ HI-MID GAIN rotary con trol adju sts th e secon ds (MTC-[s]).
Th e EQ/ HI GAIN rotary con trol th e fram es (MTC-[f]).
LOCATE TIME
LOCATE POINT
2. Press t h e ch an n el 8 [ON] k ey (fu n ct ion in g as t h e STORE k ey),
t h en press an [EQ EDIT] or [SOLO] k ey t o specify wh ere you
wish t o st ore t h e locat e poin t .
Th e VM200 displays th e locate poin t in th e u pper -left of th e dis-
play.
Checking the Locate Points
You can ch eck th e locate poin ts m em orized in to th e Locate keys as
follows:
3. Wh ile t h e MMC SEND fu n ct ion page is displayed, press t h e ch an -
n el 7 [ON] k ey (fu n ct ion in g as t h e RECALL k ey), t h en press t h e
Locat e k ey for t h e Locat e poin t you wish t o ch eck .
Th e VM200 displays th e locate poin t in th e u pper -left of th e dis-
play.
Transm itting the Locate Com m ands
4. Press t h e desired [EQ EDIT] or [SOLO] k eys 1 –1 6 (fu n ct ion in g as
Locat e k eys 1 –1 6 ) t o t ran sm it t h e locat e com m an ds t o t h e
recorder.
Note th at you can store Locate poin ts u sin g th e MIDI Bu lk Du m p
fu n ction . See “Bu lk Du m p” on page 189.
VM200 UserÕs Guide
195
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
VM200 & MIDI
196
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
CHAPTER 12
Initializing the VM200
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
About This Chapter
Th is brief ch apter describes h ow to re-in itialize th e VM200 to reset
SOLO
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
all param eters to th eir origin al defau lt valu es.
ON
AN
P
EQ EDIT
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
AN
P
Chapter Contents
ON
EQ EDIT
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
AN
-10
P
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
-30
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
197
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initializing the VM200
Initializing the VM200
You can in itialize th e VM200 to its factory defau lt settin gs by u sin g
th e In itialization fu n ction .
You can specify th e item s you wish to in itialize, ch oosin g from th e fol-
lowin g option s:
❑ ALL (all param eters)
❑ SCENE MEM. (Scen e Mem ory)
❑ EQ LIBRARY
❑ EFF LIBRARY
❑ PGM C. TABLE (Program Ch an ge Table)
❑ CTRL C. TABLE (Con trol Ch an ge Table)
❑ SETUP
Not e: If you wan t to reset on ly th e m ix settin gs an d retain oth er param -
eter settin gs, recall on e of th e preset scen e m em ories P0, P1, or P2
in stead. See th e ch apter en titled “Scen e Mem ory” on page 147 for m ore
in form ation .
Follow th e steps below to in itialize th e VM200.
1. Press t h e [SYSTEM] k ey repeat edly t o display t h e 6: INITIALIZE
fu n ct ion page.
2. Rot at e t h e EQ/ LO Gain con t rol t o select t h e desired it em .
Select from th e followin g option s:
• ALL (all param eters)
• SCENE MEM. (Scen e Mem ory)
• EQ LIBRARY
• EFF LIBRARY
• PGM C. TABLE (Program Ch an ge Table)
• CTRL C. TABLE (Con trol Ch an ge Table)
• SETUP
Th e selected item flash es.
198
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initializing the VM200
3. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey.
Th e selected item ligh ts u p con tin u ou sly, an d a “YES/ ENTER” dia-
log appears.
4. Press t h e [ENTER] k ey t o in it ialize t h e specifi ed set t in gs, or
press t h e [EXIT] k ey t o ret u rn t o t h e previou s screen .
If you press th e [ENTER] key, a warn in g m essage appears an d th e
VM200 starts in itializin g its settin gs.
Warn in g: Do n ot power off th e VM200 wh ile it is writin g to th e
flash m em ory or you m ay dam age th e VM200.
VM200 User’s Guide
199
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Initializing the VM200
Default Setup Param eters
System Parameters
Value
CLOCK SEL
MON SEL
INT44
ST-B
SOLO MODE
SOLO KEY
CASCADE
PFL
LATCH
OFF
MOTOR
ON
FRAME MODE
RECALL SAFE
24
CH. FADER
CH. PAN
CH. ON
ROUTING
AUX1–4
EFF1/2
EQ
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
OFF
EQ ON
Ch1–20
Ch1–20
LAST-STORED
OFF
ALL OFF
ALL OFF
SOLO SAFE
POWER ON RCL
MIDI Parameters
Value
Tx CH
1
Rx CH
OMNI
OFF
ON
ECHO
BULK Rx
PG Tx
ON
PG Rx
ON
PG Table
CC Tx
1 (User)
OFF
OFF
1 (User)
OFF
0
CC Rx
CC Table
SySEx Tx&Rx
SysEx DevID
PGM C. TABLE1
CTL C. TABLE1
ITEM
Same as PGM C. TABLE 2(preset)
Same as CTL C. TABLE2 (preset)
ALL
---
BLOCK
INTERVAL
0ms
200
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MAX
MIN
APPENDIX
Specifications and Data
EFF2
RECORDING MIXER
ORE
ST
AL
Y
VM200
EFF EDIT
DIGIT
EFF1
EFF LIBRAR
RECALL
RECALL
ORE
ST
Y
EQ ON
SELECTED EQ
EQ LIBRAR
12
-18
-24
R
REC BUSSSOLO
-36
-40
RECALL
L
ST BUSS/SOLO
Chapter Contents
EXIT
Q
EQ/HI
GAIN
AN
P
EQ EDIT
Tables & Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
17-20 EFF RTN
FREQ
SOLO
Ch an n el Fader Gain Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
AN
P
ON
EQ EDIT
Pan Gain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Q
0
SOLO
GAIN
EQ/HI-MID
Q . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
AN
-10
P
ON
EQ Frequ en cy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
T
IN
-20
EQ EDIT
ADA
AGE SELECT
P
9-16
-40
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-60
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
GAIN
EQ/LO-MID
0
AN
P
-
ON
Con trol Ch an ge Assign Table 2 (Preset). . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
-10
EQ EDIT
Preset Scen e Param eters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
-20
FREQ
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
EQ EDIT
Declaration of EC Directive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
-20
Q
SOLO
+10
-30
Fostex Distribu tors List In Eu rope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
6
-20
14
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
AN
P
-
ON
-10
EQ EDIT
5
-20
13
SOLO
+10
-30
-40
0
-
ON
-10
4
-20
12
20
+10
-30
-40
0
-
AIR/
P
-10
GROUP
3
1
1
-20
19
METER
+10
CHANNEL/
-30
-40
0
-
MMC SEND
0
VM200 User’s Guide
201
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Display Warning Messages
Warning Messages
Meaning
The EQ ENABLE setting of the channel you are operating is
not turned ON, thus the EQ is not available for that channel.
EQ 1–8 Invalid! (EQ Enable 9–16)
EQ 9–16 Invalid! (EQ Enable 1–8)
Channel Invalid!
The EQ ENABLE setting of the channel you are operating is
not turned ON, thus the EQ is not available for that channel.
You have tried to operate channels 21–24, which are not
available.
ADD AUX parameter is turned off, and AUX3/4 are not avail-
able.
AUX 3/4 Invalid! (ADD.AUX Off)
REC BUSS Invalid! (AD.AUX On)
ADD AUX parameter is turned on, and REC BUSS is not
available.
EFF 1/2 Invalid! (EQ Enable
1–16)
EQ is enabled for channels 1–16, and effects are not avail-
able.
The phantom power is turned on. (This appears when pow-
ering up the mixer.)
+48V SW On!
The byte count of the received Bulk Dump data is not cor-
rect.
Byte Count Error in BULK DATA!
Check Sum Error in BULK DATA!
The check sum of the received Bulk Dump data is not cor-
rect.
MIDI IN Buffer Full!
The VM200 has received too much MIDI data.
The VM200 has transmitted too much MIDI data.
MIDI OUT Buffer Full!
The word clock received from the connected device is not
correct and the VM200 cannot synchronize correctly.
Wrong WORD-IN CLK
Digital signals from the ADAT IN connector are not word
clock synchronized with the VM200, and noise may infiltrate
the audio data.
Wrong ADAT-IN CLK!
Digital signals from the S/P DIF-IN connector are not word
clock synchronized with the VM200, and noise may infiltrate
the audio data.
Wrong S/P DIF-IN CLK!
202
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Specifications
Specifications
Inputs
Connector
XLR3-31 (1: Ground, 2: Hot, 3: Cold), 1/4-inch phone jack
A/B switch
A: XLR3-31 (mics), B: 1/4-inch phone jack (lines)
3kΩ or higher (mics), 10kΩ or higher (lines)
26dB (+2dB, –1dB)
+48V (+1V, –2V)
ANALOG IN
(ch1-ch4)
Input impedance
PAD switch
PHANTOM switch
Connector
1/4-inch phone jack
10kΩ or higher
–10dBV
ANALOG IN
(ch5-ch8)
Input impedance
Nominal input level
Connector
1/4-inch phone jack
10kΩ or higher
–10dBV
INSERT IN
(ch1-ch4)
Input impedance
Nominal input level
Connector
Optical (Toslink)
ADAT IN
Format
Adat format
1
EFFECT RTN
(ch17–ch20)
Connector
none
Connector
Format
Optical (Toslink)
IEC60958 (S/P DIF)
RCA pin jack (x2)
10kΩ or higher
2
S/P DIF IN
Connector
Input impedance
Nominal input level
Connector
Level
2TRACK IN
WORD IN
–10dBV
BNC
TTL/75Ω (with Terminate ON/OFF switch)
1. Effect returns for the internal effects processor
2. Assignable to any consecutive odd/even channels
Outputs
Connector
1/4-inch phone jack (x2)
AUX OUT (1, 2) Applicable impedance 10kΩ or higher
Nominal output level
Connector
–10dBV
1/4-inch phone jack (x2)
10kΩ or higher
–10dBV
REC BUSS
Input impedance
Nominal input level
Connector
1
OUT (1,2)
1/4-inch phone jack (x2)
10kΩ or higher
–10dBV
STEREO OUT
(L, R)
Input impedance
Nominal input level
Connector
Optical (Toslink)
IEC60958 (S/P DIF)
Optical (Toslink)
Adat format
S/P DIF OUT
ADAT OUT
Format
Connector
Format
Connector
RCA pin jack (x2)
MON OUT (L, R) Applicable impedance 10kΩ or higher
Nominal output level
–10dBV
Connector
1/4-inch phone jack (x1)
8kΩ or higher
50mW or higher (at 32Ω)
BNC
PHONES
Input impedance
Max. output level
Connector
WORD OUT
Level
TTL/75Ω
VM200 User’s Guide
203
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI
Connector
Format
DIN 5-pin (x3)
MIDI standards
IN/OUT/THRU
1. The default setting is REC BUSS. However, with the ADD.AUX parameter turned on, AUX3/4
are available, and these connectors function as AUX OUT 3/4, providing four AUX SENDs.
General
Frequency response 20Hz–20kHz, +1dB/-3dB (phones: 50Hz–20kHz, +1dB/-3dB)
Dynamic range
90dB or higher (LINE IN CH IN –> ST OUT)
CH IN–>ST OUT: 0.08% or less (at 0dBV output)
LINE IN–>ST OUT: 0.008% or less (at 0dBV output)
LINE IN–>PHONES OUT: 0.05% or less (at 50mW/33)
AUX1-4, ST BUSS OUT: -90dB or less (master fader = min, all ch faders = min)
AUX1-4, ST OUT: -78dB or less (master fader = 0dB, all ch faders = 0dB)
MIC->INSERT: –71dBV or less (gain=max, pad=off, Rs=150)
MONITOR OUT (min): –100dBV or less
Total harmonic
distortion
Residual noise
PHONES (min): -98dBV or less
S/N
1–4CH CH IN (–4dB)–>AUX1-4, ST BUSS OUT: 92dB or higher (IHF-A)
CH IN (–48dB)–>AUX1-4, ST BUSS OUT: 76dB or higher (IHF-A)
5–8CH CH IN (–4dB)–>AUX1-4, ST BUSS OUT: 92dB or higher (IHF-A)
CH IN (–38dB)–>AUX1-4, ST BUSS OUT: 82dB or higher (IHF-A)
1–4CH: 50dB (+3dB -1dB)
Mic gain
5–8CH: 40dB (+3dB -1dB)
Crosstalk
70dB or higher (@ 1kHz), phone: 53dB or higher
PHONES max
output
50mW or higher, impedance 32Ω, 1kHz
A/D
20bit, 64-times oversampling ∆∑ modulation
20bit, 128-times oversampling ∆∑ modulation
Motor-driven, 128 steps/60mm
D/A
Fader
Internal: 44.1kHz fixed
External (S/PDIF, ADAT, WORD): 44.1kHz/48kHz+/–6%
Sampling frequency
Internal processing
Equalizer
32-bit
4-band parametric (LO, LO-MID, HI-MID, HI)
Type: Peaking (bell) or Lo shelving or High Pass Filter
f: 20.3Hz–4.00kHz (1/24 octave/step)
Gain: +/–18dB (0.5dB step)
EQ LO
Q: 0.1–20 (45 steps)
Type: Peaking (bell)
f: 20.3Hz–4.00kHz (1/24 octave steps)
Gain: +/–18dB (0.5dB step)
EQ LO-MID
EQ HI-MID
EQ HI
Q: 0.1–20 (45 steps)
Type: Peaking (bell)
f: 500Hz–20.2kHz (1/24 octave steps)
Gain: +/–18dB (0.5dB step)
Q: 0.1–20 (45 steps)
Type: Peaking (bell) or Lo shelving or High Pass Filter
f: 500Hz–20.2kHz (1/24 octave steps)
Gain: +/–18dB (0.5dB step)
Q: 0.1–20 (45 steps)
Scene memory: 3 (preset) + 100 (user)
Effect library: 50 (preset) + 50 (user)
EQ library: 50 (preset) + 50 (user)
STN graphic LCD (256 x 64 dots)
Memory
Display
204
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Maintenance
13
5
7
16
/
(W) X 4 / (H) X 17 / (D) inches
16
8
8
Dimensions
Weight
(428(W) X 118(H) X 454(D) mm)
Approx. 15.4 pounds (7kg)
90V–250V (50Hz/60Hz):
Power source
120VAC 60Hz(US, Canada), 230V– 50/60Hz(Europe)
100VAC 50/60Hz(JPN)
Power consumption
30W
❑ Specification s an d appearan ce are su bject to ch an ge with ou t n otice for
produ ct im provem en t.
❑ “Adat” an d th e
sym bol are tradem arks of Alesis Corporation .
OPTICAL
Maintenance
For n orm al clean in g, u se a soft dry cloth .
For stu bborn dirt, m oisten a cloth in dilu ted detergen t, wrin g it ou t
firm ly, an d wipe th e dirt off. Th en polish th e VM200 with a dry cloth .
Not e: Never u se solven ts su ch as alcoh ol, th in n er, or ben zen e, sin ce
th ese will dam age th e prin ting an d fin ish of th e exterior.
VM200 User’s Guide
205
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Tables & Data
Channel Fader Gain Table
Calculated Displayed
Calculated Displayed
Calculated Displayed
No.
No.
43
No.
86
Gain (dB)
Gain (dB)
Gain (dB)
-18.70
-18.30
-17.90
-17.50
-17.10
-16.75
-16.40
-16.05
-15.70
-15.35
-15.00
-14.70
-14.40
-14.10
-13.80
-13.50
-13.20
-12.90
-12.60
-12.30
-12.00
-11.75
-11.50
-11.25
-11.00
-10.75
-10.50
-10.25
-10.00
-9.75
Gain (dB)
-18.7
-18.3
-17.9
-17.5
-17.1
-16.8
-16.4
-16.1
-15.7
-15.4
-15.0
-14.7
-14.4
-14.1
-13.8
-13.5
-13.2
-12.9
-12.6
-12.3
-12.0
-11.8
-11.5
-11.3
-11.0
-10.8
-10.5
-10.3
-10.0
-9.8
Gain (dB)
-5.90
-5.60
-5.30
-5.00
-4.65
-4.30
-3.90
-3.50
-3.10
-2.70
-2.30
-1.90
-1.50
-1.10
-0.70
-0.35
0.00
Gain (dB)
0
-∞
-∞
-5.9
1
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
87
-72.30
-66.20
-60.20
-57.40
-55.30
-53.20
-51.00
-49.00
-46.90
-45.00
-43.30
-41.60
-40.00
-38.60
-37.30
-36.10
-35.00
-33.90
-32.80
-31.80
-30.90
-30.10
-29.40
-28.70
-28.00
-27.40
-26.80
-26.20
-25.60
-25.00
-24.50
-24.00
-23.50
-23.00
-22.50
-22.00
-21.50
-21.00
-20.50
-20.00
-19.55
-19.10
-72.0
-66.0
-60.0
-57.5
-55.0
-53.0
-51.0
-49.0
-47.0
-45.0
-43.5
-42.0
-40.0
-38.5
-37.0
-36.0
-35.0
-34.0
-33.0
-32.0
-31.0
-30.0
-29.0
-28.5
-28.0
-27.5
-27.0
-26.0
-25.5
-25.0
-24.5
-24.0
-23.5
-23.0
-22.5
-22.0
-21.5
-21.0
-20.5
-20.0
-19.5
-19.1
-5.6
2
88
-5.3
3
89
-5.0
4
90
-4.7
5
91
-4.3
6
92
-3.9
7
93
-3.5
8
94
-3.1
9
95
-2.7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
96
-2.3
97
-1.9
98
-1.5
99
-1.1
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
-0.7
-0.4
0.0
+0.35
+0.70
+1.05
+1.40
+1.80
+2.20
+2.60
+3.00
+3.40
+3.80
+4.20
+4.60
+5.00
+5.40
+5.80
+6.20
+6.60
+7.00
+7.40
+7.80
+8.20
+8.60
+9.00
+9.50
+10.00
+0.4
+0.7
+1.1
+1.4
+1.8
+2.2
+2.6
+3.0
+3.4
+3.8
+4.2
+4.6
+5.0
+5.4
+5.8
+6.2
+6.6
+7.0
+7.4
+7.8
+8.2
+8.6
+9.0
+9.5
+10.0
-9.50
-9.5
-9.25
-9.3
-9.00
-9.0
-8.75
-8.8
-8.50
-8.5
-8.25
-8.3
-8.00
-8.0
-7.60
-7.6
-7.40
-7.4
-7.10
-7.1
-6.80
-6.8
-6.50
-6.5
-6.20
-6.2
206
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Master Fader Gain
Master Fader Gain
Calculated Displayed
Calculated Displayed
Calculated Displayed
Gain (dB)
No.
No.
43
No.
86
Gain (dB)
Gain (dB)
Gain (dB)
-35.80
-35.10
-34.40
-33.70
-33.00
-32.40
-31.80
-31.20
-30.60
-30.00
-29.50
-29.00
-28.50
-28.00
-27.50
-27.00
-26.50
-26.00
-25.50
-25.00
-24.50
-24.00
-23.50
-23.05
-22.60
-22.15
-21.70
-21.25
-20.80
-20.40
-20.00
-19.62
-19.25
-18.88
-18.51
-18.14
-17.77
-17.40
-17.03
-16.66
-16.29
-15.92
-15.55
Gain (dB)
-35.8
-35.1
-34.4
-33.7
-33.0
-32.4
-31.8
-31.2
-30.6
-30.0
-29.5
-29.0
-28.5
-28.0
-27.5
-27.0
-26.5
-26.0
-25.5
-25.0
-24.5
-24.0
-23.5
-23.1
-22.6
-22.2
-21.7
-21.3
-20.8
-20.4
-20.0
-19.6
-19.3
-18.9
-18.5
-18.1
-17.8
-17.4
-17.0
-16.7
-16.3
-15.9
-15.6
Gain (dB)
-15.18
-14.81
-14.44
-14.07
-13.70
-13.33
-12.96
-12.59
-12.22
-11.85
-11.48
-11.11
-10.74
-10.37
-10.00
-9.62
-9.25
-8.88
-8.51
-8.14
-7.77
-7.40
-7.03
-3.66
-6.29
-5.92
-5.55
-5.18
-4.81
-4.44
-4.07
-3.70
-3.33
-2.96
-2.59
-2.22
-1.85
-1.48
-1.11
-0.74
-0.37
0.00
0
-∞
-∞
-15.2
-14.8
-14.4
-14.1
-13.7
-13.3
-13.0
-12.6
-12.2
-11.9
-11.5
-11.1
-10.7
-10.4
-10.0
-9.6
1
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
87
-90.00
-84.00
-80.00
-78.00
-76.00
-74.00
-72.00
-70.00
-68.70
-67.40
-66.20
-64.30
-62.70
-61.40
-59.90
-58.50
-57.20
-56.00
-54.70
-53.50
-52.40
-51.10
-50.00
-49.20
-48.40
-47.70
-47.00
-46.30
-45.60
-44.90
-44.20
-43.50
-42.80
-42.10
-41.40
-40.70
-40.00
-39.30
-38.60
-37.90
-37.20
-36.50
-90.0
-84.0
-80.0
-78.0
-76.0
-74.0
-72.0
-70.0
-68.7
-67.4
-66.2
-64.3
-62.7
-61.4
-60.0
-58.5
-57.2
-56.0
-54.7
-53.5
-52.4
-51.2
-50.0
-49.2
-48.4
-47.7
-47.0
-46.3
-45.6
-44.9
-44.2
-43.5
-42.8
-42.1
-41.4
-40.7
-40.0
-39.3
-38.6
-37.9
-37.2
-36.5
2
88
3
89
4
90
5
91
6
92
7
93
8
94
9
95
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
-9.3
-8.9
-8.5
-8.1
-7.8
-7.4
-7.0
-3.7
-6.3
-5.9
-5.6
-5.2
-4.8
-4.4
-4.1
-3.7
-3.3
-3.0
-2.6
-2.2
-1.9
-1.5
-1.1
-0.7
-0.4
0.0
VM200 User’s Guide
207
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Pan Gain
Gain
Left
(dB)
Gain
Right
(dB)
Gain
Left
(dB)
Gain
Right
(dB)
Gain
Left
(dB)
Gain
Right
(dB)
Displayed
Pan
Displayed
Pan
Displayed
Pan
No.
No.
No.
0
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
0.0
-∞
<–L
-1.8
-7.1
-6.3
-5.5
-4.8
-4.2
-3.6
-3.0
-2.8
-2.6
-2.4
-2.2
-2.0
-1.8
-1.6
L3.0
L2.5
L2.0
L1.5
L1.0
L0.5
CENTER
R0.5
R1.0
R1.5
R2.0
R2.5
R3.0
R3.5
-9.0
-1.4
R4.0
R4.5
R5.0
R5.5
R6.0
R6.5
R7.0
R7.5
R8.0
R8.5
R9.0
R9.5
R–>
1
-0.1
-0.2
-32.0 L9.5
-27.0 L9.0
-2.0
-2.2
-2.4
-2.6
-2.8
-3.0
-3.6
-4.2
-4.8
-5.5
-6.3
-7.1
-8.0
-10.2 -1.2
-11.6 -1.0
-13.2 -0.8
-15.0 -0.6
-16.1 -0.5
-17.4 -0.4
-19.0 -0.35
-21.0 -0.3
-23.5 -0.25
-27.0 -0.2
-32.0 -0.1
2
3
-0.25 -23.5 L8.5
-0.3 -21.0 L8.0
-0.35 -19.0 L7.5
4
5
6
-0.4
-0.5
-0.6
-0.8
-1.0
-1.2
-1.4
-1.6
-17.4 L7.0
-16.1 L6.5
-15.0 L6.0
-13.2 L5.5
-11.6 L5.0
-10.2 L4.5
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
-9.0
-8.0
L4.0
L3.5
-∞
0.0
Q
HI: 0.1–20 (45 steps), HI-shelving, LPF
HI-MID, LO-MID: 0.1–20 (45 steps)
LO: 0.1–20 (45 steps), LO-shelving, HPF
No.
Q
No.
15
Q
No.
30
Q
0
0.10
0.56
3.2
3.5
4.0
4.5
5.0
5.6
6.3
7.1
7.9
8.9
10
1
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
0.11
0.13
0.14
0.16
0.18
0.20
0.22
0.25
0.28
0.32
0.35
0.40
0.45
0.50
0.63
0.71
0.79
0.89
1.0
2
3
4
5
6
1.1
7
1.3
8
1.4
9
1.6
10
11
12
13
14
1.8
2.0
11
2.2
13
2.5
16
2.8
20
208
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ Frequency
EQ Frequency
Range: 20.3Hz – 20.2kHz (240 steps per 1/24 octave)
Freq
(display)
Freq
(display)
Freq
(display)
Freq
(display)
Freq
(display)
Freq
No.
No.
No.
40
No.
80
No.
No.
(display)
0
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140
141
142
143
144
145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157
158
159
160
161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
178
179
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
187
188
189
190
191
192
193
194
195
196
197
198
199
200
201
202
203
204
205
206
207
208
209
210
211
212
213
214
215
216
217
218
219
220
221
222
223
224
225
226
227
228
229
230
231
232
233
234
235
236
237
238
239
20.3
20.9
21.5
22.1
22.7
23.4
24.1
24.8
25.5
26.3
27.0
27.8
28.7
29.5
30.4
31.3
32.2
33.1
34.1
35.1
36.1
37.2
38.3
39.4
40.5
41.7
42.9
44.2
45.5
46.8
48.2
49.6
51.1
52.6
54.1
55.7
57.3
59.0
60.7
62.5
64.3
66.2
68.2
70.2
72.2
74.3
76.5
78.7
81.1
83.4
85.9
88.4
91.0
93.6
96.4
99.2
102
105
108
111
115
118
121
125
129
132
136
140
144
149
153
157
162
167
172
177
182
187
193
198
204
210
216
223
229
236
243
250
257
265
273
281
289
297
306
315
324
334
343
354
364
375
386
397
408
420
433
445
459
472
486
500
515
530
545
561
578
595
612
630
648
2.06K
2.12K
2.18K
2.24K
2.31K
2.38K
2.45K
2.52K
2.59K
2.67K
2.75K
2.83K
2.91K
3.00K
3.08K
3.17K
3.27K
3.36K
3.46K
3.56K
3.67K
3.78K
3.89K
4.00K
4.12K
4.24K
4.36K
4.49K
4.62K
4.76K
4.90K
5.04K
5.19K
5.34K
5.50K
5.66K
5.82K
5.99K
6.17K
6.35K
6.54K
6.73K
6.92K
7.13K
7.34K
7.55K
7.77K
8.00K
8.23K
8.48K
8.72K
8.98K
9.42K
9.51K
9.79K
10.1K
10.4K
10.7K
11.0K
11.3K
11.6K
12.0K
12.3K
12.7K
13.1K
13.5K
13.8K
14.3K
14.7K
15.1K
15.5K
16.0K
16.5K
17.0K
17.4K
18.0K
18.5K
19.0K
19.6K
20.2K
1
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
81
667
2
82
687
3
83
707
4
84
728
5
85
749
6
86
771
7
87
794
8
88
817
9
89
841
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
90
866
91
891
92
917
93
944
94
972
95
1.00K
1.03K
1.06K
1.09K
1.12K
1.16K
1.19K
1.22K
1.26K
1.30K
1.33K
1.37K
1.41K
1.46K
1.50K
1.54K
1.59K
1.63K
1.68K
1.73K
1.78K
1.83K
1.89K
1.94K
2.00K
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
VM200 UserÕs Guide
209
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Program Change To Scene Mem ory Assignm ent
Tables
Program Change Assign Table 2
(Preset)
Program Change Assign Table 1
(User)
PGM
CHG
#
PGM
CHG
#
PGM
CHG
#
PGM
CHG
#
PGM
CHG
#
PGM
CHG
#
Scene
Scene
Scene
Scene
Scene
Scene
1
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
1
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
00
01
02
03
04
05
06
07
08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
P0
P1
P2
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
2
88
2
88
3
89
3
89
4
90
4
90
5
91
5
91
6
92
6
92
7
93
7
93
8
94
8
94
9
95
9
95
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
96
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
96
97
97
98
98
99
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
125
126
127
128
210
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control Change To Control Parameters Assignment Tables
Control Change To Control Param eters Assignm ent
Tables
Control Change Assign Table 1 (User)
CTL
CTL
CTL
CHG Section 1 Section 2
#
Item
CHG Section 1 Section 2
#
Item
CHG Section 1 Section 2
#
Item
0
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
1
81
2
82
3
83
4
84
5
85
6
86
7
87
8
88
9
89
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
VM200 User’s Guide
211
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Control Change Assign Table 2 (Preset)
CTL
CHG Section 1
#
CTL
CTL
CHG Section 1
#
Section
2
Section
2
Item
CHG Section 1 Section 2
#
Item
Item
0
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
No Assign ----
----
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
19
20
1
CH ON
CH ON
PAN
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
19
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
1
81
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
1
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
----
20
1
2
82
2
3
83
3
2
PAN
2
4
84
4
3
PAN
3
5
85
5
4
PAN
4
6
86
6
5
PAN
5
7
87
7
6
PAN
6
8
88
8
7
PAN
7
9
89
9
8
PAN
8
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
90
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
1
9
PAN
9
91
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
1
PAN
10
11
12
13
14
92
PAN
93
PAN
94
PAN
95
PAN
96
PAN
97
PAN
98
PAN
Not available
99
PAN
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
PAN
PAN
2
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
EFF1 SND
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Effect
15
16
17
18
19
20
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
EFF2 SND
3
2
4
3
5
4
6
5
7
6
8
7
ST-BUSS FADER
9
8
AUX1
AUX2
AUX3
AUX4
EFF1
EFF2
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
FADER
10
11
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
No Assign ----
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
CH ON
ST-BUSS CH ON
EFF1
EFF2
LIB.RCL
LIB.RCL
----
Effect
No Assign ----
No Assign ----
----
212
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Preset Scene Parameters
Preset Scene Param eters
P0 (Init_Mix)
Category
Parameter
Value
Category
Parameter
Value
CH FADER
CH ON
–∞
ON
ST-BUSS MASTER 0dB
ST-BUSS ON ON
AUX1 MASTER 0dB
AUX1 ON ON
AUX2 MASTER 0dB
AUX2 ON ON
AUX3 MASTER 0dB
AUX3 ON ON
AUX4 MASTER 0dB
AUX4 ON ON
EFF1 MASTER 0dB
EFF1 ON ON
EFF2 MASTER 0dB
Ch1–16:Center
Ch17,19:L10.0
Ch18,20:R10.0
CH PAN
AUX1 SEND
AUX2 SEND
AUX3 SEND
AUX4 SEND
EFF1 SEND
EFF2 SEND
AUX1&2 PAN
AUX3&4 PAN
EQ/LO Gain
EQ/LO Freq
EQ/LO Q
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
Center
Center
0
MASTER
EFF2 ON
EQ ENABLE
ADD.AUX
ON
1–8
ON
125
L-S
0
EQ/LO-MID Gain
EQ/LO-MID Freq 500
EQ/LO-MID Q
EQ/HI-MID Gain
AUX1 POST/PRE POST
AUX2 POST/PRE POST
AUX3 POST/PRE POST
AUX4 POST/PRE POST
EFF1 POST/PRE POST
EFF2 POST/PRE POST
SCENE
STATUS
1.0
0
Channels
1–20
EQ/HI-MID Freq 2.00K
EQ/HI-MID Q
EQ/HI Gain
EQ/HI Freq
EQ/HI Q
EQ ON
ROUTING
ST-BUSS
1.0
0
8.00K
H-S
ON
AUX1&2 PAIR
AUX3&4 PAIR
Scene Name
OFF
OFF
Init_Mix
01: Normal
Large Hall
38: 3D Chorus
Others
EFFECT1
EFFECT2
All channels
ROUTING
REC-BUSS
OFF
ROUTING
DIRECT
OFF
PHASE
NORMAL
Ch1–16:off
Ch17-20:on
CH PAIR
MUTE GROUP
FADER GROUP
S/P DIF IN
OFF
OFF
OFF
VM200 UserÕs Guide
213
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
P1 (Recording)
Category
Parameter
Value
Category
Parameter
Value
CH FADER
CH ON
–∞
ON
ST-BUSS MASTER 0dB
ST-BUSS ON
AUX1 MASTER 0dB
AUX1 ON ON
AUX2 MASTER 0dB
AUX2 ON ON
AUX3 MASTER 0dB
AUX3 ON ON
AUX4 MASTER 0dB
AUX4 ON ON
EFF1 MASTER 0dB
EFF1 ON ON
EFF2 MASTER 0dB
ON
Ch1–16:Center
Ch17,19:L10.0
Ch18,20:R10.0
CH PAN
AUX1 SEND
AUX2 SEND
AUX3 SEND
AUX4 SEND
EFF1 SEND
EFF2 SEND
AUX1&2 PAN
AUX3&4 PAN
EQ/LO Gain
EQ/LO Freq
EQ/LO Q
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
Center
Center
0
MASTER
EFF2 ON
ON
125
L-S
0
EQ ENABLE
ADD.AUX
1–8
OFF
EQ/LO-MID Gain
EQ/LO-MID Freq 500
EQ/LO-MID Q
EQ/HI-MID Gain
AUX1 POST/PRE POST
AUX2 POST/PRE POST
AUX3 POST/PRE POST
AUX4 POST/PRE POST
EFF1 POST/PRE POST
EFF2 POST/PRE POST
SCENE
STATUS
1.0
0
Channels
1–20
EQ/HI-MID Freq 2.00K
EQ/HI-MID Q
EQ/HI Gain
EQ/HI Freq
EQ/HI Q
EQ ON
ROUTING
ST-BUSS
1.0
0
8.00K
H-S
ON
AUX1&2 PAIR
AUX3&4 PAIR
Scene Name
OFF
OFF
Recording
01: Normal
Large Hall
38: 3D Chorus
Others
EFFECT1
EFFECT2
Ch9–20
ROUTING
REC-BUSS
Ch1–8
ROUTING
DIRECT
OFF
PHASE
NORMAL
Ch1–16:off
Ch17-20:on
CH PAIR
MUTE GROUP
FADER GROUP
S/P DIF IN
OFF
OFF
OFF
214
VM200 UserÕs Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Preset Scene Parameters
P2 (Mix_Dow n)
Category
Parameter
Value
Category
Parameter
Value
CH FADER
CH ON
–∞
ON
ST-BUSS MASTER 0dB
ST-BUSS ON ON
AUX1 MASTER 0dB
AUX1 ON ON
AUX2 MASTER 0dB
AUX2 ON ON
AUX3 MASTER 0dB
AUX3 ON ON
AUX4 MASTER 0dB
AUX4 ON ON
EFF1 MASTER 0dB
EFF1 ON ON
EFF2 MASTER 0dB
Ch1–16:Center
Ch17,19:L10.0
Ch18,20:R10.0
CH PAN
AUX1 SEND
AUX2 SEND
AUX3 SEND
AUX4 SEND
EFF1 SEND
EFF2 SEND
AUX1&2 PAN
AUX3&4 PAN
EQ/LO Gain
EQ/LO Freq
EQ/LO Q
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
–∞
Center
Center
0
MASTER
EFF2 ON
ON
125
L-S
0
EQ ENABLE
ADD.AUX
9–16
ON
EQ/LO-MID Gain
EQ/LO-MID Freq 500
EQ/LO-MID Q
EQ/HI-MID Gain
AUX1 POST/PRE POST
AUX2 POST/PRE POST
AUX3 POST/PRE POST
AUX4 POST/PRE POST
EFF1 POST/PRE POST
EFF2 POST/PRE POST
SCENE
STATUS
1.0
0
Channels
1–20
EQ/HI-MID Freq 2.00K
EQ/HI-MID Q
EQ/HI Gain
EQ/HI Freq
EQ/HI Q
EQ ON
ROUTING
ST-BUSS
1.0
0
8.00K
H-S
ON
AUX1&2 PAIR
AUX3&4 PAIR
Scene Name
OFF
OFF
Mix_Down
01: Normal
Large Hall
38: 3D Chorus
Others
EFFECT1
EFFECT2
All channels
ROUTING
REC-BUSS
OFF
ROUTING
DIRECT
OFF
PHASE
NORMAL
Ch1–16:off
Ch17-20:on
CH PAIR
MUTE GROUP
FADER GROUP
S/P DIF IN
OFF
OFF
OFF
VM200 UserÕs Guide
215
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
<Transm ission>
MIDI In/ Out Data
Form at
Program Change messages are transmitted on
the channel set by [TX CH] when you recall a
scene assigned in the table selected by [PRO-
GRAM CHANGE TABLE] and when [PRO-
GRAM CHANGE TX] is set to ON.
1. CHANGE MESSAGE
1-1.NOTE OFF (8n)
If the same scene is assigned to mu ltiple Pro-
gram nu mbers, the smallest Program nu mber
will be transmitted.
NOTE OFF m essages are n ot received or
tran sm itted.
1-2.NOTE ON (9n)
STATUS 1100nnnn Cn Program Change
NOTE ON m essages are n ot received or
tran sm itted.
DATA
0nnnnnnn
nn Program No. (0–127)
2. EXCLUSIVE MESSAGE (F0–F7)
1-3.CONTROL CHANGE (Bn)
2-1.MOTION CONTROL STATE (MCS
MMC STOP/ PLAY/ FOR-
WARD/ REWIND/
<Reception>
Control Change messages are received only
when [CONTROL CHANGE RX] is set to ON
and the receive channel [RX CH] matches. If
[RX CH] is set to OMNI, the message is
received regardless of which channel is receiv-
ing.
RECORD/ PAUSE
<Transm ission>
Operating the key in the [MMC SEND] page
will transmit these messages.
Use [Dev ID.] to specify the destination.
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01111111 7F Real Time System Exclusive
Device ID0ddddddd dd Destination (00–7E, 7F:all call)
Control Change messages are “echoed” when
[ECHO] is set to ON.
The parameters are controlled based on the
settings selected by [CONTROL CHANGE
TABLE].
Command 00000110 06 MMC sub-id
0ccccccc cc Command String
[1]: Stop
If the messages are received while the [CTL
TABLE] setting page is displayed, the cu rsor
au tomatically moves to the corresponding
Control Change nu mber.
[2]: Play
[4]: Fast Forward
[5]: Rewind
<Transm ission>
Control Change messages are transmitted on
the channel set by [TX CH] when you operate
the or item assigned in the table selected by
[CONTROL CHANGE TABLE] and when
[CONTROL CHANGE TX] is set to ON.
[6]: Record Strobe
[9]: Pause
EOX
11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
2-2.MOTION CONTROL PROCESS (MCP)
MMC LOCATE (target)
If the same item is assigned to mu ltiple Con-
trol nu mbers, the smallest Control nu mber
will be transmitted.
<Transm ission>
Operating the key in the [MMC SEND] page
will transmit these messages.
STATUS 1011nnnn Bn Control Change
DATA
0cccccccc cc Control No. (0–95, 102–119)
9vvvvvvvv vv Control Value (0–127)
Use [Dev ID] to specify the destination.
STATUS 11110000 F0 System Exclusive Message
ID No. 01111111 7F Real Time System Exclusive
Device ID0ddddddd dd Destination (00–7E, 7F:all call)
1-4.PROGRAM CHANGE (Bn)
<Reception>
Command 00000110 06 MMC sub-id
01000100 44 Locate
Program Change messages are received only
when [PROGRAM CHANGE RX] is set to ON
and the receive channel [RX CH] matches. If
[RX CH] is set to OMNI, the message is
received regardless of which channel is receiv-
ing.
00000110 06 byte count
00000001 01 “target” sub command
0hhhhhhh hh hour
0mmmmmmm
mm minute
0ssssss ss second
0fffffff ff frame
0sssssss ss sub frame (only ‘0’)
Program Change messages are “echoed” when
[ECHO] is set to ON.
A scene is recalled according to the settings
selected by [PROGRAM CHANGE TABLE].
EOX
11110111 F7 End Of Exclusive
If the messages are received while the [PGM
TABLE] setting page is displayed, the cu rsor
au tomatically moves to the corresponding
PGM nu mber.
216
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI In/Out Data Format
3. FOSTEX EXCLUSIVE MESSAGE
<Reception>
Fostex Exclu sive messages are received when [SYSTEM EX. Tx&Rx] is set to ON and the Rx
channel matches the channel of [Dev ID].
When the VM200 receives the System Exclu sive message, the specified parameter will be
changed immediately.
When the VM200 receives the Parameter Requ est message, the corresponding parameter set-
ting will be transmitted immediately.
<Transm ission>
Fostex Exclu sive messages are transmitted if the Tx channel matches the channel of [Dev ID]
and when you operate the key while [SYSTEM EX. Tx&Rx] is ON.
In response to the Parameter Requ est messages, VM200 transmits the parameter settings if
the Tx channel matches the channel of [Dev ID].
F0 51 <Device Id>Sub Id><Data> F7
Com m and List
Setup Com m and
Command
18,10 <master clock>
18,11 <fs>
Request
Status
38,10 <master clock>
38,11 <fs>
Master Clock
Fs
28,10
28,11
28,20
Current Scene Name
Scene Recall
Scene Store
18,20 <Name..>
38,20 <Name..>
18,22 <SceneNo>
18,23 <SceneNo>
18,28,11 <OnOff>
18,28,12 <OnOff>
18,28,30,7f <OnOff>
Rcl Safe – Fader
Rcl Safe – Pan
Rcl Safe – Routing
28,28,11
28,28,12
28,28,30,7f
38,28,11 <OnOff>
38,28,12 <OnOff>
38,28,30,7f <OnOff>
38,28,41 <AuxId> <OnOff>
38,28,49 <EffId> <OnOff>
38,28,50,7f <OnOff>
38,28,5f <OnOff>
Rcl Safe – Aux Send Level 18,28,41 <AuxId> <OnOff> 28,28,41 <AuxId>
Rcl Safe – Eff Send Level
Rcl Safe – Eq On
Rcl Safe – Eq
Eq Enable Ch
Add Aux Mode
Mon Sel
18,28,49 <EffId> <OnOff>
18,28,50,7f <OnOff>
18,28,5f <OnOff>
18,30 <EqEna>
28,28,49 <EffId>
28,28,50,7f
28,28,5f
28,30
38,30 <EqEna>
18,31 <OnOff>
28,31
38,31 <OnOff>
18,40 <MonSel>
18,42 <SoloMode>
18,43 <SoloKeyMode>
18,50 <OnOff>
28,40
38,40 <MonSel>
Solo Mode
28,42
38,42 <SoloMode>
38,43 <SoloKeyMode>
38,50 <OnOff>
Solo Key Mode
Motor OnOff
28,43
28,50
Power On Recall
Cascade
18,51 <SceneNo>
18,52 <Cascade>
18,60 <MemId>
28,51
38,51 <SceneNo>
38,52 <Cascade>
28,52
Memory Backup
Smoothing
18,32<Mode>f7
28,32,17
38,32<mode>f7
Channel/ Buss Com m and
Command
19,01,10 <OnOff>
19,01,11 <Vol>
Request
29,01,10
Status
39,01,10 <OnOff>
39,01,11 <Vol>
ST Buss – Ch On
ST Buss – Master Fader
ST Buss – Solo
29,01,11
19,01,19 <OnOff>
19,02,11 <Vol>
29,01,19
39,01,19 <OnOff>
39,02,11 <Vol>
REC Buss – Master Level
REC Buss – Solo
29,02,11
19,02,19 <OnOff>
29,02,19
39,02,19 <Vol>
AUX Buss – Ch On
19,05 <AuxId> 10 <OnOff> 29,05 <AuxId> 10
29,05 <AuxId> 11
19,05 <AuxId> 19 <OnOff> 29,05 <AuxId> 19
39,05 <AuxId> 10 <OnOff>
39,05 <AuxId> 11 <Vol>
39,05 <AuxId> 19 <OnOff>
AUX Buss – Master Fader 19,05 <AuxId> 11 <Vol>
AUX Buss – Solo
VM200 User’s Guide
217
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Command
Request
29,06 <EffId> 10
29,06 <EffId> 11
29,06 <EffId> 19
29,10 <Ch> 10
29,10 <Ch> 11
29,10 <Ch> 12
29,10 <Ch> 19
29,10 <Ch> 21
29,10 <Ch> 26
29,10 <Ch> 30
29,10 <Ch> 31
29,10 <Ch> 33
Status
EFF Buss – Ch On
19,06 <EffId> 10 <OnOff>
19,06 <EffId> 11 <Vol>
19,06 <EffId> 19 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 10 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 11 <Vol>
39,06 <EffId> 10 <OnOff>
39,06 <EffId> 11 <Vol>
39,06 <EffId> 19 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 10 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 11 <Vol>
EFF Buss – Master Fader
EFF Buss – Solo
CH1-20 – Ch On
CH1-20 – Ch Fader
CH1-20 – Ch Pan
19,10 <Ch> 12 <Pan>
19,10 <Ch> 19 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 21 <Phase>
19,10 <Ch> 26 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 30 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 31 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 33 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 41 <AuxId> <Vol>
19,10 <Ch> 43 <AuxId> <Post/Pre>
19,10 <Ch> 49 <EffId> <Vol>
19,10 <Ch> 4b <EffId> <Post/Pre>
19,10 <Ch> 50 <Band><OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 51 <Band> <Type>
19,10 <Ch> 52 <Band> <Gain>
19,10 <Ch> 53 <Band> <Freq>
19,10 <Ch> 5e <LibNo>
39,10 <Ch> 12 <Pan>
39,10 <Ch> 19 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 21 <Phase>
39,10 <Ch> 26 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 30 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 31 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 33 <OnOff>
CH1-20 – Ch Solo
CH1-20 – Phase
CH1-20 – S/P DIF IN
CH1-20 – Rout:ST Buss
CH1-20 – Rout:Rec Buss
CH1-20 – Rout:Adat Dir.
CH1-20 – Aux Send Level
CH1-20 – Aux Post/Pre
CH1-20 – Eff Send Level
CH1-20 – Eff Post/Pre
CH1-20 – Eq On
29,10 <Ch> 41<AuxId> 39,10 <Ch> 41 <AuxId> <Vol>
29,10 <Ch> 43<AuxId>
29,10 <Ch> 49<EffId>
29,10 <Ch> 4b<EffId>
29,10 <Ch> 50 <Band>
29,10 <Ch> 51 <Band>
29,10 <Ch> 52 <Band>
29,10 <Ch> 53 <Band>
39,10 <Ch> 43 <AuxId><Post/Pre>
39,10 <Ch> 49 <EffId> <Vol>
39,10 <Ch> 4b <EffId><Post/Pre>
39,10 <Ch>50 <Band><OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 51 <Band><Type>
39,10 <Ch> 52 <Band><Gain>
39,10 <Ch> 53 <Band><Freq>
CH1-20 – Eq Type(Q)
CH1-20 – Eq Gain
CH1-20 – Eq Freq.
CH1-20 – Eq Lib Recall
CH1-20 – Eq Lib Store
CH1-20 – Ch Pair
19,10 <Ch> 5f <LibNo> <Name..>
19,10 <Ch> 70 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 71 <Grp>
29,10 <Ch> 70
29,10 <Ch> 71
29,10 <Ch> 72
29,10 <Ch> 73
29,10 <Ch> 74
39,10 <Ch> 70 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 71 <Grp>
39,10 <Ch> 72 <Grp>
39,10 <Ch> 73 <OnOff>
39,10 <Ch> 74 <OnOff>
Ch1-20 – Fader Group
CH1-20 – Mute Group
CH1-20 – Ch Solo Safe
CH1-20 – Ch Recall Safe
19,10 <Ch> 72 <Grp>
19,10 <Ch> 73 <OnOff>
19,10 <Ch> 74 <OnOff>
Effects Command
Command
Request
Status
Eff Type
1a <EffId> 10 <Type>
2a <EffId> 10
3a <EffId> 10 <Type>
Eff Parameter
1a <EffId> 11 <ParamNo>
<Val-L> <Val-H>
2a <EffId> 11
<ParamNo>
3a <EffId> 11 <ParamNo>
<Val-L> <Val-H>
Eff Name
1a <EffId> 70 <Name..>
1a <EffId> 72 <LibNo>
1a <EffId> 73 <LibNo>
2a <EffId> 70
3a <EffId> 70 <Name..>
Eff Lib Recall
Eff Lib Store
Remote Command
Command
Request
Status
Key Remote
1f, 01 <KeyId> <OnOff>
1f, 02 <EncId> <EncVal>
Encoder Remote
218
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI In/Out Data Format
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
Com m and Details
Setup Com m ands
<< Rcl Safe – Eq On >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 28 50 7f <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 28 50 7f f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 28 50 7f <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
<< Master Clock>>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 10 <MasterClock> F7.
request: F0 51 <DevId> 28 10 F7.
status: F0 51 <DevId> 38 10 <MasterClock> F7.
<MasterClock> 0:int 1:adat 2:spdif 3:word
<< Rcl Safe – Eq >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 28 5f <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 28 5f f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 28 5f <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
<< Fs >>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 11 <Fs> F7.
request: F0 51 <DevId> 28 11 F7.
status: F0 51 <DevId> 38 11 <Fs> F7.
<Fs> 0:44.1k 1:48k
<< Eq Enable Ch >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 30 <EqEna> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 30 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 30 <EqEna> f7.
<EqEna> 00:1to8 01:8to16 02:1to16
<< Current Scene Name >>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 20 <Name..> F7.
request: F0 51 <DevId> 28 20 F7.
status: F0 51 <DevId> 38 20 <Name..> F7.
<Name..> ASCII Character(max 9byte).
<< Add Aux Mode >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 31 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 31 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 31 <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 00:off 01:on
<< Scene Recall>>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 22 <SceneNo> F7.
<SceneNo> 00–99:User scene, 100–102:Preset scene.
<< Scene Store >>
<< Smoothing >>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 23 <SceneNo> F7.
<SceneNo> 00..99: user scene.
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 32 <Mode> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 32 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 32 <Mode> f7
<Mode> 00:Level1 01:Level2
<< Rcl Safe – Fader >>
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 28 11 <OnOff> F7.
request: F0 51 <DevId> 28 28 11 F7.
status: F0 51 <DevId> 38 28 11 <OnOff> F7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
<< Mon Sel >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 40 <MonSel> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 40 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 40 <MonSel> f7.
<< Rcl Safe – Pan >>
<MonSel> 00:ST_BUSS 01:REC_BUSS 02:AUX1 03:AUX2
04:AUX3 05:AUX4 06:EFF1 07:EFF2 08:AUX12
09:AUX34
command: F0 51 <DevId> 18 28 12 <OnOff> F7.
request: F0 51 <DevId> 28 28 12 F7.
status: F0 51 <DevId> 38 28 12 <OnOff> F7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
<< Solo Mode >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 42 <SoloMode> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 42 f7.
<< Rcl Safe – Routing >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 28 30 7f <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 28 30 7f f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 28 30 7f <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 42 <SoloMode> f7.
<SoloMode> 00:PFL 02:M-SOLO (01:AFL does not apply to
VM200.
)
<< Solo Key Mode >>
<< Rcl Safe – Aux Send Level >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 43 <SoloKeyMode> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 43 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 43 <SoloKeyMode> f7.
<SoloKeyMode> 00:latCh 01:unlatCh
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 28 41 <AuxId> <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 28 41 <AuxId> f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 28 41 <AuxId> <OnOff> f7.
<AuxId> 01:aux1 02:aux2 03:aux3 04:aux4 7f:all_aux
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on.
<< Motor OnOff >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 50 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 50 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 50 <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 00:off 01:on
<< Rcl Safe – Eff Send Level >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 28 49 <EffId> <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 28 49 <EffId> f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 28 49 <EffId> <OnOff> f7.
<EffId> 01:eff1 02:eff2 7f:all_eff
VM200 User’s Guide
219
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 05 <AuxId> 11 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 05 <AuxId> 11 <Vol> f7.
<AuxId> 1:aux1 2:aux2 3:aux3 4:aux4 0x7f:all_aux
<Vol> 0 to 127
<< Power On Recall >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 51 <SceneNo> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 51 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 51 <SceneNo> f7.
<SceneNo> 00–99:User scene, 100–102:Preset scene.
103:Last store secene.
<< AUX Buss – Solo >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 05 <AuxId> 19 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 05 <AuxId> 19 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 05 <AuxId> 19 <OnOff> f7.
<AuxId> 1:aux1 2:aux2 3:aux3 4:aux4 0x7f:all_aux
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< Cascade >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 52 <Cascade> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 28 52 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 38 52 <Cascade> f7.
<Cascade> 0:Off 1:On_A 2:On_B 3:On_C
<< EFF Buss – Ch On >>
<< Memory Backup >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 06 <EffId> 10 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 06 <EffId> 10 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 06 <EffId> 10 <OnOff> f7.
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
command: f0 51 <DevId> 18 60 <MemId> f7
<MemId> 1:setup(system + midi) parameters,
2:Scene Memory, 3:Eff Lib, 4:EQ Lib
Channel/ Buss Com m ands
<< EFF Buss – Master Fader >>
<< ST Buss – Ch On >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 06 <EffId> 11 <Vol> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 06 <EffId> 11 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 06 <EffId> 11 <Vol> f7.
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<Vol> 0 to 127
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 01 10 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 01 10 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 01 10 <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< ST Buss – Master Fader >>
<< EFF Buss – Solo >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 01 11 <Vol> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 01 11 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 01 11 <Vol> f7.
<Vol> 0 to 127.
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 06 <EffId> 19 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 06 <EffId> 19 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 06 <EffId> 19 <OnOff> f7.
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< ST Buss – Solo >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 01 19 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 01 19 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 01 19 <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Ch On >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 10 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 10 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 10 <OnOff> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<< REC Buss – Master Level >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 02 11 <Vol> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 02 11 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 02 11 <Vol> f7.
<Vol> 0 to 127.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Ch Fader >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 11 <Vol> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 11 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 11 <Vol> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:All
<< REC Buss – Solo >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 02 19 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 02 19 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 02 19 <OnOff> f7.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<Vol> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Ch Pan >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 12 <Pan> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 12 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 12 <Pan> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<< AUX Buss – Ch On >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 05 <AuxId> 10 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 05 <AuxId> 10 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 05 <AuxId> 10 <OnOff> f7.
<AuxId> 1:aux1 2:aux2 3:aux3 4:aux4 0x7f:all_aux
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<Pan> 0 to 40 (0:L - 20:Center - 40:R)
<< CH1-20 – Ch Solo >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 19 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 19 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 19 <OnOff> f7.
<< AUX Buss – Master Fader >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 05 <AuxId> 11 <Vol> f7.
220
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI In/Out Data Format
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 49 <EffId> f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 49 <EffId> <Vol> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:All
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Phase >>
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<Vol> 0-127:Volume
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 21 <Phase> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 21 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 21 <Phase> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<< CH1-20 – Eff Post/Pre >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 4b <EffId>
<Post/Pre> f7.
<Phase> 0:Nor. 1:Inv.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 4b <EffId> f7.
<< CH1-20 – S/P DIF In>>
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 4b <EffId>
<Post/Pre> f7.
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 26 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 26 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 26 <OnOff> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<Ch> 0x7f:all_Ch
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<Post/Pre> 0:post 1:pre
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Eq On >>
<< CH1-20 – Rout:ST Buss >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 50 <Band>
<OnOff> f7
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 30 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 30 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 30 <OnOff> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 50 <Band> f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 50 <Band>
<OnOff> f7
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<Band> 0x7f:all Band.
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Rout:REC Buss >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 31 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 31 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 31 <OnOff> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<< CH1-20 – Eq Type(Q) >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 51 <Band> <Type> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 51 <Band> f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 51 <Band> <Type> f7
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 : Adat Direct >>
<Band> 1:L 2:LM 3:HM 4:H 0x7f:All_Band.
<Type> 0:Hi/Lo_pass 1:Shelving 2-46:Parmetric_Q
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 33 <OnOff> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 33 f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 33 <OnOff> f7.
<Ch> 1-8:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<< CH1-20 – Eq Gain >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 52 <Band> <Gain> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 52 <Band> f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 52 <Band> <Gain> f7
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<< CH1-20 – Aux Send Level >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 41 <AuxId> <Vol> f7.
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 41 <AuxId> f7.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 41 <AuxId> <Vol> f7.
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<Band> 1:L 2:LM 3:HM 4:H 0x7f:All_Band.
<Gain> 0-72:gain (36:0dB)
<< CH1-20 – Eq Freq >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 53 <Band> <fL>
<fH> f7
<AuxId> 1:aux1 2:aux2 3:aux3 4:aux4 0x7f:all_aux
<Vol> 0-127:Vol
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 53 <Band> f7
<< CH1-20 – Aux Post/Pre >>
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 53 <Band> <fL>
<fH> f7
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 43 <AuxId>
<Post/Pre> f7.
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 43 <AuxId> f7.
<Band> 1:L 2:LM 3:HM 4:H 0x7f:all_Band.
<fL>(lower 7bit) + <fH>(upper 7bit) 0-239:F step.
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 43 <AuxId>
<Post/Pre> f7.
<< CH1-20 – Eq Lib Recall >>
<Ch> 0x7f:all_Ch
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 5e <LibNo> f7
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:All
<AuxId> 1:aux1 2:aux2 3:aux3 4:aux4 0x7f:all_aux
<Post/Pre> 0:post 1:pre
<LibNo> 0-99:Eq lib number.
<< CH1-20 – Eff Send Level >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 49 <EffId> <Vol> f7.
VM200 User’s Guide
221
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
<< Eff Name >>
<< CH1-20 – Eq Lib Store >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1a <EffId> 70 <Name..> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 2a <EffId> 70 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 3a <EffId> 70 <Name..> f7
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 5f <LibNo>
<Name..> f7
<Ch> 1-16:Ch 0x7f:All
<LibNo> 50-99:Eq lib number.
<Name..> Max 9byte lib Name ascii string.
<Name..> Max 9byte lib Name ascii string.
<< CH1-20 – Ch Pair >>
<< Eff Lib Recall >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 70 <OnOff> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 70 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 70 <OnOff> f7
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1a <EffId> 72 <LibNo> f7
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_eff
<LibNo> 0 to 99 eff lib number.
<< Eff Lib Store >>
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1a <EffId> 73 <LibNo> f7
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2
<< CH1-20 – Fader Group >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 71 <Grp> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 71 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 71 <Grp> f7
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
<LibNo> 50 to 99 eff lib number.
Remote Commands
<< Key Remote >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1f 01 <KeyId> <OnOff> f7
<Grp> 0:off 1:A 2:B 3:C
<KeyId> 01-08:[Channel]On, 09:[Master]On,
11-18:[Channel]Solo, 19:[Master]Solo
1a:[Rec Buss]Solo, 21-28:[Channel]EQ Edit
31:[Fader Mode]Channel,
<< CH1-20 – Mute Group >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 72 <Grp> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 72 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 72 <Grp> f7
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
32-35:[Fader Mode]Aux1-4,
36-37:[Fader Mode]Eff1-2
38:[Key Mode]Routing/Phase
<Grp> 0:off 1:A 2:B 3:C
39:[Key Mode]Pair/Group
3a:[Key Mode]Ch View
<< CH1-20 – Ch Solo Safe >>
3b:[Key Mode]Channel/Meter
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 73 <OnOff> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 73 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 73 <OnOff> f7
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
41:[Current Scene Status], 42:[Setup]System
43:[Setup]Midi, 51:[Page Sel]1-8
52:[Page Sel]9-16, 53:[Page Sel]17-20
61:[Selected EQ]EQ On
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
62:[Selected EQ] Library Recall
63:[Selected EQ]Library Store
64:[Eff Edit]Eff1, 65:[Eff Edit]Eff2
66:[Eff Edit]Library Recall
67:[Eff Edit]Library Store
<< CH1-20 – Ch Recall Safe >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 19 10 <Ch> 74 <OnOff> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 29 10 <Ch> 74 f7
status: f0 51 <DevId> 39 10 <Ch> 74 <OnOff> f7
<Ch> 1-20:Ch 0x7f:all_Ch
68:[Scene Memory]Recall
69:[Scene Memory]Store
71:<-/-1, 72:+1->, 73:Exit, 74:Enter
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
<OnOff> 0:off 1:on
Effects Commands
<< Key Remote >>
<< Eff Type >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1f 02 <EncId> <EncVal> f7
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1a <EffId> 10 <Type> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 2a <EffId> 10 f7
command f0 51 <DevId> 3a <EffId> 10 <Type> f7
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_Ch
<Type> 0 to (EFFTYP_END - 1)
<EncId> 01-12:Encoder (top raw from left:1-4,
bottom raw from left: 9-12), 11:Data
<EncVal> 0-3f:-64 – -1, 40-7f:+1 – +64
0–3f:variation=0x40-Val
40–7f:variation=Val-0x3f
<< Eff Parameter >>
command: f0 51 <DevId> 1a <EffId> 11 <ParamNo>
<valL> <valH> f7
request: f0 51 <DevId> 2a <EffId> 11 <ParamNo> f7
command: f0 51 <DevId> 3a <EffId> 11 <ParamNo> f7
<EffId> 1:eff1 2:eff2 0x7f:all_Ch
<ParamNo> 1 to 12 or 0x7f:all_params.
<ValL> + <ValH>: 14bit parameter value.
222
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI In/Out Data Format
4. Bulk Dum p (& Request)
<Reception>
Bu lk Du mp is received when [BLK DMP EQ.] is set to ON and when [RX CH] and DEVICE No.
match.
The received Bu lk Du mp is immediately written into the specified memory.
When the VM200 receives the Bu lk Du mp Requ est, it immediately transmits Bu lk Du mp.
<Transm ission>
Bu lk Du mp is transmitted on the channel specified by [TX CH] when you operate the key in the
[BULK DUMP] page.
In response to Bu lk Du mp Requ est, Bu lk Du mp is sent on the channel specified by [RX CH].
4-1.Bulk Dum p Request
<< Setu p Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 01 <Item> f7
<Item> 01:System, 02:Midi, 03:Locate, 127:All Setup
<< Scene Memory Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 02 <MemNo> f7
<MemNo> 0: Edit Buffer, 1 – 100: UserMemory, 127: All User Memory
<< Eff Library Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 03 <LibNo> f7
<LibNo> 50 – 99: User Library, 127: All User Library
<< Eq Library Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 04 <LibNo> f7
<LibNo> 50 – 99: User Library, 127: All User Library
<< PGM Table Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 05 00 f7
<< CTL Table Bu lk Du mp Requ est >>
f0 51 <DevId> 2B ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 06 00 f7
4-2.BULK DUMP OUT FORMAT
<< Setu p Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 01 <Item>
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
<< Scene Memory Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 02 <MemNo>>
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
<MemNo> 0: Edit Buffer, 1 – 100: UserMemory
<< Eff Library Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 03 <LibNo>>
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
<LibNo> 50 – 99: User Library
<< Eq Library Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 04 <LibNo>>
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
<LibNo> 50 – 99: User Library
<< PGM Table Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 05 00
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
<< CTL Table Bu lk Du mp Format >>
f0 51 <DevId> 3B <Byte Count L> <Byte Count H> ’V’ ’M’ ’2’ ’0’ ’0’ ’A’ 06 00
<Data> --- <Data> <Check Sum> f7
* “Byte Cou nt” is the nu mber of bytes cou nted from the byte following <Byte Cou nt> u p to the
byte before <Check Su m>.
* “Check Su m” covers after <Byte Cou nt> before <Check Su m>, with all EOR being removed.
VM200 User’s Guide
223
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
5. MIDI Device Inquiry Message
The VM200 transmits Identity Reply when it receives Identity Requ est, if the Setu p: System
EX. Tx&Rx has been tu rned on.
Identity Request: F0 7c <DeviceId> 06 01 f7
Identity Reply: F0 7c <DeviceId> 06 02 51 02 00 01 00 01 00 63 04 f7
224
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
MIDI Implementation Chart
FOSTEX (Digital Recording Mixer – Internal Parameters)
MIDI Im plem entation Chart
Model: VM200
Version:1.0
Function...
Default
Transmitted
Recognized
Remarks
1-16
1-16
Basic
Memorized
Channel
Changed
Default
1-16
1-16
X
OMNI off / OMNI on
Mode
Messages
Altered
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
O
Memorized
********************
X
Note
Number
True voice
Note ON
Note OFF
Key’s
********************
X
X
X
X
X
O
Velocity
After
Touch
Ch’s
Pitch Bend
0-95, 102-119
Control
Change
Assignable
Assignable
O
0-127
O
0-127
0-99
Prog
Change
True #
********************
System Exclusive
Song Pos
O
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
O
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
System
Song Sel
Tune
Common
Clock
System
Real Time
Commands
Local ON/OFF
All Note Off
Active Sense
Reset
Aux
Messages
Mode 1: OMNI ON, POLY
Mode 3: OMNI OFF, POLY
Mode 2: OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4: OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
VM200 User’s Guide
225
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Declaration of EC Directive
This equipment is compatible with the EMC Directive
(89/336/EEC) - Directive on approximation of member
nation's ordinance concerning the electromagnetic compatibil-
ity and with the Low Voltage Directive (73/23/EEC) - Directive
on approximation of member nation's ordinance concerning
electric equipment designed to be used within the specified
voltage range.
The Affect of Immunity onThis Equipment
The affect of the European Specification EN50082-1 (coexist-
ence of electromagnetic waves - common immunity specifica-
tion) on this equipment are as shown below.
❑ In the electrical fast transient/burst requirements, radiate
electromagnetic field requirements and static electricity dis-
charging environment, this could be affected by generation of
noise in some cases.
Fostex Distributors List In Europe
❑ Including non-EU countries.
❑ underlined: contracted distributors (as of April 1999)
<AUSTRIA>
Name:
Address: Im Winkel 5, A-2325 Velm, Austria
Tel: (+43) 2234-74004, Fax: (+43) 2234-74074
ATEC Audio-u. Videogeraete VertriebsgesmbH.
<BELGIUM>
Name: EML Sound Industries N. V.
Address: Bijvennestraat 1A, B3500 Hasselt, Belgium
Tel: (+32) 11-232355, Fax: (+32) 11-232172
<DENMARK>
Name: SC Sound ApS
ADD: Malervej 2, DK-2630 Taastrup, Denmark
Tel: (+45) 4399-8877, Fax: (+45) 4399-8077
<FINLAND>
Name: Noretron Oy Audio
Address: P.O. Box 22, FIN-02631 Espoo, Finland
Tel: (+358) 9-5259330, Fax: (+358) 9-52593352
<FRANCE>
Name: Musikengro
Address: ZAC de Folliouses, B. P. 609, 01706 Les Echets, France
Tel: (+33) 472 26 27 00, Fax: (+33) 472 26 27 01
<GERMANY>
Name: Studio sound & Music GmbH
Address: Industriestrasse 20, D-35041 Marburg, F.R. Germany
Tel: (+49) 6421-92510, Fax: (+49) 6421-925119
226
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Fostex Distributors List In Europe
<GREECE>
Name: Bon Studio S. A.
Address: 6 Zaimi Street, Exarchia, 106.83 Athens, Greece
Tel: (+30) 1-3809605-8, 3302059, Fax: (+30) 1-3845755
<ICELAND>
Name: I. D. elrf. electronic Ltd.
Address: ARMULA 38 108 REYKJAVIK, ICELAND
Tel: (+354) 588 5010, Fax: (+354) 588 5011
<ITALY>
Name: Recoton Italia Srl.
Address:V. 1 Maggio, N 18, 40050 Quarto Inferiore, (BO) Italy
Tel: (+39) 051-768576, Fax: (+39) 051-768336
<THE NETHERLANDS>
Name: IEMKE ROOS AUDIO B. V.
Address: Kuiperbergweg 20, 1101 AG Amsterdam, The Netherlands
Tel: (+31) 20-697-2121, Fax: (+31) 20-697-4201
<NORWAY>
Name: Siv. Ing. Benum A/S
Address: P. O. Box 145 Vinderen, 0319 Oslo 3, Norway
Tel: (+47) 22-139900, Fax: (+47) 22-148259
<PORTUGAL>
Name: Caius - Tecnologias Audio e Musica, Lda.
Address: Rua de Santa Catarina, 131 4000 Porto, Portugal
Tel: (+351) 2-2086009/2001394, Fax: (+351) 2-2054760/2087488
<SPAIN>
Name: Multitracker, S. A.
Address: C/Garcilaso No.9, Madrid 28010, Spain
Tel: (+34) 91-4470700, 91-4470898, Fax: (+34) 91-5930716
<SWEDEN>
Name: TTS Professional Television AB
Address: Kavallerivagen 24, 172 48 Sundbyberg, Sweden
Tel: (+46) 8-59798000, Fax: (+46) 8-59798001
<SWITZERLAND>
Name: Audio Bauer Pro AG
Address: Bernerstrasse-Nord 182, CH-8064 Zurich, Switzerland
Tel: (+41) 1-4323230, Fax: (+41) 1-4326558
<UK>
Name: SCV London
Address: 3A 6-24 Southgate Road, London N1 3JJ, England, UK
Tel: (+44) 171-923-1892, Fax: (+44) 171-241-3644
VM200 User’s Guide
227
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
228
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Index
A
Control Change TX 178
control surface illustration 18
controls, rotary 48
A inputs 19, 39
A.S.P. 124
converters, D/A and A/D 12, 48
copying channel settings 72
copying EQ settings 90
A/B Input selectors 19
A/D converters 12, 48
AC power 39, 45
CTL TABLE1 function page 23
CTL TABLE2 function page 23
Current Scene Status function page 80
CURRENT SCENE STATUS key 24
Current Scene Status section 24
curve, response 78
ADAT 15, 40
ADAT interface 160
ADAT OUT 24, 109, 166
ADAT-compatible 40
ADD. AUX parameter 14, 24, 38, 115
Advanced Signal Processing Technology 15, 124
Alesis ADAT 14, 15, 40
amplifier 99
D
analog control section 19
applying effects 128
ASP 15
assigning names to programs 86
attenuators 14
D/A converters 12, 48
DAT recorders 40
Data Wheel 21, 28, 29, 30, 56
default settings 198, 200
delays 126
AUX keys 27
AUX Sends 14, 39, 109, 115, 116
muting 118
DevID parameter 179
diagram, block 41
digital connectors 160
Display, LCD 15, 20, 49
DUAL_DELAY 141
DUAL_PITCH 143
dynamic microphones 19
dynamic range 12
B
B Inputs 19
balanced XLR inputs 39
bands, EQ 36, 76
block diagram 41
E
Bulk Dump 174, 179, 189, 223
BULK DUMP function page 23
Bulk RX parameter 179
bypassing the EQ 80
ECHO parameter 176
EDIT indicator 149
editing effects 133
Eff Edit
C
function page 29
section 29
cascade configuration 14, 171, 174
CD players 40, 52
EFF LIBRARY NAME EDIT function page 135
EFF1 15, 27, 29, 124, 128
EFF2 15, 27, 29, 124, 128
effect combinations 29
Effect Library Name Edit function page 30
Effect Library Store function page 30
Effect Preset Library List 125
Effects Library 14, 29, 56, 124, 125, 133
Effects 29, 56, 124
processors 15
return, setting 128
applying 128
editing 133
multi presets 127
naming 135
panning 132
parameters 139
recalling 134
storing 135
ENTER key 21, 30
EQ 15, 28, 76
adjusting 77
bypassing 80
copying settings 90
enabling 80
recalling 84
CH COPY function page 26, 72
CH EDIT function page 26, 49
CH PAIR function page 25
CH VIEW function page 26
CH VIEW key 24, 25
channel control 32
Channel Edit/Input 26
Channel Edit/Output 26
Channel Fader Gain Table 206
Channel Fader Mode 35
CHANNEL key 27
channel layers 16, 37, 46
Channel Pair (Ch Pair) function page 25
channel pairs 68
Channel View key 25
CHANNEL/METER key 24, 26
channels, copying settings 72
character selector box 86, 154
CHORUS 142
CHORUS-REVERB 144
clock 12
condenser microphones 39
connecting MIDI devices 175
contrast 20
Control Change 178
resetting 81
storing 86
EQ COPY function page 26, 90
Control Change Assign Tables 178, 185, 211
Control Change messages 184
Control Change RX 178
VM200 User’s Guide
229
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
EQ Edit function page 36, 54, 76
EQ EDIT keys 34, 36
LED Display Meter 106
LED meters 20
EQ Frequency 209
LED-lighted keys 51
level, stereo output 111
line-level sources 39
locate points 195
low-pass filter 76
LPF 76
EQ Library 15, 28, 76, 83, 86
EQ Library Name Edit function page 29, 86
EQ Library Recall function page 28, 84
EQ Library Store function page 29
EQ ON key 28
EQ Preset Library List 83
EQ Preset Library Parameters 92
EQ program titles 88
equalizer 14, 28, 36, 76
EXIT Key 21
M
maintenance 205
Master Fader 16, 32, 111
Master Fader Gain 207
master, word clock 163
memory, scene 148
F
Fader Gain Tables 206
FADER GROUP function page 25
Fader groups 69
messages
system exclusive 179
warning 202
Fader Mode 16, 27, 32, 35, 65
faders 16, 27, 32, 49, 153
FD-8 10
metering levels 105
meters 105
meters, LED 20
FLANGE 142
microphones 39, 52
FLANGE-REVERB 145
flashing keys 22
dynamic 19
MIDI 12, 23
Fostex 9910 11
MIDI connections 16
MIDI Control Change 16, 184
MIDI controllers 16, 32
MIDI devices, connecting 175
MIDI Implementaion Chart 225
MIDI IN 40
Fostex Advanced Signal Processing
Technology 15, 124
Fostex FD-8 10
Fostex System Exclusive 174, 217
Fostex VR800 10, 15, 40, 164, 165, 166, 192
Frame Mode 194
MIDI In/Out Data 216
MIDI key 23, 176
Freq 54, 77
Freq control 86
MIDI Machine Control 192
MIDI OUT 40
MIDI ports 40, 174
MIDI Program Change 16, 152, 174
MIDI studio 10
frequency response 12
frequency response curve 78
function pages 22, 50
G
MIDI THRU 40
MIDI Transmit and Receive Channels 176
MIDI TX&R function page 23
mix scenes, storing 154
Mix Solo 35, 99, 101, 102
MMC (MIDI Machine Control) 16, 192
MMC mode 25
Gain 54, 77, 78, 86
Gain control 86
guided tour 17
H
Harmonic Feedback Algorithm 15
headphones 14, 99
modes, Fader 16
modulation effects 126
MON SEL parameter 38, 98
MONITOR Gain knob 20, 38
MONITOR OUT 19, 38, 52, 99
Monitor Out level 20
Monitor Select parameter 38, 98
monitoring 98, 100
monitoring ST BUSS OUT 110
MONO_DELAY 140
MONO_PITCH 143
motorized faders 16, 32
M-SOLO 35, 99, 101, 102
multi-effects 127
multi-effects processors 124
multiple VM200s, cascading 174
MUTE GROUP function page 25
Mute groups 65
muting 111
muting AUX Sends 118
muting channels 65
High Density Logarithmic Processing 15
high-pass filter 76
HPF 76
I
initializing the VM200 198
Input Channels 1 - 4 39, 60
input channels 17–20 61
Input channels 5–8 39, 61
input channels 9-16
input preamps 19
inputs 12
61
Inputs, Channel Edit 26
Insert connectors 62
inverting phase 64
K
key 24
Key Mode section 24
keyboard 52
N
L
naming effect programs 135
naming EQ programs 88
LATCH 111
LCD Display 15, 20, 49
230
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
naming programs 86
naming scenes 154
noise 14
R
rack mount 11
rear panel 38
REC BUSS OUT 108, 112
Rec Buss Out 38
O
OL LED lights 106
ON keys 34
optical digital connectors 40
output level 111
outputs 12, 14
Outputs, Channel Edit 26
overload 106
oversampling 12
Rec Buss section 30
RECALL key 28, 29, 30, 31
recall safe 156
recalling effects 134
recalling EQ programs 84
recalling scenes 148, 180
recalling scenes at start-up 151
REC-B.GAIN 24
Receive channel 176
Record Buss 24
P
recording 57
Pad switches 19, 63
resetting the EQ 81
response curve 78
Reverb effects 125
Page Select keys 37, 46, 65
PAIR/GROUP key 24, 25, 68
pairing AUX Sends 119
pairing channels 68
Pan Gain 208
PAN_DELAY 140
panning 65
panning effects returns 132
parameters 22
default values 200
effect 139
EQ Library Presets 92
parametric equalizer 28, 36, 76
PFL 35, 99, 101, 102
PGM TABLE1 function page 23
PGM TABLE2 function page 23
phantom power 39, 61
phase 64
PHASE function page 25
phone connectors 19
PHONES 99
REVERB-CHORUS 145
REVERB-FLANGE 146
Reverbs, Early Reflection 126
rotary controls 48, 54
routing 66, 108
ROUTING function page 25, 66, 108
ROUTING/PHASE key 24, 108
RX CH 176
RX parameter 177, 178
S
S/P DIF 15, 40, 160, 168
S/P DIF function page 25
S/P DIF inputs 24
S/P DIF OUT 14, 109
sample rate 12, 160
samples 160
Phones Gain knob 20
PHONES jack 38
PHONES OUT 19
Pitch Changer 127
Post-fader 117, 130
Scene Memory 16, 57, 76, 148
Scene Memory Name Edit function page 31
Scene Memory Recall function page 31
Scene Memory section 31
scenes 16, 31
power switch 40
naming 154
power, phantom 39, 61
powering on 45
preamps 19
recalling 148
Selected EQ Section 28
selecting a monitor source 100
setting effects return 128
SETUP:SYSTEM 1:CLOCK/MON function
page 20, 35, 38
Setup section 23
shelving-type EQ 76
SHLV EQ 76
Pre-fader 117, 130
Pre-Fader Listen 35, 99, 101, 102
Preset Control Change Assign Table 186
preset effects parameters 139
preset effects 29
Preset Program Change Assign Table 182
Preset Scene Parameters 213
preset scenes 16
signal routing 108
slave, word clock 163
Smoothing function 24, 120
snapshot 16, 31
Preset Table 185
presets, EQ 83
Program Change messages 152, 177
recalling scenes via 180
Program Change RX parameter 177
Program Change Table 177
Program Change To Scene Memory Assignment
Tables 210
Solo Key parameter 111
SOLO keys 30, 31, 34, 35
Solo Mode parameter 98
solo modes 101
Solo Safe function 104
soloing 98
Program Change TX parameter 177
Sony/Philips Digital InterFace 168
soundcards 40
Q
speakers 99
specifications 203
Q 54, 77, 208
Q control 76, 86
ST BUSS OUT 38, 52, 108, 110
start-up scene recall 151
Stereo Buss 24
VM200 User’s Guide
231
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Stereo Buss Out 38
stereo output level 111
stereo pairs 68
STORE key 28-31
storing effects 135
studio
ADAT 10
MIDI 10
synchronizing word clocks 48
synthesizer 52
SYSTEM EX. TX&RX parameter 188
system example illustration 44
System Exclusive Bulk Dump 16, 174, 189
System Exclusive DevID 179
System Exclusive messages 174, 179, 188, 217
SYSTEM key 23
T
tip-ring-sleeve 19
titling effect programs 135
titling scenes 154
top panel illustration 18
translucent function keys 22
Transmit channel, MIDI 176
Trim controls 14, 19, 63
TRS 19
TRS phone jack 38
two-track input 38
TX CH 176
TX parameter 177, 178
U
unbalanced (1/4-inch) phone plugs 39
UNLATCH 111
User Table 185
user’s guide 10
V
VM200, installing 11
VR800 10, 15, 40, 164, 165, 166, 192
W
warning messages 202
waveform 160
Wheel, Data 21
word clock 12, 48, 160
word clock guidelines 161
Word In and Out connectors 40
WORD IN/OUT 162
X
XLR 39, 52
XLR-type connectors 19
Symbols
>/-1 and +1/ 56
Numerics
17-20 EFF RTN key 37
1-8 ANALOG IN key 37
24-bit digital two-channel output 14
2TRK IN 12, 19, 38, 99
3CH_DELAY 141
3D_CHORUS 142
75Ω On/Off Switch 40
9-16 ADAT IN key 37
232
VM200 User’s Guide
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
FOSTEX CORPORATION
3-2-35 Musashino, Akishima-shi, Tokyo 196-0021, Japan
FOSTEX CORPORATION OF AMERICA
15431, Blackburn Ave., Norwalk, CA 90650, U. S. A.
C
PRINTED IN JAPAN OCT.1999 8288 433 200 FX
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.
|